Chemistry PDF
Chemistry PDF
Chemistry PDF
The maximum total mark for this syllabus, after weighting has been applied, is 200.
The overall thresholds for the different grades were set as follows.
Combination of
Option A* A B C D E F G
Components
BX 21, 41, 51 152 129 106 84 71 59 46 33
BY 22, 42, 52 155 134 113 92 78 65 51 37
BZ 23, 43, 53 153 131 109 88 75 62 48 34
CX 21, 41, 61 152 129 106 84 71 59 46 33
Learn more! For more information please visit www.cambridgeinternational.org/igcse or contact Customer Services
on +44 (0)1223 553554 or email info@cambridgeinternational.org
Grade thresholds continued
Cambridge IGCSE Chemistry (0620)
Combination of
Option A* A B C D E F G
Components
CY 22, 42, 62 157 135 113 92 78 65 51 37
CZ 23, 43, 63 151 130 109 88 75 62 48 34
FY 12, 32, 52 – – – 121 104 87 70 53
FZ 13, 33, 53 – – – 119 101 84 67 50
GX 11, 31, 61 – – – 120 103 86 68 50
GY 12, 32, 62 – – – 121 104 87 70 53
GZ 13, 33, 63 – – – 119 101 84 67 50
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*3496257854*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the Question Paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The Supervisor’s Report to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and enclose
it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of the
Supervisor’s Results and of the Supervisor’s Report are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Suitable eye protection should be provided.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Confidential Instructions, please contact Cambridge stating the Centre
number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
email info@cie.org.uk
phone +44 1223 553554
fax +44 1223 553558
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_51CI/FP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
Question 1
[MH] (f) 3 g of anhydrous calcium chloride in a stoppered test-tube, labelled solid X
Question 2
Each candidate will require the following apparatus and chemicals. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
[MH][N] (b) 10 cm3 of aqueous ammonia of concentration 1 mol / dm3, in a stoppered test-tube,
labelled solution Z
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
Supervisor’s Report
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record the
results on a spare copy of the Question Paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’. Failure to
enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably penalised.
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported directly to
Cambridge on the Special Consideration form.
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
Signed ...................................................
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/52
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*9581461431*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the Question Paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The Supervisor’s Report to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and enclose
it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of the
Supervisor’s Results and of the Supervisor’s Report are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Suitable eye protection should be provided.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Confidential Instructions, please contact Cambridge stating the Centre
number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
email info@cie.org.uk
phone +44 1223 553554
fax +44 1223 553558
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_52CI/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
Question 1
Question 2
Each candidate will require the following apparatus and chemicals. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
[MH] (a) 0.5 g of anhydrous sodium carbonate, Na2CO3, in a stoppered test-tube, labelled solid U
[MH][N] (j) aqueous silver nitrate of sufficient concentration to give a positive halide test
(o) splints
(p) spatula
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
Supervisor’s Report
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record the
results on a spare copy of the Question Paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’. Failure to
enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably penalised.
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported directly to
Cambridge on the Special Consideration form.
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
Signed ...................................................
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/53
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*6356581871*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the Question Paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The Supervisor’s Report to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and enclose
it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of the
Supervisor’s Results and of the Supervisor’s Report are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Suitable eye protection should be provided.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Confidential Instructions, please contact Cambridge stating the Centre
number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
email info@cie.org.uk
phone +44 1223 553554
fax +44 1223 553558
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_53CI/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
Question 1
[MH] (f) 3 g of anhydrous calcium chloride in a stoppered test-tube, labelled solid X
Question 2
Each candidate will require the following apparatus and chemicals. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
[MH][N] (b) 10 cm3 of aqueous ammonia of concentration 1 mol / dm3, in a stoppered test-tube,
labelled solution Z
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
Supervisor’s Report
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record the
results on a spare copy of the Question Paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’. Failure to
enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably penalised.
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination;
Other cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported directly to
Cambridge on the Special Consideration form.
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
Signed ...................................................
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 D 1
2 B 1
3 C 1
4 D 1
5 C 1
6 A 1
7 C 1
8 B 1
9 C 1
10 B 1
11 B 1
12 C 1
13 B 1
14 C 1
15 B 1
16 B 1
17 B 1
18 C 1
19 A 1
20 B 1
21 C 1
22 A 1
23 B 1
24 D 1
25 A 1
26 A 1
27 A 1
28 A 1
29 C 1
30 C 1
31 B 1
32 A 1
33 C 1
34 C 1
35 C 1
36 B 1
37 B 1
38 A 1
39 B 1
40 C 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/12
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 D 1
2 B 1
3 B 1
4 C 1
5 D 1
6 C 1
7 D 1
8 D 1
9 D 1
10 C 1
11 B 1
12 C 1
13 B 1
14 C 1
15 B 1
16 B 1
17 B 1
18 D 1
19 B 1
20 A 1
21 B 1
22 B 1
23 A 1
24 D 1
25 A 1
26 B 1
27 C 1
28 A 1
29 C 1
30 C 1
31 B 1
32 D 1
33 C 1
34 D 1
35 B 1
36 C 1
37 B 1
38 A 1
39 B 1
40 C 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/13
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
1 B 1
2 C 1
3 C 1
4 B 1
5 B 1
6 A 1
7 C 1
8 B 1
9 D 1
10 C 1
11 B 1
12 D 1
13 B 1
14 C 1
15 D 1
16 B 1
17 B 1
18 B 1
19 C 1
20 B 1
21 B 1
22 A 1
23 A 1
24 D 1
25 A 1
26 B 1
27 A 1
28 D 1
29 C 1
30 A 1
31 B 1
32 A 1
33 C 1
34 C 1
35 C 1
36 D 1
37 B 1
38 A 1
39 B 1
40 C 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 D 1
2 C 1
3 B 1
4 A 1
5 C 1
6 B 1
7 A 1
8 B 1
9 A 1
10 D 1
11 B 1
12 B 1
13 B 1
14 B 1
15 C 1
16 C 1
17 B 1
18 B 1
19 A 1
20 B 1
21 C 1
22 A 1
23 B 1
24 D 1
25 A 1
26 A 1
27 D 1
28 D 1
29 C 1
30 B 1
31 C 1
32 B 1
33 D 1
34 C 1
35 C 1
36 C 1
37 B 1
38 B 1
39 C 1
40 B 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/22
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 C 1
2 B 1
3 B 1
4 B 1
5 B 1
6 C 1
7 A 1
8 B 1
9 A 1
10 D 1
11 B 1
12 B 1
13 B 1
14 D 1
15 C 1
16 B 1
17 B 1
18 B 1
19 B 1
20 A 1
21 B 1
22 B 1
23 A 1
24 D 1
25 A 1
26 B 1
27 B 1
28 A 1
29 C 1
30 D 1
31 A 1
32 C 1
33 D 1
34 C 1
35 D 1
36 B 1
37 B 1
38 B 1
39 B 1
40 D 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/23
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
1 C 1
2 C 1
3 C 1
4 D 1
5 B 1
6 A 1
7 A 1
8 B 1
9 A 1
10 D 1
11 C 1
12 B 1
13 B 1
14 D 1
15 A 1
16 A 1
17 B 1
18 B 1
19 C 1
20 B 1
21 B 1
22 A 1
23 A 1
24 D 1
25 A 1
26 C 1
27 D 1
28 C 1
29 C 1
30 C 1
31 A 1
32 B 1
33 D 1
34 C 1
35 C 1
36 C 1
37 B 1
38 B 1
39 D 1
40 C 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Core Theory October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a)(i) A 1
1(a)(ii) B 1
1(a)(iii) D 1
1(a)(iv) B 1
1(a)(v) C 1
1(b) substance containing only one type of atom / substance containing atoms (each) with the same number of protons 1
/ substance which cannot be broken down further by chemical means
1(c) solid 1
2(c) labels ‘C’ and ‘H’ in the correct circles and no non-bonding electrons or extra bonding electrons 1
2(d)(i) atoms of the same element with the same number of protons but a different number of neutrons 1
number of neutrons: 2 1
2(e)(i) 30 2
IF full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for (C =) 12 and (H =) 1
3(a)(i) 2 (CO2) 1
3 (H2O) 1
3(a)(ii) correct structure showing all of the atoms and all of the bonds including O–H 2
IF full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for structure with OH
3(b)(i) pH 10 1
3(b)(ii) red / pink 1
to yellow 1
3(b)(iii) sodium carbonate + sulfuric acid → sodium sulfate + carbon dioxide + water 2
IF full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for either sodium sulfate OR carbon dioxide + water
Q: solvent 1
3(d)(ii) chromatography 1
potassium: conducts 1
4(c) does not conduct when solid but conducts when molten 2
IF full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for conducts when molten
5(a)(i) 2 (C) 1
2 (Cl2) 1
5(c)(i) relative reactivity with water: forms bubbles slowly / slower than sodium 1
6(b)(ii) hydrogen 1
6(c) covalent 1
6(d) polymer 1
7(b)(i) C4H6O2Br2 1
7(c) average 1
an element 1
an atom 1
12 1
7(d)(ii) 4 (HBr) 1
8(b)(ii) 28% 1
8(c) 112 (g) 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/32
Paper 3 Core Theory October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a)(i) A 1
1(a)(ii) C 1
1(a)(iii) D 1
1(a)(iv) D 1
1(a)(v) E 1
1(c) substance contain two (or more different) elements which are bonded together / which are chemically combined 1
2(b)(ii) gas 1
turns blue 1
one pair of electrons in each overlap area and no non-bonding electrons or extra bonding electrons added 1
2(d) 51 2
IF full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for (S =) 32, (N =) 14 and (H =) 1
2(e)(ii) global warming / effect of global warming, e.g. melting ice caps / desertification / more extreme weather / death of 1
corals / more risk of flooding
3(a)(ii) pH 4 1
3(a)(iii) neutralisation 1
3(b) C3H8O3 1
3(c) 2 (CO) 1
3 (H2O) 1
3(d)(i) distillation 1
water is the distillate / water collects in the condenser / sodium chloride remains in the flask 1
white precipitate 1
4(c) does not conduct when solid but conducts when molten 2
IF full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for conducts when molten
number of neutrons: 16 1
4(g) goes (directly) from solid to vapour / gas (without liquid state being formed) 1
5(a) nickel(II) oxide loses oxygen / oxidation number of nickel decreases / nickel gains electrons 1
5(c)(ii) toxic / poisonous 1
relative reactivity of rubidium with water: reacts explosively / bigger flame (than potassium) / forms bubbles extremely 1
rapidly / faster that potassium but slower than caesium / rapidly bursts into flame
from ethene:
• steam
• high temperature
• catalyst
by fermentation:
• yeast / zymase / enzymes
• absence of oxygen / anaerobic
• water / aqueous (suspension)
• suitable temperature quoted (10–40 °C)
7(b) Cl2 1
2 (SCl2) 1
7(c) P: freezing 1
Q: condensing / condensation 1
8(a) 89.6 (g) 1
8(b)(i) 220 (cm3) 1
8(b)(ii) 49 (min) 1
8(c)(i) 16% 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/33
Paper 3 Core Theory October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a)(i) B 1
1(a)(ii) C 1
1(a)(iii) B 1
1(a)(iv) D 1
1(a)(v) C 1
number of neutrons: 8 1
number of electrons: 7 1
2(b) limewater 1
2(c)(i) labels ‘O’ and ‘H’ in the correct circles and no extra non-bonding electrons or bonding electrons 1
2(c)(ii) solid 1
2(d)(i) sulfuric acid + magnesium carbonate → magnesium sulfate + carbon dioxide + water 2
IF full credit is not awarded, award 1 mark for either magnesium sulfate OR carbon dioxide + water
2(d)(ii) 98 2
IF full credit is not awarded, award 1 mark for (S =) 32 , (O = 16) and (H =1)
2(e)(ii) pH 2 1
green precipitate 1
3(c)(i) H2 1
3(c)(ii) filtration / filter 1
3(d)(i) structure completed correctly with all of the atoms and all of the bonds 2
IF full credit is not awarded, award 1 mark for OH instead of O–H
4(c) does not conduct when solid but conducts when molten 2
IF full credit is not awarded, award 1 mark for does not conduct when molten
4(d)(ii) electrolysis 1
4(f)(i) diamond has a giant structure AND diamond has covalent bonds 1
5(a) 3 (O2) 1
2 (SO2) 1
5(b)(i) lead oxide loses oxygen / oxidation number of lead decreases / lead gains electrons 1
5(c) air / oxygen 1
water 1
5(e) mixture 1
6(b) naphtha 1
6(c)(i) correct structure of ethane showing all of the atoms and all of the bonds 1
6(c)(ii) 3 (H2) 1
6(e)(ii) any value between –8 and –80 (°C) inclusive of these values 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Paper 4 Extended Theory October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a)(i) B 1
1(a)(ii) A 1
1(a)(iii) C 1
1(a)(iv) E 1
1(b) O2– 2
M1 O
M2 2–
2(a)(i) S 1
2(a)(ii) S 1
2(a)(iii) V 1
2(c) sublimation 1
gains electrons 1
4(b)(ii) 92 2
If full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for Mr of ethene = 28
4(c)(ii) 3
propanoic acid 1
structure of butan-1-ol 1
butan-1-ol 1
(nitrate ions) add aluminium AND aqueous sodium hydroxide AND warm 1
5(b)(ii) 2 / 2 / 4 / 1 1
6(b)(i) oxide ion has an outer shell with six dots and two crosses 1
7(a)(ii) particles have more energy / particles move faster / more collisions per second / more collisions per unit time / greater 1
collision rate
more (of the) particles / collisions have energy greater than the activation energy / more particles have sufficient energy to 1
react / more collisions have sufficient energy to react / a greater percentage of collisions are successful
7(b)(i) 0.075 2
If full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for Mr of CuO = 80
7(b)(ii) 0.05 1
7(b)(iii) 4 (g) 2
M1 moles copper(II) oxide that reacted = (0.05 / 2) = 0.025 mol
M2 mass copper(II) oxide = ((0.075 – 0.025) × 80) = 4 g
7(c) Cl2CuH4O2 2
M1 41.52 / 35.5; 37.43 / 64; 2.34 / 1; 18.71 / 16 OR 1.17 : 0.58 : 2.34 : 1.17
M2 appropriate scaling to give whole number ratios
CHEMISTRY 0620/42
Paper 4 Extended Theory October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a)(ii) molecules 1
1(b)(i) diffusion 1
1(b)(ii) Br2 has an Mr of 160 AND Cl2 has an Mr of 71 / bromine has an Ar of 80 AND chlorine has an Ar of 35.5 1
2(a) Si: 2: 8 : 4 1
Ca2+: 2 : 8: 8 1
N3–: 2 : 8 1
2(b) Ca3N2 1
2(c) Li shown as having one shell with 2 electrons OR no electrons OR no outer shell 1
Cl shown as having an outer shell of 7 electrons of one type, plus one different electron which matches Li electrons 1
3(a) exothermic mark: horizontal line representing the energy of the products below the energy of the reactants 1
correct direction of vertical heat of reaction arrow: arrow starts level with reactant energy and finishes level with product 1
energy AND has (only) one arrow head
3(d)(i) cracking 1
heat 1
3(d)(iv) addition / hydration 1
3(f)(i) CH3O 1
fully correct structure with at least one repeat unit including continuation bonds from correct atom or rectangle 1
3(f)(iv) polyester 1
4(b)(i) oxygen 1
relights 1
because zinc is more reactive than copper AND silver is less reactive than copper 1
5(a) both colours referred to correctly as observations in both parts of the answer 1
(if sulfuric acid is added to solution Y,) equilibrium moves to the right-hand side 1
(if sodium hydroxide is added to solution Y,) equilibrium moves to the left-hand side 1
5(b)(i) 210 cm3 2
M1 expected volume of hydrogen = 300 cm3
M2 70% of M1
5(b)(iii) endothermic 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/43
Paper 4 Extended Theory October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a) mixture 1
1(b) element 1
1(c) compound 1
1(d) mixture 1
2(a)(ii) substance that cannot be split up / broken down / decomposed (into anything simpler) 1
OR
(substance) made of atoms with the same atomic number / number of protons / proton number
2(b)(i) 10 1
2(b)(ii) 22 1
2(b)(iii) A AND B 1
2(b)(iv) A AND B 1
2(b)(v) C AND D 1
3(a) hematite 1
3(b) (coke reacts with oxygen / air) to produce heat / increase temperature / exothermically 1
limestone (decomposes to calcium oxide which) reacts with / removes acidic impurities / SiO2 / sand / silica / 1
silicon(IV) oxide / silicon dioxide
limestone / calcium oxide / lime is involved in the production of slag / calcium silicate 1
sea of electrons / mobile electrons / delocalised electrons / moving electrons / flowing electrons 1
4(b)(i) oxidation 1
4(b)(ii) acid(ic) 1
4(d)(ii) storage of hydrogen is difficult / takes more space to store (hydrogen) / high likelihood of (hydrogen) leaks / lack of 1
availability of hydrogen
4(e)(iii) fermentation 1
4(f) electrolysis 1
5(a)(i) oxygen / O2 1
5(b)(i) reversible reaction in which the rate of the forward reaction equals the rate of the backward reaction 1
concentration of all reactants and products becomes constant / does not change 1
(increased temperature) causes equilibrium to shift to the right / to shift in the endothermic direction / to form more 1
nitrogen dioxide / to form more product(s)
alkenes: CnH2n 1
6(a)(iv) 1
H H
H C C C C H
H H H H
OR
H H
H C C C
H H
H C H
6(b)(i) more than enough oxygen to react with all of the hydrocarbon 1
6(b)(ii) 125 (cm3) 1
6(b)(iii) 1:5:3 1
6(b)(iv) C3H8 2
If full credit is not awarded, allow 1 mark for CxHy (g) + 5O2(g) → 3CO2(g) + 4H2O(l)
7(a)(i) diffusion 1
7(a)(iii) photosynthesis 1
chlorophyll / chloroplasts 1
M2 sunlight / UV (light) 1
7(b)(i) condensation 1
7(b)(ii) hydrolysis 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
shown clearly 1
shown clearly 1
1(e) exothermic 1
1(h) fewer data / less detail / fewer readings / graph not as good / not enough readings taken whilst the solid is reacting 1
2(b)(i) green 1
precipitate 1
2(c) pH 8–11 1
2(d)(ii) blue 1
precipitate 1
2(e) grey-green 1
precipitate 1
2(f) chromium 1
nitrate 1
2(g) ammonia / NH3 1
max [6]:
M1 weigh (any) sample of washing soda
M2 heat (to remove water of crystallisation)
M3 in named container
M4 cool
M5 reweigh
M6 repeat heating
M7 to constant mass
M8 appropriate calculation suggested for the percentage of water
max [6]:
M1 weigh (any) sample of washing soda
M2 heat to remove water of crystallisation
M3 in named container
M4 using apparatus capable of collecting water (vapour)
M5 cool / condense (water vapour)
M6 continue until no more collects
M7 weigh water
M8 appropriate calculation suggested for the percentage of water
CHEMISTRY 0620/52
Paper 5 Practical October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a) initial and final temperature boxes completed AND results ascending in magnitude with more solid S added 1
1(b) initial and final temperature boxes completed AND results ascending in magnitude with more solid T added 1
shown clearly 1
shown clearly 1
1(e) exothermic 1
2(b) bubbles / fizz 1
limewater 1
(turns) milky 1
2(d) yellow 1
2(e) sodium 1
carbonate 1
2(f) white 1
precipitate 1
2(g)(i) white 1
precipitate 1
2(g)(ii) dissolves / clears / soluble 1
bubbles / fizz / effervescence 1
chloride 1
3 6
max [6]:
M1 weigh specified number of nail(s) / specified number of nails
M2 immerse in same volume
M3 samples of tap water and distilled water (in two test-tubes)
M4 for suitable time
M5 dry (in oven)
M6 reweigh nails
M7 compare / conclusion
CHEMISTRY 0620/53
Paper 5 Practical October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
shown clearly 1
shown clearly 1
1(e) exothermic 1
1(h) fewer data / less detail / fewer readings / graph not as good / not enough readings taken whilst the solid is reacting 1
2(b)(i) green 1
precipitate 1
2(c) pH 8–11 1
2(d)(ii) blue 1
precipitate 1
2(e) grey-green 1
precipitate 1
2(f) chromium 1
nitrate 1
2(g) ammonia / NH3 1
max [6]:
M1 weigh (any) sample of washing soda
M2 heat (to remove water of crystallisation)
M3 in named container
M4 cool
M5 reweigh
M6 repeat heating
M7 to constant mass
M8 appropriate calculation suggested for the percentage of water
max [6]:
M1 weigh (any) sample of washing soda
M2 heat to remove water of crystallisation
M3 in named container
M4 using apparatus capable of collecting water (vapour)
M5 cool / condense (water vapour)
M6 continue until no more collects
M7 weigh water
M8 appropriate calculation suggested for the percentage of water
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(c)(i) filtration 1
1(d) heat / boil / evaporate 1
to crystallising point 1
cool / leave to stand 1
2(a) average temperatures completed for all five experiments: 18, 31, 41, 53, 63 1
times completed for all five experiments: 210, 111, 84, 66, 54 1
unit (s) 1
shown clearly 1
2(e)(i) Experiment 5 1
depth greater 1
3(a)(i) red-brown 1
precipitate 1
turns blue 1
3(d) ammonia 1
3(e) lithium 1
carbonate 1
max [6]:
M1 fixed volume of acid
M2 to fixed mass of metal
M3 measure volume of gas / temperature change
M4 named apparatus for the measurement
M5 after time
M6 repeat with other metals
M7 compare / conclude
displacement method
CHEMISTRY 0620/62
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a) water 1
1(b)(i) arrow under mineral wool AND arrow under magnesium ribbon 1
labelled 1
1(d)(ii) ‘pops’ 1
2(a) initial and final temperature boxes completed: 21, 21, 21, 32, 37, 48 2
all readings correct = [2]
4 or 5 readings correct = [1]
2(b) initial and final temperature boxes completed: 23, 23, 23, 23, 20, 18, 16, 12 2
all readings correct = [2]
6 or 7 readings correct = [1]
shown clearly 1
shown clearly 1
2(e) exothermic 1
3(b) bubbles / fizz 1
limewater 1
(turns) milky 1
3(d) yellow 1
3(e) chloride 1
4 6
max [6]:
M1 weigh specified number of nail(s) / specified number of nails
M2 immerse in same volume
M3 samples of tap water and distilled water (in two test-tubes)
M4 for suitable time
M5 dry (in oven)
M6 reweigh nails
M7 compare / conclusion
CHEMISTRY 0620/63
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical October/November 2017
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the October/November 2017 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1(a) pestle 1
(teat) pipette 1
1(d) residue 1
2(a) temperature boxes completed: 23, 16, 14, 13, 12, 11, 11, 11, 11, 11 2
all readings correct = [2]
8 or 9 readings correct = [1]
2(b) temperature boxes completed correctly: 22, 26, 29, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 35, 35 2
all readings correct = [2]
8 or 9 readings correct = [1]
shown clearly 1
shown clearly 1
2(e) exothermic 1
2(h) fewer data / less detail / fewer readings / graph not as good / not enough readings whilst the solid is reacting 1
3(a)(i) green 1
precipitate 1
3(a)(iii) bubbles / fizzing / effervescence 1
3(b) ammonia / NH3 1
4 6
heating to dryness method
max [6]:
M1 weigh (any) sample of washing soda
M2 heat (to remove water of crystallisation)
M3 in named container
M4 cool
M5 reweigh
M6 repeat heating
M7 to constant mass
M8 appropriate calculation suggested for the percentage of water
max [6]:
M1 weigh (any) sample of washing soda
M2 heat to remove water of crystallisation
M3 in named container
M4 using apparatus capable of collecting water (vapour)
M5 cool / condense (water vapour)
M6 continue until no more collects
M7 weigh water
M8 appropriate calculation suggested for the percentage of water
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) October/November 2017
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*1330880521*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_11/4RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 The diagram shows how the arrangement of particles changes when a substance changes state.
A boiling
B condensation
C evaporation
D sublimation
2 Which method can be used to separate a mixture of salt and water to obtain both parts of the
mixture?
A crystallisation
B distillation
C evaporation
D filtration
3 A student put 25.0 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid into a conical flask.
The student added 2.5 g of solid sodium carbonate and measured the change in temperature of
the mixture.
Which apparatus does the student need to use to obtain the most accurate results?
A –61 °C to –51 °C
B –56 °C
C 51 °C to 61 °C
D 56 °C
P Q R
W 6 6 6
X 6 6 7
Y 7 7 7
Z 7 7 8
substance 1 substance 2
8 Substances with giant covalent structures can be used as lubricants and as cutting tools for hard
materials.
The diagram shows how the atoms are arranged in two giant covalent substances, X and Y.
X Y
key
strong
covalent
bond
weak
attraction
9 The equation shows the thermal decomposition of magnesium carbonate (Mr = 84).
Which mass of magnesium oxide is formed when 21.0 g of magnesium carbonate are completely
decomposed?
10 Electricity is passed through concentrated aqueous sodium chloride. Inert electrodes are used.
+ –
concentrated
aqueous sodium
chloride
A chlorine
B hydrogen
C oxygen
D sodium
1 2
12 When dilute sulfuric acid reacts with aqueous sodium hydroxide, the temperature of the solution
increases.
Which graph represents what happens when sodium carbonate reacts with an excess of dilute
hydrochloric acid in an open beaker?
A B C D
0 0 0 0
0 time 0 time 0 time 0 time
14 When blue copper(II) sulfate is heated, a white solid and water are formed.
The white solid turns blue and gives out heat when water is added to it.
Which terms describe the blue copper(II) sulfate and the reactions?
the blue
reactions
copper(II) sulfate is
15 Which changes increase the rate of reaction between calcium carbonate and dilute
hydrochloric acid?
P 2NaNO2 + O2 → 2NaNO3
Q 2HgO → 2Hg + O2
P Q
A
B
C
D
18 Magnesium, phosphorus and chlorine are elements in the same period of the Periodic Table.
Which row describes the type of oxide formed by each of these elements?
19 Zinc sulfate is made by reacting an excess of zinc oxide with dilute sulfuric acid.
Which process is used to obtain solid zinc sulfate from the solution?
A crystallisation
B dissolving
C filtration
D fractional distillation
A a glowing splint
B damp litmus paper
C limewater
21 Which statements about the trends across a period of the Periodic Table are correct?
The melting point of astatine is ......2...... than the melting point of iodine.
1 2 3
A high no no
B high yes yes
C low no yes
D low yes no
A It conducts electricity.
B It glows when heated.
C It is less dense than air.
D It is not reactive.
A conduct electricity
B hard
C low melting points
D react with water
26 Which material is not involved in the large-scale extraction of iron from iron ore?
A bauxite
B calcium carbonate (limestone)
C carbon (coke)
D hematite
P yes no
Q no yes
R yes yes
most least
reactive reactive
A P R Q
B Q P R
C R P Q
D R Q P
29 The flow chart shows stages in the treatment of river water to produce drinking water.
X Y
A distillation chlorination
B distillation filtration
C filtration chlorination
D filtration distillation
A argon
B carbon dioxide
C nitrogen
D oxygen
Mild steel is used for ......1...... and is prevented from rusting by ......2...... .
Stainless steel does not rust. It is produced by ......3...... iron with another metal.
1 2 3
32 A mixture produces a gas both when it reacts with an acid and when it reacts with an alkali.
33 Some marble chips (calcium carbonate) are heated strongly and substances X and Y are formed.
Substance X is a white solid that reacts with water, giving out heat. Substance Y is a colourless
gas.
X Y
1 2 3 4
C C H C C H H C C H H C C CH3
H3 C CH3 H CH3 H H H H
35 Some of the fractions obtained from the fractional distillation of petroleum are used as fuels for
vehicles.
A coal
B hydrogen
C natural gas
D petroleum
38 The table shows bonds that are present and bonds that are not present in compound X.
bond
C–C
C=C
C–H
C–O
C=O
O–H
A a carboxylic acid
B an alcohol
C an alkane
D an alkene
X Y Z
carbon dioxide
butane ethene ethanol
and water
X Y Z
H H H H H H H H H H H H
C C + C C + C C C C C C C C
H H H H H H H H H H H H
A cracking
B oxidation
C polymerisation
D reduction
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/11/O/N/17
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/12
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) October/November 2017
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*1011389924*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_12/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 The melting points and boiling points of four elements are shown.
melting boiling
element
point / °C point / °C
W –7 60
X –101 –34
Y 114 184
Z 39 688
mixture
funnel
filter paper
A balance
B measuring cylinder
C stopclock
D thermometer
A –9 °C
B 72 °C to 78 °C
C 116 °C
D 116 °C to 126 °C
A B C D
64 65
B 29 Cu and 29 Cu
64 65
C 29 Cu and 30 Zn
65 65
D 29 Cu and 30 Zn
electrical conductivity
melting point type of bonding
when liquid
A 74 B 86 C 134 D 148
10 The diagram shows the electrolysis of two solutions using inert electrodes.
P Q R S
+ – + –
dilute concentrated
sulfuric acid aqueous
sodium chloride
P Q R S
1 2
Which type of reaction and energy level diagram apply to this reaction?
reactants
A endothermic energy
products
products
B endothermic energy
reactants
reactants
C exothermic energy
products
products
D exothermic energy
reactants
Which graph represents what happens when sodium carbonate reacts with an excess of dilute
hydrochloric acid in an open beaker?
A B C D
0 0 0 0
0 time 0 time 0 time 0 time
14 When blue copper(II) sulfate is heated, a white solid and water are formed.
The white solid turns blue and gives out heat when water is added to it.
Which terms describe the blue copper(II) sulfate and the reactions?
the blue
reactions
copper(II) sulfate is
15 An experiment was carried out to find the rate of reaction when 1 g of solid X reacts with 100 cm3
of solution Y.
gas syringe
solution Y
solid X
A add a catalyst
B decrease the concentration of solution Y
C decrease the particle size of solid X
D increase the temperature
P 2NaNO2 + O2 → 2NaNO3
Q 2HgO → 2Hg + O2
P Q
A
B
C
D
The solution of the oxide formed from element Q turns Universal Indicator red.
The solution of the oxide formed from element R turns Universal Indicator blue.
Q R
A carbon sulfur
B sodium magnesium
C sodium sulfur
D sulfur sodium
19 Copper(II) sulfate can be prepared by adding excess copper(II) carbonate to sulfuric acid.
20 Compound P reacts with hydrochloric acid to produce a gas that turns limewater milky.
What is P?
A sodium carbonate
B sodium chloride
C sodium hydroxide
D sodium sulfate
23 Which properties do the elements chromium, iron and vanadium have in common?
A It conducts electricity.
B It glows when heated.
C It is less dense than air.
D It is not reactive.
A conduct electricity
B hard
C low melting points
D react with water
26 Which process is used to extract iron from hematite in the blast furnace?
A electrolysis
B reduction with carbon monoxide
C reduction with lime
D thermal decomposition
P yes yes
Q yes no
R no yes
most least
reactive reactive
A P Q R
B P R Q
C Q P R
D R P Q
aluminium copper
29 The flow chart shows stages in the treatment of river water to produce drinking water.
X Y
A distillation chlorination
B distillation filtration
C filtration chlorination
D filtration distillation
A argon
B nitrogen
C oxygen
D sulfur
Mild steel is used for ......1...... and is prevented from rusting by ......2...... .
Stainless steel does not rust. It is produced by ......3...... iron with another metal.
1 2 3
33 Some marble chips (calcium carbonate) are heated strongly and substances X and Y are formed.
Substance X is a white solid that reacts with water, giving out heat. Substance Y is a colourless
gas.
X Y
S T U V
H H H H H H H H H H
H C C C C H H C C H H C C H C C
H H H H H H H C C H H H
H H
38 The table shows bonds that are present and bonds that are not present in compound X.
bond
C–C
C=C
C–H
C–O
C=O
O–H
A a carboxylic acid
B an alcohol
C an alkane
D an alkene
X Y Z
carbon dioxide
butane ethene ethanol
and water
X Y Z
H H H H H H H H H H H H
C C + C C + C C C C C C C C
H H H H H H H H H H H H
A cracking
B oxidation
C polymerisation
D reduction
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/12/O/N/17
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/13
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) October/November 2017
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*5136071969*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_13/4RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
2 Which method is used to obtain copper(II) sulfate crystals from an aqueous solution of
copper(II) sulfate?
A chromatography
B condensation
C evaporation
D filtration
3 25 cm3 of an alkali are added to 20 cm3 of an acid. The temperature change is measured.
4 A sample of liquid X turns blue cobalt(II) chloride paper pink. The sample boils at 102 °C.
1 X contains water.
2 X is impure water.
What is Y?
6 Which row gives the number of protons, electrons and neutrons found in an atom of zinc?
A 30 30 35
B 30 35 35
C 35 30 30
D 35 35 30
8 The diagrams, X, Y and Z, show part of a polymer and two giant covalent structures.
X Y Z
Which of X, Y or Z could be used as a cutting tool and which of X, Y or Z could be used to reduce
friction?
A X Y
B Y Z
C Z X
D Z Y
9 A compound with the formula XO2 has a relative formula mass of 64.
What is X?
A cadmium
B copper
C gadolinium
D sulfur
+ –
concentrated
hydrochloric acid
1 2
Which graph represents what happens when sodium carbonate reacts with an excess of dilute
hydrochloric acid in an open beaker?
A B C D
0 0 0 0
0 time 0 time 0 time 0 time
14 When blue copper(II) sulfate is heated, a white solid and water are formed.
The white solid turns blue and gives out heat when water is added to it.
Which terms describe the blue copper(II) sulfate and the reactions?
the blue
reactions
copper(II) sulfate is
15 The equation for the reaction between magnesium and hydrochloric acid is shown.
Mg + 2HCl → MgCl 2 + H2
gas syringe
hydrochloric acid
magnesium ribbon
P 2NaNO2 + O2 → 2NaNO3
Q 2HgO → 2Hg + O2
P Q
A
B
C
D
18 Which oxide produces a solution with a pH between pH 1 and pH 7 when reacted with water?
A calcium oxide
B carbon dioxide
C potassium oxide
D sodium oxide
19 Three solids, P, Q and R, all react with dilute sulfuric acid to produce zinc sulfate.
The gas produced when P reacts will not burn. The gas produced when R reacts will burn.
P Q R
20 Which ion forms a green precipitate with aqueous sodium hydroxide that dissolves in an excess
of aqueous sodium hydroxide?
element R S T V W X Y Z
melting point in °C 98
boiling point in °C 883
reaction with cold water gives off H2 gas
reaction when heated with oxygen burns to give a white solid
A Group I
B Group VII
C Group VIII
D transition elements
A acts as a catalyst
B brittle
C forms an acidic oxide
D highly reactive with water
A It conducts electricity.
B It glows when heated.
C It is less dense than air.
D It is not reactive.
A conduct electricity
B hard
C low melting points
D react with water
26 What is the reducing agent in the large-scale extraction of iron from iron ore?
A air
B carbon monoxide
C hematite
D limestone
P yes no
Q yes yes
R no yes
most least
reactive reactive
A P Q R
B P R Q
C Q P R
D R P Q
29 The flow chart shows stages in the treatment of river water to produce drinking water.
X Y
A distillation chlorination
B distillation filtration
C filtration chlorination
D filtration distillation
A carbon monoxide
B hydrogen
C lead compounds
D sulfur dioxide
Mild steel is used for ......1...... and is prevented from rusting by ......2...... .
Stainless steel does not rust. It is produced by ......3...... iron with another metal.
1 2 3
damp red
litmus paper
Q and aqueous
sodium hydroxide
heat
What is Q?
A ammonium chloride
B copper(II) chloride
C iron(III) chloride
D sodium chloride
33 Some marble chips (calcium carbonate) are heated strongly and substances X and Y are formed.
Substance X is a white solid that reacts with water, giving out heat. Substance Y is a colourless
gas.
X Y
H H H
H C C C OH
H H H
What is R?
A propane
B propanoic acid
C propanol
D propene
35 Fuel oil and naphtha are two fractions obtained from petroleum.
A CO + H2
B CO + H2O
C CO2 + H2
D CO2 + H2O
38 The table shows bonds that are present and bonds that are not present in compound X.
bond
C–C
C=C
C–H
C–O
C=O
O–H
A a carboxylic acid
B an alcohol
C an alkane
D an alkene
X Y Z
carbon dioxide
butane ethene ethanol
and water
X Y Z
H H H H H H H H H H H H
C C + C C + C C C C C C C C
H H H H H H H H H H H H
A cracking
B oxidation
C polymerisation
D reduction
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/13/O/N/17
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) October/November 2017
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*1790619835*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_21/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 Which process causes the greatest increase in the distance between particles?
A condensation
B freezing
C melting
D sublimation
2 A student put 25.0 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid into a conical flask.
The student added 2.5 g of solid sodium carbonate and measured the change in temperature of
the mixture.
Which apparatus does the student need to use to obtain the most accurate results?
distance travelled / cm
solvent 5.0
substance X 3.0
substance Y 2.5
Rf (X) Rf (Y)
A 0.5 0.6
B 0.6 0.5
C 1.6 2.0
D 2.0 1.6
1 It is a hard substance.
2 It has a macromolecular structure with strong covalent bonds.
Which is correct?
5 Which statement explains why isotopes of the same element have the same chemical properties?
6 Which dot-and-cross diagram shows the outer shell electron arrangement in a molecule of
nitrogen?
A B C D
N N N N N N N N
7 The equation for the reaction between barium chloride solution and dilute sulfuric acid is shown.
8 A compound is analysed and found to contain 85.7% carbon and 14.3% hydrogen.
9 Which statements about the electrolysis of concentrated copper(II) chloride are correct?
2 Electrons move round the external circuit from the cathode to the anode.
3 Chloride ions are attracted to the anode.
4 Hydroxide ions transfer electrons to the cathode.
10 Which metal combination produces the highest voltage reading in the cells shown?
A B
V V
Fe Cu Zn Cu
C D
V V
Cu Cu Mg Cu
11 The compound hydrazine is used as a rocket fuel. It has the structural formula shown.
H H
N N
H H
N2H4 → N2 + 2H2
bond energy
in kJ / mol
H–H +436
N–H +390
N–N +160
N≡N +945
A The energy absorbed for bond breaking is greater than the energy released by bond
formation.
B The energy absorbed for bond breaking is less than the energy released by bond formation.
C The energy released by bond breaking is greater than the energy absorbed for bond
formation.
D The energy released by bond breaking is less than the energy absorbed for bond formation.
Which graph represents what happens when sodium carbonate reacts with an excess of dilute
hydrochloric acid in an open beaker?
A B C D
0 0 0 0
0 time 0 time 0 time 0 time
CuO + H2 → Cu + H2O
A H2 CuO
B CuO H2
C H2O Cu
D Cu H2O
Which statements explain why an increase in temperature increases the rate of the reaction?
Which changes in temperature and pressure increase the equilibrium yield of carbon monoxide?
temperature pressure
A decrease decrease
B decrease increase
C increase decrease
D increase increase
Oxide 2 reacts with acids to form salts but does not react with alkalis.
Oxide 3 reacts with alkalis to form salts but does not react with acids.
19 Zinc sulfate is made by reacting an excess of zinc oxide with dilute sulfuric acid.
Which process is used to obtain solid zinc sulfate from the solution?
A crystallisation
B dissolving
C filtration
D fractional distillation
A a glowing splint
B damp litmus paper
C limewater
21 Which statements about the trends across a period of the Periodic Table are correct?
The melting point of astatine is ......2...... than the melting point of iodine.
1 2 3
A high no no
B high yes yes
C low no yes
D low yes no
A It conducts electricity.
B It glows when heated.
C It is less dense than air.
D It is not reactive.
A conduct electricity
B hard
C low melting points
D react with water
A aluminium tin
B aluminium zinc
C copper tin
D copper zinc
28 Information about the nitrates and carbonates of two metals, Q and R, is shown.
29 The flow chart shows stages in the treatment of river water to produce drinking water.
X Y
A distillation chlorination
B distillation filtration
C filtration chlorination
D filtration distillation
The nails were placed in an open dish filled with water and left for a week.
A B
wrapped wrapped
in aluminium in copper
D C
wrapped wrapped
in zinc in magnesium
N2 + 3H2 2NH3
What are the sources of the nitrogen and hydrogen used in the Haber process?
nitrogen hydrogen
A combustion of alkanes
B photosynthesis
C respiration
D thermal decomposition of limestone
33 Which row shows the conditions used in the manufacture of sulfuric acid by the Contact process?
temperature pressure
catalyst
/ °C / atm
A 40 200 Fe
B 40 200 V2O5
C 400 2 Fe
D 400 2 V2O5
34 Some marble chips (calcium carbonate) are heated strongly and substances X and Y are formed.
Substance X is a white solid that reacts with water, giving out heat. Substance Y is a colourless
gas.
X Y
1 2 3 4
C C H C C H H C C H H C C CH3
H3 C CH3 H CH3 H H H H
36 Some of the fractions obtained from the fractional distillation of petroleum are used as fuels for
vehicles.
X Y Z
carbon dioxide
butane ethene ethanol
and water
X Y Z
O O O O O
C C N N C C N N C
H H H H
1 2
A polyamide addition
B polyamide condensation
C polyester addition
D polyester condensation
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/21/O/N/17
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/22
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) October/November 2017
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*4951844726*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_22/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 The diagram shows the arrangement of particles in the three states of matter.
P Q R
initial final
state state
A P R
B Q P
C R P
D R Q
A balance
B measuring cylinder
C stopclock
D thermometer
has a is an conducts
giant structure acidic oxide electricity
A
B
C
D
5 Why do isotopes of the same element have the same chemical properties?
6 Which dot-and-cross diagram shows the outer shell electron arrangement in a molecule of
carbon dioxide?
A B
O C O O C O
C D
O C O O C O
7 The equation for the reaction between phosphorus and oxygen is shown.
x y z
A 1 5 2
B 1 10 2
C 2 5 2
D 2 10 1
Which row shows the empirical formula and molecular formula for this alcohol?
A C2H4O C2H4O
B C2H4O C4H8O2
C C4H8O2 C4H8O2
D C4H8O2 C2H4O
9 Which statements about the electrolysis of concentrated copper(II) chloride are correct?
2 Electrons move round the external circuit from the cathode to the anode.
3 Chloride ions are attracted to the anode.
4 Hydroxide ions transfer electrons to the cathode.
10 Which metal combination produces the highest voltage reading in the cells shown?
A B
V V
Fe Cu Zn Cu
C D
V V
Cu Cu Mg Cu
bond energy
bond
in kJ / mol
C–H +410
O=O +496
H–O +460
A The energy absorbed for bond breaking is greater than the energy released by bond
formation.
B The energy absorbed for bond breaking is less than the energy released by bond formation.
C The energy released by bond breaking is greater than the energy absorbed for bond
formation.
D The energy released by bond breaking is less than the energy absorbed for bond formation.
Which graph represents what happens when sodium carbonate reacts with an excess of dilute
hydrochloric acid in an open beaker?
A B C D
0 0 0 0
0 time 0 time 0 time 0 time
A copper ions
B copper metal
C silver ions
D zinc metal
15 Four statements about the effect of increasing temperature on a reaction are shown.
Oxide 2 reacts with acids to form salts but does not react with alkalis.
Oxide 3 reacts with alkalis to form salts but does not react with acids.
19 Copper(II) sulfate can be prepared by adding excess copper(II) carbonate to sulfuric acid.
20 Compound P reacts with hydrochloric acid to produce a gas that turns limewater milky.
What is P?
A sodium carbonate
B sodium chloride
C sodium hydroxide
D sodium sulfate
23 Which properties do the elements chromium, iron and vanadium have in common?
A It conducts electricity.
B It glows when heated.
C It is less dense than air.
D It is not reactive.
A conduct electricity
B hard
C low melting points
D react with water
Which row shows the anode material and the anode reaction?
A carbon Al 3+ + 3e– → Al
B carbon 2O2– → O2 + 4e–
C steel Al 3+ + 3e– → Al
D steel 2O2– → O2 + 4e–
B Ca(NO3)2 → Ca(NO2)2 + O2
C Ca(NO3)2 → Ca + O2 + 2NO2
D Ca(NO3)2 → Ca + 3O2 + N2
29 The flow chart shows stages in the treatment of river water to produce drinking water.
X Y
A distillation chlorination
B distillation filtration
C filtration chlorination
D filtration distillation
X Y
pure iron galvanised iron
air
water
tube X tube Y
A falls rises
B no change no change
C rises falls
D rises no change
31 Which metal is used as a catalyst in the Haber process for the manufacture of ammonia?
A iron
B nickel
C platinum
D vanadium
33 Which row shows the conditions used in the manufacture of sulfuric acid by the Contact process?
temperature pressure
catalyst
/ °C / atm
A 40 200 Fe
B 40 200 V2O5
C 400 2 Fe
D 400 2 V2O5
34 Some marble chips (calcium carbonate) are heated strongly and substances X and Y are formed.
Substance X is a white solid that reacts with water, giving out heat. Substance Y is a colourless
gas.
X Y
S T U V
H H H H H H H H H H
H C C C C H H C C H H C C H C C
H H H H H H H C C H H H
H H
X Y Z
carbon dioxide
butane ethene ethanol
and water
X Y Z
H H O H H
H C C C O C C H
H H H H
H CH3
C C
H CH3
A B
H CH3 H CH3 H CH3 H H H H H H
C C C C C C C C C C C C
C D
H H CH3 CH3 CH3 H H CH3 H CH3 H CH3
C C C C C C C C C C C C
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/22/O/N/17
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/23
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) October/November 2017
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*7280088800*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_23/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
A Particles moving slowly past each other speed up and move further apart.
B Particles vibrating next to each other become mobile and move slowly past each other.
C Particles vibrating next to each other start to move rapidly and move further apart.
D Rapidly moving particles slow down and move closer together.
2 25 cm3 of an alkali are added to 20 cm3 of an acid. The temperature change is measured.
Chromatography was carried out on an impure sample of paracetamol. The results are shown
(not drawn to scale).
solvent front
0.35 cm
key
0.26 cm S = impure sample of paracetamol
P = pure paracetamol
0.17 cm
baseline
S P
A –73 no no
B 801 no yes
C 1495 yes yes
D 1710 no no
5 Carbon has three naturally occurring isotopes, 12C, 13C and 14C.
Which statement explains why the isotopes have the same chemical properties?
6 Which dot-and-cross diagram shows the outer shell electron arrangement in a molecule of
carbon dioxide?
A B C D
O C O O C O O C O O C O
7 The equation represents the reaction between solid magnesium oxide and dilute
hydrochloric acid to form magnesium chloride and water.
Which row shows the state symbols for hydrochloric acid, magnesium chloride and water?
8 A compound contains 34.5% calcium, 24.1% silicon and 41.4% oxygen by mass.
9 Which statements about the electrolysis of concentrated copper(II) chloride are correct?
2 Electrons move round the external circuit from the cathode to the anode.
3 Chloride ions are attracted to the anode.
4 Hydroxide ions transfer electrons to the cathode.
10 Which metal combination produces the highest voltage reading in the cells shown?
A B
V V
Fe Cu Zn Cu
C D
V V
Cu Cu Mg Cu
H–H +436
O=O +496
H–O +460
A –3208 kJ / mol
B –908 kJ / mol
C –472 kJ / mol
D –448 kJ / mol
A The energy absorbed for bond breaking is greater than the energy released by bond
formation.
B The energy absorbed for bond breaking is less than the energy released by bond formation.
C The energy released by bond breaking is greater than the energy absorbed for bond
formation.
D The energy released by bond breaking is less than the energy absorbed for bond formation.
Which graph represents what happens when sodium carbonate reacts with an excess of dilute
hydrochloric acid in an open beaker?
A B C D
0 0 0 0
0 time 0 time 0 time 0 time
A Ag → Ag+ + e– oxidation
B Ag → Ag+ + e– reduction
C Ag+ + e– → Ag oxidation
D Ag+ + e– → Ag reduction
15 Which statement about the effect of concentration and temperature on the rate of a reaction is
not correct?
A If the concentration of a reactant is increased, the rate of reaction increases because more
particles have sufficient energy to react.
B If the concentration of a reactant is increased, the rate of reaction increases because there
are more collisions between particles per second.
C If the temperature is increased, the rate of reaction increases because there are more
collisions between particles per second.
D If the temperature is increased, the rate of reaction increases because more particles have
sufficient energy to react.
Which row shows the effect of increasing the pressure on the equilibrium mixture?
Oxide 2 reacts with acids to form salts but does not react with alkalis.
Oxide 3 reacts with alkalis to form salts but does not react with acids.
19 Three solids, P, Q and R, all react with dilute sulfuric acid to produce zinc sulfate.
The gas produced when P reacts will not burn. The gas produced when R reacts will burn.
P Q R
20 Which ion forms a green precipitate with aqueous sodium hydroxide that dissolves in an excess
of aqueous sodium hydroxide?
element R S T V W X Y Z
melting point in °C 98
boiling point in °C 883
reaction with cold water gives off H2 gas
reaction when heated with oxygen burns to give a white solid
A Group I
B Group VII
C Group VIII
D transition elements
A acts as a catalyst
B brittle
C forms an acidic oxide
D highly reactive with water
A It conducts electricity.
B It glows when heated.
C It is less dense than air.
D It is not reactive.
A conduct electricity
B hard
C low melting points
D react with water
What is M?
A chromium
B nickel
C vanadium
D zinc
Metal Q has a nitrate that decomposes to give a salt and a colourless gas only.
The carbonate of metal Q does not decompose when heated with a Bunsen burner.
What is metal Q?
A calcium
B copper
C sodium
D zinc
29 The flow chart shows stages in the treatment of river water to produce drinking water.
X Y
A distillation chlorination
B distillation filtration
C filtration chlorination
D filtration distillation
30 A piece of zinc is attached to the hull of a steel boat. Steel is an alloy of iron.
Which statement explains why the zinc prevents the iron from rusting?
A Zinc is less reactive than iron, and iron is less likely to lose electrons than zinc.
B Zinc is less reactive than iron, and iron is more likely to lose electrons than zinc.
C Zinc is more reactive than iron, and iron is less likely to lose electrons than zinc.
D Zinc is more reactive than iron, and iron is more likely to lose electrons than zinc.
31 The Haber process for making ammonia is carried out at a temperature of 450 °C and a pressure
of 200 atmospheres in the presence of a catalyst.
A combustion of methane
B photosynthesis
C respiration
D thermal decomposition of calcium carbonate
33 Which row shows the conditions used in the manufacture of sulfuric acid by the Contact process?
temperature pressure
catalyst
/ °C / atm
A 40 200 Fe
B 40 200 V2O5
C 400 2 Fe
D 400 2 V2O5
34 Some marble chips (calcium carbonate) are heated strongly and substances X and Y are formed.
Substance X is a white solid that reacts with water, giving out heat. Substance Y is a colourless
gas.
X Y
H H H
H C C C OH
H H H
What is R?
A propane
B propanoic acid
C propanol
D propene
36 Fuel oil and naphtha are two fractions obtained from petroleum.
X Y Z
carbon dioxide
butane ethene ethanol
and water
X Y Z
H H O
H C C C H H H H
H H O C C C C H
H H H H
– H2 O
O O
C C N N
H H n
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/23/O/N/17
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*8786129582*
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_31/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
A B C
Na+ Br – Na+ Br – F
Br Br
Br – Na+ Br – Na+ F Br F
Na+ Br – Na+ Br –
D E
H H H H
C C Br C C Br
H H H H
nswer the following questions using only the structures in the diagram.
A
Each structure may be used once, more than once or not at all.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 8]
2 The table shows the composition of the atmosphere of the planet Neptune.
percentage of gas in
gas present
Neptune’s atmosphere
helium 19.5
hydrogen 78.8
methane
(a) Complete the table to calculate the percentage of methane in Neptune’s atmosphere. [1]
(b) D
escribe how Neptune’s atmosphere differs from the Earth’s atmosphere.
Give three differences.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
3 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[3]
[2]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
educe the number of protons and neutrons present in one atom of this isotope of
D
hydrogen.
Use your Periodic Table to help you.
(e) Other gases present in Neptune’s atmosphere include ethane and water vapour.
test .......................................................................................................................................
result ....................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 13]
coloured dyes
ethanol
preservatives
sodium carbonate
(a) (i) Balance the chemical equation for the complete combustion of ethanol.
(ii) Draw the structure of an ethanol molecule showing all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[2]
(iii) T
he chemical equation for the reaction between sodium carbonate and dilute sulfuric acid
is shown.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) The coloured dyes in the liquid floor cleaner can be separated using the apparatus shown.
P ..................................................................
Q ..................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) O
n the diagram, put an X to show where the mixture of coloured dyes is placed at the start
of the experiment. [1]
[Total: 14]
electrical electrical
density
substance boiling point conductivity conductivity
in g / cm3
of solid when molten
graphite 2.25
(a) Complete the table to show the electrical conductivity of solid graphite and solid potassium.
[2]
(b) Give one piece of evidence from the table that shows that iodine is a simple covalent substance.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) What information in the table shows that zinc chloride is an ionic compound?
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(e) Aqueous iodine is formed when aqueous chlorine is added to aqueous potassium iodide.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 8]
(a) (i) Balance the chemical equation for the first step in this extraction.
(ii) Explain why the conversion of carbon to carbon monoxide is an oxidation reaction.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b) T
itanium is a transition element.
Sodium is a Group I element.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(c) T
he properties and relative reactivity with water of some Group I elements are shown in the
table.
(ii) Describe the general trend in the density of the Group I elements.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 9]
6 The diagram shows a fractionating column used for the fractional distillation of petroleum.
refinery gas
gasoline fraction
naphtha fraction
kerosene fraction
lubricating fraction
and bitumen
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [4]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
C4H10 2C2H4 + X
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
All the bonds in butane are single ................................ chemical bonds. [1]
[Total: 9]
(a) A few drops of liquid bromine were placed at the bottom of a beaker containing cyclohexane.
After 3 days, a red-brown colour had spread throughout the beaker.
cyclohexane
bromine
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
Br H H O
H C C C C
H Br H O H
(i) D
educe the molecular formula of this compound showing the number of carbon, hydrogen,
oxygen and bromine atoms.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
Complete the definition of relative atomic mass using terms from the list.
6
12
an atom
an element
a molecule
average
carbon
hydrogen
total
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
3 ...........................................................................................................................................
[3]
(ii) Hydrobromic acid reacts with oxygen. The products are water and bromine.
[Total: 13]
8 Ammonia is manufactured by combining nitrogen and hydrogen at high temperature and pressure.
catalyst
nitrogen + hydrogen ammonia
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b) The graph shows the percentage yield of ammonia at different temperatures.
100
80
60
percentage
yield of
ammonia
40
20
0
0 100 200 300 400 500 600
temperature / °C
(i) Describe how the percentage yield of ammonia changes with temperature.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
When 20 g of copper(II) oxide react with an excess of ammonia, 16 g of copper are formed.
alculate the mass of copper formed when 140 g of copper(II) oxide react with an excess of
C
ammonia.
.............................. g [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
16
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/31/O/N/17
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*9126653271*
CHEMISTRY 0620/32
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_32/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
A B C
H H
S S S
S S S H C C S H
S H H
S S
H H
D E
Cl
S
S S
O O
Cl
nswer the following questions using only the structures in the diagram.
A
Each structure may be used once, more than once or not at all.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
3 ............................................................................................................................................ [3]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 9]
(a) D
escribe how Saturn’s atmosphere differs from the Earth’s atmosphere.
Give three differences.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
3 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[3]
(b) Some properties of hydrogen and helium are given in the table.
(i) U
se the information to suggest why the layer of liquid hydrogen in Saturn floats on top of
the liquid helium.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) W
hat is the physical state of hydrogen at –250 °C?
Explain your answer.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
test .......................................................................................................................................
result ....................................................................................................................................
[2]
[2]
(e) S
aturn’s atmosphere also contains small amounts of methane.
Small amounts of methane are present in the Earth’s atmosphere.
Methane is a greenhouse gas.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) S
cientists are concerned about the increase in the amount of greenhouse gases in the
Earth’s atmosphere.
Explain why.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 14]
3 The following compounds are present in a liquid used for cleaning metal.
ethanoic acid
ethanol
glycerol
sodium chloride
water
(a) (i) Draw the structure of the functional group present in ethanoic acid.
[1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
H C O H
H C O H
H C O H
Deduce the molecular formula of glycerol showing the number of carbon, hydrogen and oxygen
atoms.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Balance the chemical equation for the incomplete combustion of ethanol.
(d) (i) D
escribe a method of obtaining pure samples of both sodium chloride and water from
aqueous sodium chloride. Explain why this method works.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [3]
(ii) Which physical property could you measure to find out if a sample of water is pure?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
test .......................................................................................................................................
result ....................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 13]
electrical electrical
solubility
substance boiling point conductivity conductivity
in water
of solid when molten
(a) C
omplete the table to show the solubility in water of calcium iodide and the electrical conductivity
of solid zinc. [2]
(b) G
ive one piece of evidence from the table that shows that phosphorus is a simple covalent
substance.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) What information in the table shows that sodium chloride is an ionic compound?
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
educe the number of protons and neutrons present in one atom of phosphorus.
D
Use your Periodic Table to help you.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 11]
5 ickel can be obtained from nickel(II) oxide by heating it with a mixture of carbon monoxide and
N
hydrogen.
(a) How does this equation show that the nickel(II) oxide is reduced?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
Ni + 4CO Ni(CO)4
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
Ni(CO)4 Ni + 4CO
(i) Suggest why the nickel obtained can be separated easily from the carbon monoxide.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(d) N
ickel is a transition element.
Potassium is a Group I element.
(i) Describe two differences in the physical properties of nickel and potassium.
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
[2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(e) T
he properties and relative reactivity with water of some Group I elements are shown in the
table.
rubidium 1.53
(ii) Describe the general trend in the density of the Group I elements.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 10]
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [5]
(i) D
escribe how you could distinguish between an unsaturated hydrocarbon and a saturated
hydrocarbon using aqueous bromine.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(iii)
Terylene is a polymer.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 9]
7 Sulfur dichloride, SCl 2, is a red liquid which vaporises easily at room temperature and pressure.
(a) A drop of sulfur dichloride was placed in the corner of a glass box.
The glass box was closed and left for 12 hours.
After 12 hours a red vapour had spread to fill the whole box.
glass box
drop of
sulfur
dichloride
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
(b) Sulfur dichloride can be made by passing chlorine through liquid disulfur dichloride, S2Cl 2.
melting evaporating
SCl 2 SCl 2 SCl 2
P Q
solid liquid gas
P .................................................................................................................................................
Q .................................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 7]
(a) W
hen 20.0 g of calcium carbonate are decomposed, 11.2 g of calcium oxide (lime), CaO, are
formed.
Calculate the mass of calcium oxide formed when 160.0 g of calcium carbonate are decomposed.
.............................. g [1]
(b) T
he graph shows the volume of carbon dioxide produced when some small pieces of
calcium carbonate are heated and decompose.
300
200
volume of
carbon dioxide
/ cm3
100
0
0 10 20 30 40 50
time / minutes
(i) D
educe the volume of carbon dioxide produced during the first 20 minutes of the
decomposition.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) W
hat would be the effect, if any, on the rate of reaction if the same mass of powdered
calcium carbonate were used?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
percentage of limestone
use of limestone
used for this purpose
agriculture
cement manufacture 37
chemical industries 14
iron and steel manufacture 11
road building 20
other uses 2
total 100
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
[Total: 7]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
16
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/32/O/N/17
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*5730339853*
CHEMISTRY 0620/33
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_33/4RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
A B C D E
H
Cl – Cl – Cl –
S N N O C O
N
O O NH4+ NH4+ NH4+
H H
Cl – Cl – Cl –
nswer the following questions using only the structures in the diagram.
A
Each structure may be used once, more than once or not at all.
(iv) is a gas which turns damp red litmus paper blue, ......................................................... [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
Deduce the number of protons, neutrons and electrons in this isotope of nitrogen.
[Total: 10]
2 he atmosphere of the planet Venus contains 96.4% carbon dioxide, 3.5% nitrogen and small
T
amounts of other gases.
(a) D escribe how Venus’ atmosphere differs from the Earth’s atmosphere.
Give three differences.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
3 ..................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[3]
test ..............................................................................................................................................
result ...........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(c) Venus’ atmosphere also contains small amounts of water and argon.
[2]
(ii) T
he melting point of argon is –189 °C.
The boiling point of argon is –186 °C.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(d) C
louds of sulfuric acid are present in Venus’ atmosphere.
Sulfuric acid reacts with magnesium carbonate.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(e) Sulfur dioxide is found in the atmospheres of both Venus and the Earth.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 16]
calcium carbonate
ethanoic acid
iron(II) sulfate
potassium dichromate(VI)
sodium sulfate
sulfuric acid
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(i) D
escribe what you would see when a test-tube containing a small amount of
hydrated iron(II) sulfate is heated gently.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
test .......................................................................................................................................
result ....................................................................................................................................
[2]
(c) Iron(II) sulfate can be prepared by reacting an excess of iron with dilute sulfuric acid.
(ii) Describe how you could remove the excess iron from the mixture formed.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(d) (i) Complete the structure of ethanoic acid to show all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
O
C C
[2]
(ii) Give one observation when aqueous ethanoic acid reacts with magnesium.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
raw a labelled diagram of the apparatus used to separate these different coloured dyes by
D
chromatography.
[3]
(f) B
lue ink was placed at the bottom of a beaker containing water.
After 2 days, a blue colour had spread throughout the beaker.
water
ink
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 15]
electrical electrical
density
substance boiling point conductivity conductivity
in g / cm3
of solid when molten
diamond 3.51
(a) Complete the table to show the electrical conductivity of solid diamond and molten sulfur. [2]
(b) Give one piece of evidence from the table that shows that sulfur is a simple covalent substance.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) What information in the table shows that potassium bromide is an ionic compound?
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(d) (i) State one property of aluminium given in the table which makes it suitable for making
aircraft.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(f) (i) Which two statements describe the structure and bonding in diamond?
Tick two boxes.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 11]
PbO + C Pb + CO
(i) How does this equation show that the lead(II) oxide is reduced?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) L
ead is a metal in Group IV.
Iron is a transition element.
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
[2]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(d) Iron from the blast furnace is converted into steel using oxygen and basic oxides.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
[2]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 14]
6 The diagram shows a fractionating column used for the fractional distillation of petroleum.
refinery gas
gasoline fraction
kerosene fraction
(a) O
n the diagram, write
● the letter X to show where the temperature in the fractionating column is highest,
● the letter B to show where bitumen is removed from the fractionating column.
[2]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(i) Draw the structure of a molecule of ethane showing all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [4]
number of
boiling point
alkane carbon atoms in
/ °C
one molecule
methane 1 –164
ethane 2 –88
propane 3
butane 4 0
(i) H
ow does the boiling point change as the number of carbon atoms in one molecule
increases?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Describe the arrangement and separation of the molecules in liquid butane.
arrangement ........................................................................................................................
separation ............................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 14]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
16
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/33/O/N/17
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*1311966589*
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_41/4RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 The table gives information about five particles. The particles are all atoms or ions.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b)
D is an ion of an element.
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
[Total: 6]
2 The graph shows how the temperature of a substance changes as it is cooled over a period of
30 minutes. The substance is a gas at the start.
300 S
250 T
V W
200
X
temperature Y
150
/ °C
Z
100
50
0
0 10 20 30
time / minutes
Each letter on the graph may be used once, more than once or not at all.
(i) the particles in the substance have the most kinetic energy,
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) Use the graph to estimate the freezing point of the substance.
.............................. °C [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) W
hen smoke is viewed through a microscope, the smoke particles in the air appear to jump
around.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 8]
Mg + Cu2+ Mg2+ + Cu
(i) Give one change you would observe during this reaction.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Identify the oxidising agent in this reaction. Give a reason for your answer.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
Write a chemical equation for the reaction between magnesium and iron(III) oxide.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) T
he metal iron and the alloy steel are commonly used materials. A problem with them is that
they rust.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
xplain how the magnesium blocks prevent the whole of the bottom of the boat from
E
rusting.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(iii) Replacing the magnesium blocks with copper blocks does not prevent rusting.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 10]
(i) Complete the chemical equation for the formation of ethanol by fermentation.
1 . .........................................................................................................................................
2 . .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(b) E
thanol can also be made by the catalytic hydration of ethene. The equation for the reaction is
shown.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Calculate the maximum mass of ethanol that can be made from 56 g of ethene.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
H O
H C C
H O H
H O
H C C
H O H
[3]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Describe how you could show that ethanoic acid is a weaker acid than hydrochloric acid.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
H H O
H C C C H H H H
H H O C C C C H
H H H H
raw the structures of the carboxylic acid and alcohol from which this ester can be made.
D
Give the names of the carboxylic acid and alcohol.
[Total: 19]
olid copper(II) carbonate undergoes thermal decomposition. One of the products of the
5 (a) S
thermal decomposition is copper(II) oxide.
(i) State the colour change of the solid seen during the reaction.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
opper(II) carbonate reacts with dilute nitric acid. One of the products of the reaction is a
(b) C
solution of copper(II) nitrate.
(i) Describe tests for copper(II) ions and nitrate ions. Include the results of the tests.
copper(II) ions .....................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
nitrate ions............................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
[4]
Balance the chemical equation for the thermal decomposition of copper(II) nitrate.
(c) N itrogen dioxide, NO2, exists in equilibrium with dinitrogen tetroxide, N2O4.
Nitrogen dioxide is brown and dinitrogen tetroxide is colourless.
2NO2(g) N2O4(g)
brown colourless
end blocked
gas syringe
tate how the colour of the gas in the syringe changed. Explain your answer in terms of
S
the position of the equilibrium.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(ii) A
sealed tube containing nitrogen dioxide and dinitrogen tetroxide at equilibrium was
cooled in an ice bath at constant pressure. The contents of the tube became paler.
Suggest an explanation for this observation in terms of the position of the equilibrium.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 12]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(i) C
omplete the dot-and-cross diagram to show the electron arrangement in one of the
oxide ions present in aluminium oxide. Include the charge on the oxide ion.
One of the aluminium ions is shown.
3+ ........
Al O
[2]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
+ power –
supply
anodes wires
cathode
+ +
aluminium oxide
and cryolite
molten aluminium
(i) Name the type of particle responsible for the transfer of charge in
1 . .........................................................................................................................................
2 . .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(iii) Write the ionic half-equation for the formation of aluminium during the electrolysis.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(d) W
hen a piece of aluminium is placed in dilute hydrochloric acid, there is no immediate visible
reaction.
If the aluminium is left in the dilute hydrochloric acid for several hours, bubbles start to form.
Explain why aluminium does not react immediately with dilute hydrochloric acid.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 14]
(a) T
he rate of the reaction can be increased by increasing the concentration of the hydrochloric acid
or by heating it.
(i) In terms of collisions, explain why increasing the concentration of the hydrochloric acid
increases the rate of the reaction.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) In terms of collisions, explain why heating the hydrochloric acid increases the rate of the
reaction.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) (i) Calculate the number of moles of copper(II) oxide added to the hydrochloric acid.
rystals of hydrated copper(II) chloride were obtained from the solution at the end of the
(c) C
reaction.
The crystals had the following composition by mass: Cl, 41.52%; Cu, 37.43%; H, 2.34%;
O, 18.71%.
[Total: 11]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/41/O/N/17
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*9307337210*
CHEMISTRY 0620/42
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_42/4RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
(i) What term describes the random movement of the dust particles?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Identify the particles in the air which cause the random movement of the dust particles.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(b) When chlorine gas, Cl 2, is put into a gas jar, it spreads out to fill the gas jar.
When bromine gas, Br2, is put into a gas jar, it also spreads out to fill the gas jar.
gas jar
gas
start later
(i) What term describes the way that the gas particles spread out?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Use data from the Periodic Table to explain why bromine gas takes longer to fill a gas jar
than chlorine gas.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(iii) Explain why increasing the temperature increases the rate at which the gas particles
spread out.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 9]
2 (a) Complete the table to show the electronic structure of the atoms and ions.
electronic structure
F 2,7
Si
Ca2+
N3–
[3]
(b) Predict the formula of the compound formed between Ca2+ and N3–.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Draw a dot-and-cross diagram to show the electron arrangements in the two ions present in
lithium chloride, LiCl.
Show outer shell electrons only. Include the charges on the ions.
[3]
(d) Sulfur dichloride, SCl 2, is a covalent compound. It has the structure Cl –S–Cl.
[3]
(e) In terms of attractive forces, explain why LiCl has a higher melting point than SCl 2.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
(f) Suggest the identity of a covalent compound with a higher melting point than LiCl.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 14]
3 The chemical equation for the complete combustion of ethanol, C2H5OH, is shown.
The energy released when one mole of ethanol undergoes complete combustion is 1280 kJ.
X
C2H5OH + 3O2
energy
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) The chemical equation for the complete combustion of methanol, CH3OH, is shown.
2 H C O H + 3 O O 2 O C O + 4 H O H
Use the bond energies in the table to determine the energy change, ΔH, for the complete
combustion of one mole of methanol.
bond energy
bond
in kJ / mol
C–H 410
C–O 360
O–H 460
O=O 500
C=O 805
.............................. kJ
.............................. kJ
● energy change, ΔH, for the complete combustion of one mole of methanol
.............................. kJ / mol
[4]
(d) Dodecane is an alkane containing 12 carbon atoms. Ethanol can be manufactured from
dodecane in a two-stage process.
In stage 1, each molecule of dodecane is converted into three molecules of ethene and one
molecule of another hydrocarbon.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Write a chemical equation for the reaction which occurs in stage 1.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
[2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(iii) One disadvantage of fermentation is that the maximum concentration of ethanol produced
is about 15%.
Suggest why the concentration of ethanol produced by fermentation does not exceed
15%.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(v) Give one advantage, other than cost, of manufacturing ethanol by fermentation.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(vi) Suggest the name of a process to obtain ethanol from a mixture of ethanol and water.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
H H
H O C C O H
H H
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Ethane-1,2-diol can undergo condensation polymerisation but cannot undergo addition
polymerisation.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
O O
H O O H H O C C O H
ethane-1,2-diol molecule Y
[3]
(iv) Name the type of condensation polymer formed between ethane-1,2-diol and molecule Y.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 30]
bulb
wire
+ –
graphite electrodes
dilute aqueous
sodium chloride
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) The student observes bubbles of colourless gas forming at each electrode.
(i) Name the main gas produced at the positive electrode (anode).
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
test .......................................................................................................................................
result ....................................................................................................................................
[2]
(iii)
Write the ionic half-equation for the reaction taking place at the negative electrode
(cathode).
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(d)
The student replaces the dilute aqueous sodium chloride with concentrated aqueous
sodium chloride.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(e) The student has a small piece of impure copper. The main impurities in the copper are small
quantities of silver and zinc.
The student uses electrolysis to extract pure copper from the small piece of impure copper.
(i) Complete the labels on the diagram of the student’s electrolysis experiment.
electrolyte of
.......................................................
[3]
(ii) Use your knowledge of the reactivity series to suggest what happens to the silver and zinc
impurities. Explain your answers.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
[3]
[Total: 17]
● Explain, in terms of the position of the equilibrium, what you would see if sulfuric acid were
added to solution Y.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
● Explain, in terms of the position of the equilibrium, what you would see if sodium hydroxide
were added to solution Y.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
[5]
(b) Hydrogen can be manufactured using a reversible reaction between methane and steam.
At 900 °C, in the presence of a nickel catalyst, the yield of hydrogen is 70%.
(i) What volume of hydrogen is produced from 100 cm3 of methane under these conditions?
(ii) If the pressure is increased, the yield of hydrogen becomes less than 70%.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
What does this information indicate about the reaction between methane and steam?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 10]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2017
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/42/O/N/17
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*6479123383*
CHEMISTRY 0620/43
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_43/5RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
[Total: 4]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) The table shows the composition of four atoms or ions, A, B, C and D.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c)
Complete the table.
number of number of
protons electrons
Na
S2–
Cl 2
[3]
[Total: 11]
waste gases
raw materials:
coke,
iron ore,
limestone
air air
slag
molten iron
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [6]
(c) (i) Describe the bonding in iron. Include a diagram in your answer.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
hen iron(III) oxide is added to dilute sulfuric acid, an aqueous solution of iron(III) sulfate
(ii) W
is formed as one of the products.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(e) A
queous sodium hydroxide, aqueous potassium iodide and aqueous acidified
potassium manganate(VII) are added to aqueous solutions of iron(II) sulfate and
iron(III) sulfate.
aqueous acidified
no change
potassium manganate(VII)
[4]
[Total: 22]
4
Hydrogen and oxygen react together in a hydrogen fuel cell. A hydrogen fuel cell is shown in the
diagram.
hydrogen oxygen
H2 O2
electrolyte
water
membrane
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) (i) In a hydrogen fuel cell, the hydrogen molecules are converted into hydrogen ions, H+,
according to the ionic half-equation shown.
H2 2H+ + 2e–
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Write a chemical equation for the overall reaction that occurs in a hydrogen fuel cell.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) Hydrogen fuel cells are being developed as alternatives to petrol engines in cars.
(i) Give one advantage of hydrogen fuel cells compared to petrol engines.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Give one disadvantage of hydrogen fuel cells compared to petrol engines.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) S
ome fuel cells use ethanol, C2H5OH, instead of hydrogen. Carbon dioxide and water are
products of the reaction in an ethanol fuel cell.
(i) Write a chemical equation for the overall reaction occurring in an ethanol fuel cell.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) S
tate an environmental problem caused by the release of carbon dioxide into the
atmosphere.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Name the process by which ethanol can be manufactured from a renewable resource.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) Name the process occurring when electrical energy is used to break down an ionic compound.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
[Total: 11]
5 (a) (i) Name the products formed when sodium nitrate is heated.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) T
he chemical equation shows the equilibrium between dinitrogen tetroxide (N2O4, a colourless
gas) and nitrogen dioxide (NO2, a brown gas).
N2O4(g) 2NO2(g)
colourless brown
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) If the equilibrium mixture is heated at constant pressure, a darker brown colour is seen
inside the gas syringe.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(iii) S uggest what you would see if the pressure on the equilibrium mixture were increased at
constant temperature.
Explain your answer in terms of the position of the equilibrium.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 10]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
alkanes, ...............................................................................................................................
alkenes? ..............................................................................................................................
[2]
(iii) Other than having a general formula, state two characteristics of a homologous series.
1 . .........................................................................................................................................
2 . .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(iv) The structure of an alkene molecule with the molecular formula C4H8 is shown.
H H H H
C C C C H
H H H
raw the structure of a different alkene molecule with the molecular formula C4H8. Show
D
all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[1]
(v) W
hat term describes molecules with the same molecular formula but different structural
formulae?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) 2
5 cm3 of a gaseous hydrocarbon, CxHy, were burnt in 150 cm3 of oxygen. This was an excess
of oxygen.
fter cooling, the volume of the gases remaining was 100 cm3. This consisted of 75 cm3 of
A
carbon dioxide and 25 cm3 of unreacted oxygen. The water that was produced in the reaction
was liquid.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) What was the volume of oxygen that reacted with the hydrocarbon?
(iii) Complete the table to show the smallest whole number ratio of volumes.
volume of
volume of volume of
: : carbon dioxide
hydrocarbon reacted oxygen reacted
produced
smallest whole
number ratio of : :
volumes
[1]
(iv) U
se your answer to (b)(iii) to balance the chemical equation. Deduce the formula of the
hydrocarbon.
[Total: 12]
7 (a) C
arbon and silicon are elements in Group IV of the Periodic Table.
Carbon dioxide from the air moves into green plants and is converted into carbohydrates.
(i) N
ame the process by which carbon dioxide molecules move through the air into green
plants.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
xplain why silicon(IV) oxide cannot move through the air in the same way that
(ii) E
carbon dioxide can.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) N
ame the process by which carbon dioxide is converted into glucose, C6H12O6, in green
plants. Give two conditions required for this process to occur. Write a chemical equation
for the reaction which occurs.
condition 1 ...........................................................................................................................
condition 2 ...........................................................................................................................
(i) What type of polymerisation occurs when glucose is converted into starch?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) What type of reaction occurs when starch is converted into glucose?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
O O O O
Complete the diagram below to represent the structure of the glucose monomer.
[1]
[Total: 10]
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
© UCLES 2017
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
12
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/43/O/N/17
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*8318292337*
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_51/FP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 You are going to investigate what happens to the temperature when two different solids, W and X,
dissolve in water.
Instructions
You are going to carry out two experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
time / s 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
temperature of
the solution / °C
[2]
(b) Experiment 2
● mpty the polystyrene cup and rinse it with water. Put the polystyrene cup back into the
E
250 cm3 beaker.
● Use a measuring cylinder to pour 30 cm3 of distilled water into the polystyrene cup.
● Measure the initial temperature of the water and record it in the table at time = 0 seconds.
● Add all of solid X to the water, start the timer and stir the solution continuously with the
thermometer.
● Measure the temperature of the solution every 10 seconds for 90 seconds.
● Record your results in the table.
time / s 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
temperature of
the solution / °C
[2]
(c) Plot your results for Experiments 1 and 2 on the grid. Draw two smooth line graphs.
Clearly label your lines.
45
40
35
30
25
temperature of
the solution / °C
20
15
10
0
0 20 40 60 80 100
time / s
[4]
(d) (i)
From your graph, deduce the temperature of the solution in Experiment 1 after 15 seconds.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. °C [2]
(ii)
From your graph, deduce the time taken for the temperature of the solution in Experiment 2
to change by 6 °C from the initial temperature.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. s [2]
(e) U
se your results to identify the type of energy change that occurs when solid X dissolves in
water.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) Predict the temperature of the solution in Experiment 2 after 1 hour. Explain your answer.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(g) State two sources of error in these experiments. Give one improvement to reduce each of
these sources of error.
improvement 1 ............................................................................................................................
improvement 2 ............................................................................................................................
[4]
(h) When carrying out the experiments, what would be a disadvantage of taking the temperature
readings only every 30 seconds?
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 19]
tests on solution Y
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) (i) A dd a few drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide to the first portion of solution Y and shake
the test-tube to mix the solutions.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) P
our the mixture from (b)(ii) into a boiling tube and add a small piece of aluminium foil.
Heat the mixture carefully. Test the gas produced with indicator paper.
Record your observations.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
tests on solution Z
(c) T
est the pH of the first portion of solution Z.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) (i) A dd a few drops of aqueous copper(II) sulfate to the second portion of solution Z.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(e) To the third portion of solution Z, add the second portion of solution Y.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 15]
3 Washing soda crystals are crystals of hydrated sodium carbonate, Na2CO3.10H2O. When exposed
to the air, some of the water is lost from the crystals and a new substance is formed. This process
occurs faster in hotter climates.
Plan an experiment to determine the percentage of water by mass present in the new substance.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced will turn
gently and test for the presence of acidified aqueous potassium
sulfur dioxide manganate(VII) from purple to
colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt., or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper(II) (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/52
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_52/4RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 You are going to investigate what happens when two different solids, S and T, dissolve in water.
Instructions
You are going to carry out two experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
● epeat the procedure using the 3.0 g sample of solid S. Record your results in the
R
appropriate row of the table.
● Repeat the procedure using the 5.0 g sample of solid S. Record your results in the
appropriate row of the table.
3.0
5.0
[2]
(b) Experiment 2
3.0
4.0
6.0
[2]
(c) P
lot your results for Experiment 1 (maximum temperature) and Experiment 2 (minimum
temperature) on the grid. Draw two straight lines of best fit.
Clearly label your lines.
60
50
40
temperature of
the solution / °C
30
20
10
0
0.0 1.0 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0
mass of solid / g
[4]
(d) (i)
From your graph, deduce the maximum temperature of the solution if 6.0 g of solid S
were added to 30 cm3 of distilled water.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. °C [2]
(ii)
From your graph, deduce the minimum temperature of the solution if 4.5 g of solid T were
added to 30 cm3 of distilled water.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. °C [2]
(e) U
se your results to identify the type of energy change that occurs when solid S dissolves in
water.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) Suggest one change you could make to the experiments to obtain more accurate results.
Explain how this change would make the results more accurate.
change ........................................................................................................................................
explanation .................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(h) E
xplain how the temperatures measured would be different if Experiment 1 were repeated
using 60 cm3 of distilled water in each case.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 18]
tests on solid U
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
dd about half of solid U to about 5 cm3 of distilled water in a test-tube. Stopper the test-tube and
A
shake it to dissolve solid U and form solution U.
Divide solution U into two equal portions in two test-tubes and carry out the following tests.
(b) To the first portion of solution U, add about 1 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid.
Test the gas produced.
Record your observations.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
Keep the second portion of solution U for the test in (g)(i).
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) C
arry out a flame test on solid U.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
tests on solid W
dd about half of solid W to about 5 cm3 of distilled water in a test-tube. Stopper the test-tube and
A
shake it to dissolve solid W and form solution W.
Divide solution W into two equal portions in two test-tubes and carry out the following tests.
(f) To the first portion of solution W, add a few drops of dilute nitric acid and about 1 cm3 of
aqueous silver nitrate.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(g) (i) To the second portion of solution W, add the second portion of solution U.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(ii) Now add an excess of dilute hydrochloric acid to the mixture from (g)(i).
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 16]
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced will turn
gently and test for the presence of acidified aqueous potassium
sulfur dioxide manganate(VII) from purple to
colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt., or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper(II) (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/53
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_53/4RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 You are going to investigate what happens to the temperature when two different solids, W and X,
dissolve in water.
Instructions
You are going to carry out two experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
time / s 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
temperature of
the solution / °C
[2]
(b) Experiment 2
● mpty the polystyrene cup and rinse it with water. Put the polystyrene cup back into the
E
250 cm3 beaker.
● Use a measuring cylinder to pour 30 cm3 of distilled water into the polystyrene cup.
● Measure the initial temperature of the water and record it in the table at time = 0 seconds.
● Add all of solid X to the water, start the timer and stir the solution continuously with the
thermometer.
● Measure the temperature of the solution every 10 seconds for 90 seconds.
● Record your results in the table.
time / s 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
temperature of
the solution / °C
[2]
(c) Plot your results for Experiments 1 and 2 on the grid. Draw two smooth line graphs.
Clearly label your lines.
45
40
35
30
25
temperature of
the solution / °C
20
15
10
0
0 20 40 60 80 100
time / s
[4]
(d) (i)
From your graph, deduce the temperature of the solution in Experiment 1 after 15 seconds.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. °C [2]
(ii)
From your graph, deduce the time taken for the temperature of the solution in Experiment 2
to change by 6 °C from the initial temperature.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. s [2]
(e) U
se your results to identify the type of energy change that occurs when solid X dissolves in
water.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) Predict the temperature of the solution in Experiment 2 after 1 hour. Explain your answer.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(g) State two sources of error in these experiments. Give one improvement to reduce each of
these sources of error.
improvement 1 ............................................................................................................................
improvement 2 ............................................................................................................................
[4]
(h) When carrying out the experiments, what would be a disadvantage of taking the temperature
readings only every 30 seconds?
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 19]
tests on solution Y
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) (i) A dd a few drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide to the first portion of solution Y and shake
the test-tube to mix the solutions.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) P
our the mixture from (b)(ii) into a boiling tube and add a small piece of aluminium foil.
Heat the mixture carefully. Test the gas produced with indicator paper.
Record your observations.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
tests on solution Z
(c) T
est the pH of the first portion of solution Z.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) (i) A dd a few drops of aqueous copper(II) sulfate to the second portion of solution Z.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(e) To the third portion of solution Z, add the second portion of solution Y.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 15]
3 Washing soda crystals are crystals of hydrated sodium carbonate, Na2CO3.10H2O. When exposed
to the air, some of the water is lost from the crystals and a new substance is formed. This process
occurs faster in hotter climates.
Plan an experiment to determine the percentage of water by mass present in the new substance.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced will turn
gently and test for the presence of acidified aqueous potassium
sulfur dioxide manganate(VII) from purple to
colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt., or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper(II) (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_61/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
1 A student reacted dilute hydrochloric acid with zinc oxide to prepare zinc chloride solution.
The diagram shows part of the procedure.
zinc chloride
solution
unreacted
zinc oxide
funnel
.........................................
(b)
Which of the reactants was in excess?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) (i)
Name the separation process this apparatus is used for.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(d) Describe how crystals of zinc chloride could be obtained from the zinc chloride solution.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
[Total: 7]
2
A student investigated the rate of reaction between dilute hydrochloric acid and aqueous
sodium thiosulfate. When these chemicals react they form a precipitate which makes the solution
go cloudy. The formation of this precipitate can be used to show how fast the reaction proceeds.
eye
Experiment 1
● sing a measuring cylinder, 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate were poured into a conical
U
flask. The initial temperature of the solution was measured. The conical flask was placed on a
sheet of paper with words printed on it.
● Using a measuring cylinder, 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid were added to the solution in the
conical flask and a stopclock was started.
● The time taken for the printed words to disappear from view was measured.
● The final temperature of the mixture was measured.
Experiment 2
● sing a measuring cylinder, 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate were poured into a conical
U
flask. The solution was heated to about 30 °C and the temperature was measured. The conical
flask was placed on a sheet of paper with words printed on it.
● Using a measuring cylinder, 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid were added to the solution in the
conical flask and a stopclock was started.
● The time taken for the printed words to disappear from view was measured.
● The final temperature of the mixture was measured.
Experiment 3
● xperiment 2 was repeated but the 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate were heated to about
E
40 °C before adding the dilute hydrochloric acid.
Experiment 4
● xperiment 2 was repeated but the 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate were heated to about
E
50 °C before adding the dilute hydrochloric acid.
Experiment 5
● xperiment 2 was repeated but the 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate were heated to about
E
60 °C before adding the dilute hydrochloric acid.
(a) Calculate the average temperatures and record them in the table.
Use the stopclock diagrams to record the times in the table.
1 19 17 45 15 5 15
10
minutes
30
0
0
2 32 30 45 15 5 15
10
30
0
0
3 42 40 45 15 5 15
10
30
0
0
4 54 52 45 15 5 15
10
30
0
0
5 65 61 45 15 5 15
10
30
[3]
(b) Plot the results of Experiments 1–5 on the grid. Draw a smooth line graph.
240
210
180
150
time taken
for the
printed
words to 120
disappear
from view / s
90
60
30
0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80
average temperature / °C
[4]
(c) From your graph, deduce the time taken for the printed words to disappear from view when
Experiment 2 was repeated at an initial temperature of 73 °C. The final temperature of the
mixture was 71 °C.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
(d) Sketch on the grid the graph you would expect if all of the experiments were repeated using
a more dilute solution of aqueous sodium thiosulfate. [1]
(e) (i) In which experiment, 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5, was the rate of reaction greatest?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Explain, in terms of particles, why the rate of reaction was greatest in this experiment.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
[Total: 18]
3 Two solid salts, F and G, were analysed. Solid F was iron(III) nitrate.
Tests were carried out on each solid.
tests on solid F
Solid F was dissolved in distilled water to produce solution F. Solution F was divided into three
equal portions in three test-tubes.
(a) (i) A
few drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide were added to the first portion of solution F until
a change was seen.
(ii) An excess of aqueous sodium hydroxide was then added to the mixture from (a)(i).
observations................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) An excess of aqueous ammonia was added to the second portion of solution F until a change
was seen.
observations.......................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Aluminium foil and aqueous sodium hydroxide were added to the third portion of solution F.
The mixture was heated and the gas which was produced was tested.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
tests on solid G
test 1
test 2
The gas produced was passed through limewater. limewater turned milky
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 9]
4 Iron, tin and zinc all react with dilute hydrochloric acid to produce hydrogen.
Plan an experiment to determine the order of reactivity of iron, tin and zinc.
You are provided with powdered samples of the metals and common laboratory apparatus.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/62
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_62/4RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
.........................................
mineral wool magnesium ribbon
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) (i) Use two arrows to show two places where heat is applied. [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) (i) Complete the diagram to show how the hydrogen produced could be collected and its
volume measured. Label your diagram. [2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(e) Suggest why the tube containing the magnesium cracks after the reaction.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 8]
2 A student investigated what happened when two different solids, S and T, dissolved in water.
Experiment 1
● sing a measuring cylinder, 30 cm3 of distilled water were poured into a polystyrene cup. The
U
initial temperature of the water was measured.
● 2.0 g of solid S were added to the polystyrene cup and the solution was stirred with a
thermometer.
● The maximum temperature of the solution was measured.
● The solution was poured away and the polystyrene cup was rinsed out with distilled water.
(a) Use the thermometer diagrams to record the temperatures in the table.
30 40
2.0 25 35
20 30
30 40
3.0 25 35
20 30
30 55
5.0 25 50
20 45
[2]
Experiment 2
● xperiment 1 was repeated using 2.0 g, 3.0 g, 4.0 g and 6.0 g of solid T. The minimum
E
temperature of the solution was measured in each case.
(b) Use the thermometer diagrams to record the temperatures in the table.
30 25
2.0 25 20
20 15
30 20
3.0 25 15
20 10
30 20
4.0 25 15
20 10
30 20
6.0 25 15
20 10
[2]
(c) P
lot the results of Experiment 1 (maximum temperature) and Experiment 2 (minimum
temperature) on the grid. Draw two straight lines of best fit.
Clearly label your lines.
70
60
50
40
temperature of
the solution / °C
30
20
10
0
0.0 1.0 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0 7.0
mass of solid / g
[4]
(d) (i) From your graph, deduce the maximum temperature of the solution if 6.0 g of solid S
were added to 30 cm3 of distilled water.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. °C [2]
(ii)
From your graph, deduce the minimum temperature of the solution if 4.5 g of solid T were
added to 30 cm3 of distilled water.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. °C [2]
(e) Use the results to identify the type of energy change that occurs when solid S dissolves in
water.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) Suggest one change you could make to the experiments to obtain more accurate results.
Explain how this change would make the results more accurate.
change ........................................................................................................................................
explanation .................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(h) E
xplain how the temperatures measured would be different if Experiment 1 were repeated
using 60 cm3 of distilled water in each case.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 18]
3
Two solid salts, U and W, were analysed. Solid U was sodium carbonate.
Tests were carried out on each solid.
tests on solid U
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
About half of solid U was dissolved in distilled water to produce solution U. Solution U was divided
into two equal portions in two test-tubes.
(b) Dilute hydrochloric acid was added to the first portion of solution U.
The gas produced was tested.
observations ...............................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
observations.......................................................................................................................... [1]
tests on solid W
test 1
Dilute nitric acid and aqueous silver nitrate were added white precipitate formed
to the first portion of solution W.
test 2
The second portion of solution U was added to the white precipitate formed
second portion of solution W.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 8]
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/63
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB17 11_0620_63/3RP
© UCLES 2017 [Turn over
2
.........................................
.........................................
dilute
acid
cerussite
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) What is the general name given to an insoluble solid left on a filter paper after filtration?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) Suggest how a sample of lead could be obtained from the solution of lead(II) nitrate.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 7]
2 A student investigated what happened to the temperature when two different solids, W and X,
dissolved in water.
Experiment 1
● sing a measuring cylinder, 30 cm3 of distilled water were poured into a polystyrene cup. The
U
initial temperature of the water was measured at time = 0 seconds.
● Solid W was added to the water, a timer was started and the solution was stirred with a
thermometer.
● The temperature of the solution was measured every 10 seconds for 90 seconds.
(a) Use the thermometer diagrams to record the temperatures in the table.
time / s 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
30 20 20 20 20 15 15 15 15 15
thermometer
25 15 15 15 15 10 10 10 10 10
diagram
20 10 10 10 10 5 5 5 5 5
temperature of
the solution / °C
[2]
Experiment 2
(b) Use the thermometer diagrams to record the temperatures in the table.
time / s 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
30 30 30 35 35 35 40 40 40 40
thermometer
25 25 25 30 30 30 35 35 35 35
diagram
20 20 20 25 25 25 30 30 30 30
temperature of
the solution / °C
[2]
(c) Plot the results for Experiments 1 and 2 on the grid. Draw two smooth line graphs.
Clearly label your lines.
40
30
temperature of
the solution / °C
20
10
0
0 20 40 60 80 100
time / s
[4]
(d) (i) From your graph, deduce the temperature of the solution in Experiment 1 after 15 seconds.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
............................. °C [2]
(ii) From your graph, deduce the time taken for the temperature of the solution in Experiment 2
to change by 6 °C from the initial temperature.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
............................. s [2]
(e) U
se the results to identify the type of energy change that occurs when solid X dissolves in
water.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) Predict the temperature of the solution in Experiment 2 after 1 hour. Explain your answer.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(g) State two sources of error in these experiments. Give one improvement to reduce each of
these sources of error.
improvement 1 ............................................................................................................................
improvement 2 ............................................................................................................................
[4]
(h) When carrying out the experiments, what would be a disadvantage of taking the temperature
readings only every 30 seconds?
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 19]
tests on solution Y
The solution was divided into two equal portions in two test-tubes.
(a) (i) A
few drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide were added to the first portion of solution Y and
the test-tube shaken to mix the solutions.
(ii) An excess of aqueous sodium hydroxide was then added to the mixture.
observations................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) The mixture from (a)(ii) was poured into a boiling tube and a small piece of aluminium foil
was added.
The mixture was heated and the gas produced was tested.
observations.........................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [3]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
tests on solution Z
test 1
test 2
test 3
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 8]
4 Washing soda crystals are crystals of hydrated sodium carbonate, Na2CO3.10H2O. When exposed
to the air, some of the water is lost from the crystals and a new substance is formed. This process
occurs faster in hotter climates.
Plan an experiment to determine the percentage of water by mass present in the new substance.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/12
Multiple Choice (Core)
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 C 21 A
2 B 22 A
3 C 23 B
4 D 24 A
5 B 25 A
6 C 26 B
7 C 27 C
8 A 28 B
9 C 29 C
10 A 30 C
11 C 31 A
12 A 32 B
13 B 33 C
14 B 34 D
15 B 35 D
16 A 36 B
17 B 37 C
18 B 38 A
19 C 39 B
20 D 40 B
General comments
Performance on the paper was generally good; some candidates found parts of the paper more difficult.
Candidates found Questions 26 and 29 straightforward. Questions 8, 18 and 24 were more challenging for
many candidates.
The following responses were common wrong answers to the questions listed.
Question 1
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 12
Response C – Candidates knew that the reaction would speed up but did not realise that the loss of carbon
dioxide results in mass decrease.
Question 18
Response C – This response was far more popular than the correct response. Candidates did not realise
that copper metal does not react with dilute sulfuric acid.
Question 19
Response B – Candidates knew that the proton number was used to order elements but were unclear about
the trends in each group.
Question 24
Response B – This response was much more popular than the correct one. Candidates correctly used the
reaction with acid but did not know the effect of reactivity on the stability of metal oxides when heated with
carbon.
Question 30
Response A – Candidates did not know that argon was present in the air and many did not recognise the
significance of the word ‘clean’.
Question 31
Response D – Candidates recognised two compounds that are fertilisers but did not realise that phosphorus
was necessary.
Question 34
Response C – Candidates correctly ignored the neutral plot but did not always understand the relationship
between pH and acidity.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/22
Multiple Choice (Extended)
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 A 21 C
2 C 22 A
3 B 23 D
4 C 24 B
5 A 25 C
6 A 26 B
7 A 27 C
8 C 28 C
9 C 29 C
10 B 30 D
11 C 31 A
12 A 32 B
13 B 33 B
14 C 34 D
15 B 35 A
16 A 36 D
17 C 37 C
18 A 38 A
19 B 39 D
20 B 40 B
General comments
Most candidates found Questions 3, 4, 18, 24, 27, 29, 32 and 36 straightforward. Question 20 was
challenging for many candidates.
The following responses were popular wrong answers to the questions listed.
Question 9
Response B – Candidates did not realise that when copper electrodes are used the anode dissolves away
and no gas is released. This reaction is the basis of copper refining.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 15
Response D – Many candidates were not familiar with the reactions of silver halides in light.
Question 16
Response C – Candidates knew that the energy of molecules increases but did not realise that this also
means they move faster and so collide more frequently.
Question 20
Response C – This response was more popular than the correct one. Candidates did not realise that copper
metal does not react with dilute sulfuric acid.
Question 21
Response D – Candidates knew that the proton number was used to order the elements but were unclear
about the trends of melting points in the two groups.
Question 23
Response C – Candidates knew the trend in reactivity in Group I but not in Group VII.
Question 25
Response B – Candidates were looking for a reaction which showed the extraction of aluminium and many
did not realise that the answer chosen does not occur in the extraction of aluminium.
Question 28
Response B – Many candidates chose –153 as the lowest boiling point when in fact, it is the highest.
Question 34
Response C – Candidates correctly ignored the neutral plot but did not always understand the relationship
between pH and acidity.
Question 40
Response A – This response was more popular than the correct one. Many candidates did not check that the
correct groups were opposite each other.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/32
Theory (Core)
Key messages
• Many candidates need more practice in memorising qualitative tests for specific ions and molecules.
• Some candidates would benefit from improving their knowledge of specific chemical terms. The terms
mixture, compound, elements and molecule were often used interchangeably.
• Some candidates need more practice in answering questions requiring free response and in organising
their work. Candidates should take note of each bullet point in a question to ensure that all relevant
points have been answered.
• A few candidates selected more than one answer for a question and so could not gain credit.
General comments
Many candidates tackled this paper well, showing a good knowledge of core Chemistry. Nearly all
candidates were entered at the appropriate level. The standard of English was generally good. A few of the
questions were left unanswered by a minority of candidates.
Some candidates need more practice in writing answers with the correct amount of detail for core level.
Some candidates disadvantaged themselves by including material from the supplement. For example, in
Questions 2(c)(i) and 6(b)(iii) answering the questions about oxidation and reduction in terms of either
electron loss/gain or change in oxidation number often led to incorrect answers. In contrast, some candidates
wrote too much and repeated themselves, sometimes resulting in writing contradictory statements. For
example, in Question 7(a) some candidates first wrote that water is a product of the reaction of calcium
oxide with acid and then wrote in another place that the product was hydrogen.
Many candidates needed to show a better understanding of qualitative tests for specific ions and molecules.
The answers to the questions about the tests for oxygen (1(c)), chloride ions (2(a)(iv)) and carbonate ions
(8(b)(ii)) were often incorrect.
Many candidates were able to extract information from tables and balance symbol equations.
Questions involving general Chemistry including, electrolysis, atomic structure and many aspects of simple
organic chemistry were answered well by many candidates.
Question 1
(a) (i) Many candidates identified oxygen as a diatomic molecule. The most common error was to
suggest the interhalogen compound (compound D). Compound C (carbon dioxide), was also a
common error.
(ii) A majority of the candidates correctly identified sodium bromide. The most common error was to
suggest compound B (dibromoethane).
(iii) A majority of the candidates recognised that oxygen is an element. The most common errors were
to suggest either compound A (sodium bromide) or compound B (dibromoethane).
(iv) Nearly all the candidates recognised that carbon dioxide is a product of respiration. The most
common incorrect answer was substance E (oxygen).
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(v) This was the least well answered question in (a). The most common incorrect answers were to
suggest either compound B (dibromoethane) or the interhalogen compound (compound D).
(b) Most candidates gained at least partial credit. The most common errors were: 17 protons; 8 or 17
neutrons; 9 electrons. A few candidates added the atomic number to the mass number when
calculating the number of neutrons.
(c) Stronger responses described the correct test for oxygen involving the relighting of a glowing splint.
However, many just mentioned the use of either a splint (unqualified) or a lighted splint. Others
reversed the test and suggested that a lighted splint glows. Many suggested the use of a flame test
or litmus.
Question 2
(a) (i) A majority of candidates calculated the relative molecular mass of ethanol correctly. The most
common errors related to the use of atomic numbers rather than atomic masses or to some type of
mole calculation involving the relative atomic mass of calcium. The most common of these
incorrect answers was 6.4 mg obtained by (20 × 40) ÷ 125.
(ii) Many candidates correctly identified potassium ions. The most common error was to suggest
calcium ions. A significant number of candidates suggested substances that did not appear in the
table, e.g. lithium ions, water.
(iii) Some candidates gave the correct name (magnesium sulfate). Others either gave the formula or
gave incorrect names. The most common of these was magnesium sulfur oxide. A small number of
candidates ignored the sulfur and incorrectly suggested that the compound was magnesium oxide.
(iv) A minority of candidates gave a completely correct description of a test for chloride ions. Some
confused this test with the test for chlorine and suggested the use of litmus paper. Others
suggested that a flame test be used. Many did not mention the use of nitric acid or gave the wrong
acid, often hydrochloric acid. Another incorrect test reagent often given was sodium hydroxide.
(b) (i) A majority of the candidates identified the carboxylic acid group correctly. The most common error
was to circle only the C=O group.
(ii) Some candidates deduced the correct formula of lactic acid. A significant number of candidates did
not count the atoms correctly. The most common errors were either to reduce the number of
carbon or hydrogen atoms by one, e.g. C2H6O3 or to write a partial molecular formula, e.g.
C3H5O2OH.
(c) (i) Some candidates gave a good explanation of reduction in terms of removal of oxygen. Others gave
a correct explanation in terms of gain of electrons. A significant number of candidates who chose
the electron route incorrectly suggested that electrons are lost. Many candidates gave answers
which were too vague or confusing, e.g. ‘to decrease the number of something’ or ‘reduction of
oxygen’.
(ii) Many candidates calculated the relative molecular mass of ethanol correctly. The most common
errors involved either incorrect addition or the use of atomic number instead of atomic mass.
Question 3
(a) Many candidates gained at least partial credit for this question. Some candidates gave well-written
answers mentioning diffusion and including the (overall) movement of particles from a higher
concentration to a lower concentration. However, others made vague statements about the colour
spreading out or the iodine dissolving without mentioning particles. Some candidates only wrote
about the process of dissolving and did not mention the spreading of the particles throughout the
liquid.
(b) (i) This was answered well by many candidates and most gained at least partial credit. The most
common error was to give an incorrect value for the melting point, usually above –7°C. A few
candidates did not respond to this question.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(ii) Many candidates suggested that fluorine is lighter in colour intensity than chlorine but few gave the
correct trend in colour of the halogens. The most common errors were either trying to relate the
colour intensity to the melting point or trying to relate colour intensity to reactivity.
(iii) Many candidates realised that bromine is liquid at 40°C. Fewer gave a complete explanation for
this in terms of both melting point and boiling point. Many just repeated the values of the melting
point and boiling point without referring to 40°C. Others referred to room temperature instead of
40°C. A significant minority thought that the bromine should be in the solid state.
(c) Nearly all candidates gained at least partial credit for balancing the equation. The most common
error was to suggest 2Br or Br instead of Br2.
Question 4
(a) A minority of candidates selected both correct statements about a homologous series but nearly all
the candidates selected one correct statement. The most common error was to tick the second box
from the top (similar physical properties). A few candidates ticked only one box.
(b) Most candidates gave the correct answer ‘alkane’. The most common errors were either ‘anes’ or
‘alkene’. A few candidates just repeated the word ‘hydrocarbon’ which was in the stem of the
question.
(c) Stronger responses gave a suitable definition of a hydrocarbon including the words ‘compound’
and ‘only’ in their answers. However, most candidates gave vague or incorrect answers such as ‘it
contains hydrogen and carbon molecules’. A significant number of candidates suggested that
hydrocarbons are mixtures or elements. Many forgot the important words ‘only’ or ‘no other
substance’.
(d) Many candidates drew the correct structure of ethane. The most common errors were either
leaving off one or more hydrogen atoms or drawing the structure of methane or the addition of a
C=C bond. Some candidates drew a dot-and-cross diagram but these were not always correct.
(e) (i) Most candidates gave at least one correct condition for cracking. ‘High temperature’ or ‘heat’ was
the most common correct answer. A few candidates did not gain credit because they suggested
‘temperature’ or ‘pressure’ unqualified. Some candidates gave values but either did not put a unit
such as °C, or gave a unit which did not fit, e.g. ‘5 Pascal’s instead of ‘5 atmospheres’ and so
could not be credited.
(ii) Most candidates gave the correct molecular formula. Common errors included C11H26, C2H6 and
C6H12.
(f) A wide variety of incorrect answers was seen, suggesting that many candidates were unfamiliar
with this reaction. The most common incorrect answers were carbon dioxide and alcohol. Ethane,
oxygen, acid and glucose were other common incorrect answers.
(g) Most candidates gained partial credit and many gained full credit for ‘monomers’ and ‘addition’ in
the correct places. The most common incorrect answer was to give ‘polymers’ instead of
‘monomers’. Only a few candidates suggested ‘condensation’ instead of ‘addition’.
Question 5
(a) (i) Many candidates answered well and referred to the fact that the magnesium floated (on top of the
magnesium chloride). The most common errors were to refer to the intensity of the grey colour in
the diagram, to refer to reactivity or to refer to the cathode.
(ii) Many candidates correctly identified chlorine. The most common error was to suggest ‘chloride’.
Other common errors were oxygen or hydrogen.
(iii) Many candidates wrote imprecise or incorrect answers as to why air is not blown over the molten
magnesium such as ‘the air can combine with the atmosphere’ or ‘air can react with the
magnesium chloride’.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(iv) Many candidates identified a suitable unreactive gas and argon was the most common correct
answer. The most common incorrect answers were hydrogen, oxygen or carbon dioxide. A few
candidates gave chlorine or bromine.
(b) (i) Most candidates identified aluminium and most of these referred to its low density. The most
common incorrect answer was to refer to the strength of aluminium. A minority of candidates gave
cobalt instead of aluminium. A few candidates disadvantaged themselves by suggesting that
aluminium is less dense than air.
(ii) Some candidates correctly identified aluminium but a significant number gave ‘cobalt’ and referred
to its strength or high melting point.
(iii) Many candidates realised that cobalt and nickel are transition elements. The most common
incorrect answer was gallium.
(c) Most candidates gave at least one correct property associated with transition elements and many
gave two correct properties. The most common error was to suggest general metallic properties
such as lustre and electrical conductivity.
(d) (i) Some candidates gave a good definition of an alloy. Others made no mention of a mixture or used
incorrect terminology such as ‘a compound of two different metals’. A significant number of
candidates either suggested that ‘an alloy is a mixture of elements’ or ‘a mixture of non-metals’. A
few just gave the name of an alloy.
(ii) A minority of the candidates referred to the alloy being stronger or harder than the corresponding
metals. Many did not use the comparative, e.g. ‘alloys are strong’, ‘alloys are light’ and so could not
be credited. Others gave answers which were too vague, e.g. ‘shows the properties of both metals’.
Question 6
(a) (i) Some candidates identify methane as the main component of natural gas. Others gave incorrect
answers such as carbon dioxide or carbon monoxide. Water, ethene and nitrogen were other
incorrect answers which were occasionally given.
(ii) This was generally well answered and most candidates referred to ‘making the reaction faster’. The
most common error was reference to ‘slows down the reaction’. A few candidates did not refer to
rate.
(b) (i) Many candidates were able to name sulfuric acid. The most common error was sulfur dioxide. A
significant number of candidates wrote the formula (often incorrectly as H2SO3) instead of the
name.
(ii) A minority of the candidates gave a suitable effect of acid rain on buildings. Many referred to
changing the colour or damaging paintwork. Others gave answers which were too vague or too
drastic, e.g. ‘reacts with them’, ‘damages them’, ‘destroys them’, ‘makes them weak’.
(iii) Some candidates explained oxidation by referring to the addition of oxygen to sulfur dioxide. Others
either gave a generalised definition of oxidation or referred to the nitrogen dioxide rather than sulfur
dioxide. A few candidates gave answers which were too vague, e.g. ‘the sulfur dioxide goes to
sulfur trioxide’. A significant number of candidates tried to answer in terms of electron transfer or
changes in oxidation number. Many of these answers were incorrect because they referred to
sulfur dioxide as a whole rather than the sulfur.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 7
(a) Many candidates answered this question well. Some candidates did not write about the effect of
acids on a named indicator or only wrote about the effect of acids on either calcium oxide or
magnesium. Many candidates repeated themselves and sometimes wrote conflicting statements.
Common errors included: carbon dioxide, hydrogen or hydroxide being formed when calcium oxide
reacts with hydrochloric acid; water being formed when magnesium reacts with hydrochloric acid;
red litmus being used as an indicator. Some candidates attempted to write symbol equations for
the reactions rather than word equations. The products of these symbol equations were accepted if
they were correct but the formulae of the chlorides were often incorrectly written as CaCl and
MgCl.
(b) (i) Some candidates correctly identified the reaction as ‘neutralisation’. Other answers were either
vague, e.g. ‘acid-base’ or incorrect, e.g. ‘endothermic’. A few candidates wrote an equation instead
of naming the type of reaction.
(ii) Most candidates suggested the correct pH of 13. The most common error was to suggest pH 2. A
significant number of candidates chose pH 7.
(iii) Some candidates correctly identified ammonia. A few candidates incorrectly suggested ammonium
or ammonium hydroxide. The most frequently seen error was to suggest hydrogen.
(iv) Many candidates selected the correct statement about sodium hydroxide. A common incorrect
answer was to select the third box down from the top (sodium boils between 319°C and 1 390°C).
(v) A minority of candidates explained why the ingredients used in medicines have to be pure. The
best answers referred to side-effects or stated ‘harms the body’. Many answers were vague, e.g.
‘doesn’t react in the body’ or made reference to melting or boiling points. Some candidates thought
that the question was about sodium hydroxide rather than medicines in general and wrote about
acid-base reactions of sodium hydroxide.
Question 8
(a) (i) Many candidates realised that the rate of reaction decreases when the concentration of
hydrochloric acid decreases. The most common errors were to write about time instead of rate or to
give answers which were not comparative, e.g. ‘the rate would be slow’.
(ii) Many candidates gave a reason for their answer although this was not required. Some candidates
incorrectly thought that the rate of reaction would increase because the surface area was greater.
A common error was to suggest that the rate of reaction does not change because there is the
same amount of iron present.
(iii) A majority of the candidates predicted that the rate would increase. The most common errors were
to write about time instead of rate or to give answers which were not comparative, e.g. ‘the rate
would be fast’.
(b) (i) Many candidates gave the correct name of an ore of iron other than siderite. The most common
errors were to suggest ‘bauxite’ or ‘limestone’.
(ii) Only the strongest responses gained full credit here. Many candidates referred to reactions in the
blast furnace. Some obtained partial credit for mentioning that carbon dioxide is released or for the
use of limewater. Others suggested that a white precipitate is formed when hydrochloric acid is
added. A significant number of candidates did not answer this question.
(c) Many candidates gave the correct order of reactivity. The most common error was to completely
reverse the order.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/42
Theory (Extended)
Key messages
• Candidates need to be reminded that if one property is asked for, as in Question 1(c)(iv), then no
more than one should be given in answers as any incorrect properties given will be viewed as a
contradiction to correct ones.
• If observations about a substance are asked for, such as silver chloride in Question 2(c)(i),
candidates should be made aware that substances should be described by (at least) two words. The
first word should be a colour (or colourless if applicable) and the second word should be the state.
• In calculation work, such as in Questions 2(c)(iv) and 4(b)(i), candidates should show their working
to allow credit for ‘error carried forward’ where this is relevant. Candidates should be advised to
include words indicating what they are attempting to do within their working, such as ‘number of
moles of ’.
• Candidates need to be reminded that a word equation, unless specifically asked for, will receive no
credit in place of a correct symbol chemical equation.
General comments
Candidates generally answered well and there was no evidence that there was insufficient time for
candidates to complete the paper.
Question 1
(a) (i)–(vi)
Most candidates could identify the majority of the gases asked for. It was noticeable that the term
‘diatomic molecule’ was not always known.
(b) (i) Nearly all candidates knew a covalent bond involved sharing electrons; only a very small minority
knew it involved sharing a pair of electrons.
(ii) The dot-and-cross diagram of NF3 was well known, with all but a few candidates showing three
shared pairs of electrons. Weaker responses tended not to show non-bonding electrons as pairs
and consequently some of the three F atoms had five or seven non-bonding electrons. These
candidates may have found it easier to count three pairs.
(c) (i) Many candidates tried to explain the meaning of mixture by using the words ‘mix’, ‘mixing’ or even
‘mixture’ in phrases such as ‘a mixture of substances’.
(iii) Many candidates wrote very detailed descriptions describing the fractional distillation of liquid air
including the extraction of carbon dioxide, water vapour and noble gases which were not asked for.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(iv) The idea of different boiling points being the key property which allows N2 and O2 to be separated
was well known. Some candidates include a second, incorrect property, such as differing densities,
and could not be credited.
Question 2
(ii) A number of candidates answered this question incorrectly, possibly because they misread the
question, as many incorrect responses included ‘17’ (the number of electrons in an atom), ‘7’ (the
number of electrons in an outer shell of an atom) and ‘8’ (the number of electrons in an outer shell
of an ion).
(iii) Argon, the correct response, was the most common answer seen, although neon was also a
popular response.
(b) (i) The definition of electrolysis was well known and some well learnt responses were seen.
Candidates need to be reminded that it is a breakdown (or decomposition) of a compound rather
than a separation process involving the formation of ions.
(ii) The three products of electrolysis of concentrated aqueous sodium chloride were well known,
although frequent incorrect responses included oxygen and occasionally, sodium.
(iii) The ionic half equation was known by many candidates; state symbols were frequently omitted or
were incorrect due to H+ ions being given as gaseous.
(c) (i) Candidates knew that solid silver chloride would form but often vague descriptions of observations
or even names of the solid product received no credit. In this case ‘white’ was usually omitted from
answers.
(ii) Candidates often focused on the collection of a pure residue, and the vague comment, ‘to remove
(soluble) impurities’ was frequently seen.
(iv) Some well set out and fully correct answers were seen. A common error was to miss out the final
90% step. In weaker responses, working out was poorly set out so that it could not be clearly
followed. Candidates should be advised to include words within their working.
(v) The equation for the thermal decomposition of sodium nitrate was not well known and NaNO2 was
rarely seen as the product. Instead, many unusual sodium-based products were seen. Many
candidates started with hydrated crystals and simply dehydrated them.
Question 3
(a) (i)–(vi)
This series of questions based upon the limestone cycle were answered well. Candidates found the
equation in (v) more challenging due to water either being omitted as a product or being substituted
by hydrogen.
(b) A minority of candidates could determine the formula of magnesium nitrate correctly with MgNO3
being a very common error. As there is effervescence between an acid and a carbonate,
candidates were expected to show the other two products as H2O and CO2 rather than H2CO3.
(c) Many candidates knew the method to follow and gained credit for division of the mass of the
element by its relative atomic mass. Some excessive rounding after the first step saw a significant
number of candidates end up with the wrong answer.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 4
(a) (i) Many candidates gave the correct definition; there were a number of vague and irrelevant
comments about properties of bases.
(ii) Many candidates opted to include water as a product. Partial credit was frequently awarded for
identifying the correct ammonium compound relative to the acid used in the reaction. Candidates
who chose to provide a chemical equation were rarely successful.
If candidates write word equations over two lines, they should avoid writing the word equation in
such a way as to introduce ambiguity.
This would be the expected way to write a word equation with the second word of a substance
appearing below the first word.
This introduces a substance which may be taken as having the name ‘ammonia chloride’.
(b) (i) Candidates needed to determine the number of moles of NH3 used and then use the stoichiometric
ratio seen in the equation to determine the number of moles of Cl 2 needed and finally convert this
value to a gas volume (in cm3) by multiplying by 24 000.
Some candidates tried a non-mole method based upon reacting masses and were usually
unsuccessful.
(ii)–(iii)
Many candidates successfully gained full credit in the calculation sections and went on to explain
why this reaction was exothermic, (i.e. more energy was released in bond formation than used in
bond breaking). Occasionally in (iii), candidates had the direction of energy change incorrect, (i.e.
more energy was used in bond formation than used in bond breaking or more energy was released
in bond formation than released in bond breaking).
(c) (i) Most candidates realised that NH3 was a reducing agent because it underwent oxidation. Stronger
responses were able to explain what the oxidation was in terms of electron loss or change in
oxidation state.
(ii) Platinum was probably the most often suggested metal as a catalyst from the list of five, but few
candidates gave the reason that platinum was the only transition element in the list. Many
candidates thought it was because platinum was (relatively) inert.
Question 5
(a) ‘Homologous series’ was almost always seen, although the occasional ‘functional group’ or just
‘homologous’ was seen.
(b) The general formula for alcohols is CnH2n+2O, although CnH2n+1OH was accepted.
(c) (i) Stronger responses stated that steam was the reagent needed under conditions of a catalyst, and
some even named the catalyst. Water, if seen with a temperature above 100°C as a condition, was
allowed as the reagent.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(ii) The equation for the combustion of propan-1-ol was often not done well. Many candidates wrote an
incorrect formula for propan-1-ol; oxygen was not always seen as a reactant and there were many
1
incorrect products such as alkanes. For those with the correct species, 5O2 instead of 4 O2 was
2
occasionally seen, possibly as a result of the oxygen atoms in the alcohol being ignored when
balancing.
(d) (i) The structure of the linkages tended to be correct but often continuation bonds were missing at the
end of the structure.
(ii) Although most candidates knew that the breakdown of carbohydrate polymers was an example of
hydrolysis, many opted for hydration. Catalytic cracking was another frequently seen error.
(iii) The conditions needed for the breakdown of carbohydrate polymers were known by only a small
number of candidates. If acid was used, heat would frequently be omitted and enzymes (if seen)
was frequently accompanied with impossible temperatures.
(e) (i)–(iv)
The responses to this series of questions showed candidates had a good understanding of
chromatography involving colourless solutes.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/52
Practical Test
Key messages
• Candidates should be familiar with the technique of carrying out a flame test.
• In qualitative analysis exercises, candidates must follow the instructions given and record all
observations.
• Candidates should be aware that the mark allocation reflects the number of valid points to be made
for parts of questions.
General comments
The majority of candidates successfully completed all questions and there was no evidence that candidates
were short of time. A range of marks was seen, with some candidates answering very well.
Supervisors’ results were submitted by the majority of Centres with the candidates’ scripts. Very few
comments were submitted by supervisors after carrying out the experiments. The results obtained by some
supervisors and candidates for Question 1 suggested that some Centres did not use reagents that were
close to the concentrations specified in the Confidential Instructions.
Question 1
(d) (i) Many candidates described the initial colour as orange instead of yellow and so could not be
awarded credit. Some candidates described the final colour as green or colourless.
(ii) A minority of candidates correctly answered with the observation that bubbles were formed. There
were a significant number who stated that the volume increased.
(e) This was generally answered well with Experiment 3 being the expected response.
(f) The majority of candidates answered the question correctly and named a burette or pipette. A
significant number thought a (graduated) beaker or a measuring cylinder, which they had just used,
would be more accurate.
(g) Many candidates mistakenly thought that changing the temperature would change the volumes of
dilute hydrochloric acid used. Stronger responses gained full credit for stating that there would be
no effect on the volume as warming the solution of sodium hydroxide would only affect the rate and
not change the volume or concentrations of the reactants.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(h) (i) This question was answered correctly by most candidates. Some candidates got the ratio the
wrong way round or did not follow the instruction ‘Determine the simplest whole number ratio’ and
gave fractions or ratios to one or two decimal places.
(ii) Many candidates gave incorrect references to solutions of different concentrations being used in
Experiments 1 and 3 and showed a lack of knowledge and understanding. Stronger responses
realised that the use of different indicators resulted in different volumes of dilute hydrochloric acid
being used.
(i) Many candidates thought that universal indicator was only a test paper and that testing would be
necessary after each addition of hydrochloric acid. References to pH were ignored. Other
candidates thought that universal indicator was colourless, or would not change colour or that it
would react with the mixture. However, stronger responses understood that there would be more
than one colour change and it would be difficult to find the end point.
(j) The idea that the reliability of the results could be checked by repeating the experiments was well
understood and scored partial credit. The mark allocation indicated that reference to comparing or
averaging the results obtained was also expected.
Some candidates wanted to repeat the experiments with different volumes or concentrations of
solutions and showed a lack of understanding, as did those who wanted to repeat them without
using an indicator.
Question 2
Tests on solution M
(a) (i) Most candidates correctly stated that the solution was yellow or brown. References to red/orange,
green or precipitate could not be credited.
(ii) This question was generally well answered but a few candidates gave pH values of 7 or more.
Solution M was acidic.
(b) The majority of candidates reported the formation of a yellow precipitate instead of a white
precipitate. This showed a lack of practical expertise and experience when carrying out the halide
test.
In coloured solutions, candidates needed to let the precipitate settle out to see the colour more
clearly. Some candidates gave two colours and could not be credited.
(c) Some candidates reported the formation of a white precipitate. A significant number of candidates
implied some sort of colour change or effervescence. This test for a sulfate should be negative and
responses such as no change, no reaction or no precipitate scored credit.
(d) The formation of a brown precipitate was often described. Yellow and red were common answers.
References to cloudy or solid formation instead of the term precipitate were ignored.
(e) Most candidates identified the presence of iron(III) ions but a number stated that iron(II) or just
iron ions were present. Most candidates identified the correct halide ion based on their observation
in (d).
Tests on solid N
(f) Most candidates correctly stated that the solid was green. References to a blue solid could not be
credited.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(g) At least four points were expected in answers to this question as indicated by the mark allocation.
The solid turning black and testing the gas with limewater, which turned milky, were common
creditworthy answers. A small number of candidates successfully noted the formation of liquid
drops or condensation on the walls of the test-tube; answers such as gas, vapour or smoke formed
were considered too vague for credit. Some impossible test results with splints were seen, e.g.
lighted splints popping and glowing splints relighting. A number of candidates reported that the gas
bleached litmus paper and that it was chlorine.
Some candidates reported fizzing on adding hydrochloric acid which indicated that they were not
following instructions.
(h) Many candidates successfully carried out a flame test and recorded a green or green-blue colour
as expected. Some red, lilac and yellow observations were inexplicably recorded. A minority of
candidates were clearly unfamiliar with a flame test.
(i) Credit was awarded for recording the formation of a brown colouration or effervescence. A
significant number of candidates described the formation of a green precipitate and could not be
credited.
(j) Many candidates correctly identified copper carbonate. There were some references to chloride
and sulfate.
Question 3
Despite the fact that they were measuring the rate of reaction between magnesium ribbon and dilute sulfuric
acid, a number of candidates used hydrochloric acid and tried to grind the ribbon into a powder. A significant
number of candidates heated the reactants with a Bunsen burner and carried out a series of experiments at
different temperatures which showed a lack of understanding.
Most candidates described a method involving collecting and measuring the volume of hydrogen and timing.
Timing at set intervals was well described but timing until the reaction stopped often lacked detail as to how
they would know when the reaction stopped. Timing when the reaction started was a flawed method as the
reaction is instantaneous. Using a gas syringe was a common correct method but those candidates who
used collection over water, often used a test-tube instead of a measuring cylinder but still claimed they would
be able to measure the volume. Stronger responses measured the loss in mass of the reactants using a
balance and were able to score full credit. Weaker responses chose less appropriate methods, such as
counting bubbles or vaguely timing how long it took for the gas produced to give a pop with a lighted splint.
A minority of candidates could describe how the results could be used to find the rate of the reaction and
vague references to the rate being the same as the time of the reaction were common. Good answers gave
experimental details. Credit was awarded for the following points:
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/62
Alternative to Practical
Key messages
• Before answering a question, candidates should read it carefully and ensure that they know and
understand what the point of the question is. A good example of this guidance not being followed was
Question 1(f) where many candidates did not use the information provided to answer the question.
• Candidates should be prepared to answer questions requiring the planning of an investigation.
General comments
The vast majority of candidates successfully attempted all of the questions. The full range of marks was seen
and the paper was accessible to all candidates. Candidates found Questions 1(c), 2(j) and 4 more
demanding than the others.
The majority of candidates were able to correctly complete tables of results from readings on diagrams in
Question 2.
Question 1
(a) (i) A lot of candidates drew the solvent front. Credit for the level of the solvent was awarded for
drawing a line between the base line and the bottom of the paper, which did not touch the dot
showing the mixtures of dyes.
(ii) This question was well answered with water or an organic solvent a common correct response. A
small number of candidates used acids or marker pens and gained no credit.
(b) This question was generally well answered. However, responses such as ninhydrin or locating
agent showed a lack of understanding.
(c) There was a lack of detail in many of the answers given. Stronger answers referred to keeping the
base line above the solvent level or stated that the paper should not fall into the solvent as the dyes
would mix.
(d) Many responses showed an understanding that dye B was a mixture of two substances and/or one
of these was dye D.
(e) A large number of incorrect responses referred to dye C being colourless, pure, only one
substance or too dense to move. Stronger responses realised that dye C was insoluble in the
solvent.
(f) Despite the instructions given, many candidates were unable to measure the distances required to
score full credit. A range of Rf values was accepted from 0.56 to 0.64. Many candidates got the
fraction the wrong way up.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 2
(d) Many candidates described the initial colour as orange instead of yellow and could not be credited.
Some candidates described the final colour as green, blue or colourless.
(e) The majority of candidates realised that the flask was rinsed with distilled water to clean it and
remove impurities from the previous experiment. Vague comments about removing traces of
indicators were ignored.
(f) Answers to this question were generally correct with Experiment 3 being the expected response.
(g) The majority of candidates answered the question correctly and named a burette or pipette. A
significant number thought a (graduated) beaker or a measuring cylinder, which was used
originally, would be more accurate.
(h) Many candidates mistakenly thought that changing the temperature would change the volumes of
dilute hydrochloric acid used because the reaction would be faster. Stronger responses gained full
credit for answers stating that there would be no effect on the volume of acid as warming the
solution of sodium hydroxide would only affect the rate and not change the volume or
concentrations of the reactants.
(i) (i) This question was answered correctly by most candidates. Some candidates got the ratio the
wrong way round or failed to follow the instruction ‘Determine the simplest whole number ratio’ and
gave fractions or ratios to one or two decimal places.
(ii) Many candidates gave incorrect references to solutions of different concentrations being used in
Experiments 1 and 3 and showed a lack of knowledge and understanding. Stronger responses
realised that the use of different indicators resulted in different volumes of dilute hydrochloric acid
being used.
(j) Many candidates thought that universal indicator was only a test paper and that testing would be
necessary after each addition of hydrochloric acid. References to pH were ignored. Other
candidates thought that universal indicator was colourless, or would not change colour or that it
would react with the mixture. However, stronger responses understood that there would be more
than one colour change and it would be difficult to find the end point.
(k) The idea that the reliability of the results could be checked by repeating the experiments was well
understood and scored partial credit. The mark allocation indicated that reference to comparing or
averaging the results obtained was also expected.
Some candidates wanted to repeat the experiments with different volumes or concentrations of
solutions and showed a lack of understanding as did those who wanted to repeat them without
using an indicator.
Question 3
(a) This was generally well answered with brown or yellow scoring credit. A number of candidates
followed their chosen colour with the description of solid or crystals, not realising that solution M
was being tested.
(b) This question was generally well answered with the recognition of the formation of a white
precipitate. Additional incorrect observations, e.g. effervescence, meant that credit could not be
awarded.
(c) Some candidates reported the formation of a white precipitate. A significant number of candidates
implied some sort of colour change or effervescence. This test for a sulfate should be negative and
responses such as no change, no reaction or no precipitate scored credit.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry March 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(d) (i) This question was well answered. The formation of a brown precipitate was often described
correctly. Some confusion with the test for iron(II) ions was seen.
(ii) Most candidates knew that the precipitate was insoluble in excess sodium hydroxide.
(e) The gas produced in test 1 was identified correctly by some candidates.
Question 4
Despite the fact that they were measuring the rate of reaction between magnesium ribbon and dilute sulfuric
acid, a number of candidates used hydrochloric acid and tried to grind the ribbon into a powder. A significant
number of candidates heated the reactants with a Bunsen burner and carried out a series of experiments at
different temperatures which showed a lack of understanding.
Almost all candidates scored some credit for adding magnesium to sulfuric acid in a suitable container.
Most candidates described a method involving collecting and measuring the volume of hydrogen and timing.
Timing at set intervals was well described but timing until the reaction stopped often lacked detail as to how
they would know when the reaction stopped. Timing when the reaction started was a flawed method as the
reaction is instantaneous. Using a gas syringe was a common correct method but those candidates who
used collection over water, often used a test-tube instead of a measuring cylinder but still claimed they would
be able to measure the volume. Stronger responses measured the loss in mass of the reactants using a
balance and were able to score full credit. Weaker responses chose less appropriate methods such as
counting bubbles or vaguely timing how long it took for the gas produced to give a pop with a lighted splint.
A minority of candidates could describe how the results could be used to find the rate of the reaction and
vague references to the rate being the same as the time of the reaction were common.
Good answers gave experimental details. Credit was awarded for the following points:
© 2018
Grade thresholds – March 2018
The maximum total mark for this syllabus, after weighting has been applied, is 200.
The overall thresholds for the different grades were set as follows.
Combination of
Option A* A B C D E F G
Components
BY 22, 42, 52 163 141 119 98 82 67 52 37
CY 22, 42, 62 165 143 121 99 84 69 54 39
FY 12, 32, 52 – – – 128 107 87 67 47
GY 12, 32, 62 – – – 129 109 89 69 49
Learn more! For more information please visit www.cambridgeinternational.org/igcse or contact Customer Services
on +44 (0)1223 553554 or email info@cambridgeinternational.org
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/12
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) March 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the March 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 C 1
2 B 1
3 C 1
4 D 1
5 B 1
6 C 1
7 C 1
8 A 1
9 C 1
10 A 1
11 C 1
12 A 1
13 B 1
14 B 1
15 B 1
16 A 1
17 B 1
18 B 1
19 C 1
20 D 1
21 A 1
22 A 1
23 B 1
24 A 1
25 A 1
26 B 1
27 C 1
28 B 1
29 C 1
30 C 1
31 A 1
32 B 1
33 C 1
34 D 1
35 D 1
36 B 1
37 C 1
38 A 1
39 B 1
40 B 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/12
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) February/March 2018
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*8565891309*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 03_0620_12/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 condensation
2 evaporation
3 freezing
4 sublimation
100
90
80
27
70
60
50
28
40
30
20
29 10
Which row shows the readings for the burette and the measuring cylinder?
measuring
burette
cylinder
A 27.8 42
B 27.8 44
C 28.2 42
D 28.2 44
A –77 °C
B –7 °C to +7 °C
C 59 °C
D 107 °C to 117 °C
The table shows information about barium sulfate and copper(II) sulfate.
state at room
substance solubility in water
temperature
How does the student obtain copper(II) sulfate crystals from the mixture?
A When concentrated aqueous sodium chloride is electrolysed, sodium forms at the cathode.
B When concentrated hydrochloric acid is electrolysed, a green gas forms at the cathode.
C When dilute sulfuric acid is electrolysed, a colourless gas forms at both electrodes.
Statement 2 When hydrogen burns in the air to form water, heat energy is produced.
Which is correct?
12 Magnesium carbonate was reacted with dilute hydrochloric acid in a conical flask.
The conical flask was placed on a balance and the mass of the conical flask and contents was
recorded as the reaction proceeded.
13 Separate samples of anhydrous copper(II) sulfate and hydrated copper(II) sulfate are heated.
anhydrous hydrated
copper(II) sulfate copper(II) sulfate
heat heat
16 A solution of compound Z gives a light blue precipitate with aqueous ammonia. The precipitate
dissolves in an excess of ammonia.
A blue-green
B lilac
C red
D yellow
17 Carbon, copper, magnesium, sodium and sulfur can all form oxides.
A 1 B 2 C 3 D 4
The melting points of Group I elements ....... 2 ....... down the group.
The melting points of Group VII elements ....... 3 ....... down the group.
1 2 3
20 Which statements about Group I and Group VII elements are correct?
statement 1 statement 2
A
B
C
D
reaction W X Y Z
fizzing fizzing violent no
metal + dilute hydrochloric acid
fizzing reaction
no metal no metal
metal oxide + carbon + heat
reaction produced reaction produced
most least
reactive reactive
A Y W X Z
B Y X W Z
C Z W X Y
D Z X W Y
A Al → C → Fe
B Al → Fe → C
C Fe → Al → C
D Fe → C → Al
property 1 property 2
27 Which statement about the uses of aluminium, copper and iron is correct?
1 acid added
2 alkali added
3 heated strongly
4 water added
Which processes are used to remove solid impurities and to kill bacteria?
to remove to kill
solid impurities bacteria
A chlorination chlorination
B chlorination filtration
C filtration chlorination
D filtration filtration
A argon
B carbon dioxide
C carbon monoxide
D water vapour
A carbon monoxide
B methane
C nitrogen dioxide
D sulfur dioxide
34 The diagram shows the pH values of the soil in two parts of a garden, X and Y.
X Y
pH 7.0 pH 5.5
To which part of the garden should the lime be added and why?
A X acidic
B X basic
C Y acidic
D Y basic
A ethanol
B hydrogen
C methane
D oxygen
In which of the reactions does the relative molecular mass of the carbon-containing compound
decrease?
C using steam at 30 °C
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/12/F/M/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/22
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) March 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the March 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 A 1
2 C 1
3 B 1
4 C 1
5 A 1
6 A 1
7 A 1
8 C 1
9 C 1
10 B 1
11 C 1
12 A 1
13 B 1
14 C 1
15 B 1
16 A 1
17 C 1
18 A 1
19 B 1
20 B 1
21 C 1
22 A 1
23 D 1
24 B 1
25 C 1
26 B 1
27 C 1
28 C 1
29 C 1
30 D 1
31 A 1
32 B 1
33 B 1
34 D 1
35 A 1
36 D 1
37 C 1
38 A 1
39 D 1
40 B 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/22
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) February/March 2018
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*3036484056*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 03_0620_22/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 Hydrogen chloride gas, HCl, reacts with ammonia gas, NH3, to form solid ammonium chloride.
After a few minutes, solid ammonium chloride forms where the two gases meet.
source of source of
hydrogen chloride gas ammonia gas
The experiment is repeated using hydrogen bromide, HBr, in place of hydrogen chloride.
How far along the tube does the solid ammonium bromide form?
A B C D
source of source of
hydrogen bromide gas ammonia gas
A –77 °C
B –7 °C to +7 °C
C 59 °C
D 107 °C to 117 °C
3 Chromatography is done on a mixture containing a drug. The drug has an Rf value of 0.66.
solvent front
15 cm
12 cm
9.9 cm
C
0.66 cm
baseline D
1 Copper has a high melting point because of the strong electrostatic attraction
between the positive ions and the ‘sea of electrons’.
2 Copper is malleable because the layers of atoms in the lattice can slide over each
other.
3 Copper atoms can be oxidised to form copper ions by losing electrons.
6 Three statements about diamond, graphite and silicon(IV) oxide are listed.
2 In silicon(IV) oxide, silicon and oxygen atoms are joined together by covalent bonds
throughout the whole structure.
How many moles of hydrochloric acid are present in 25 cm3 of this solution?
9 A solution of copper(II) sulfate can be electrolysed using copper electrodes or carbon electrodes.
voltmeter
V
metal 1 metal 2
electrolyte
The table shows the reading on the voltmeter when different metals are used.
metal 2
beryllium cerium cobalt manganese
The greater the difference in reactivity of the metals, the larger the reading on the voltmeter.
most least
reactive reactive
11 The energy level diagram for the reaction between X2 and Y2 to form XY gas is shown.
X2(g) + Y2(g)
energy
2XY(g)
progress of reaction
bond energy
bond
in kJ / mol
C–H +410
C=O +805
O–H +460
O=O +496
A –818 kJ / mol
B –323 kJ / mol
C +323 kJ / mol
D +818 kJ / mol
13 Methanol is made by reacting carbon monoxide with hydrogen. The reaction is reversible.
Which combination of temperature and pressure gives the highest equilibrium yield of methanol?
temperature pressure
/ °C / atmospheres
A 200 10
B 200 200
C 600 10
D 600 200
14 The ionic equation for the reaction between zinc and aqueous copper ions is shown.
A the conversion of carbon dioxide and water to glucose and oxygen in green plants
B the reaction of bromine with ethene
C the reaction of chlorine with methane
D the reduction of silver ions to silver
16 Calcium carbonate reacts with dilute hydrochloric acid to form bubbles of carbon dioxide.
A increases more
B increases the same
C stays the same more
D stays the same the same
Which row describes the roles of ethanoic acid and water in this reaction?
18 A solution of compound Z gives a light blue precipitate with aqueous ammonia. The precipitate
dissolves in an excess of ammonia.
A blue-green
B lilac
C red
D yellow
19 Carbon, copper, magnesium, sodium and sulfur can all form oxides.
A 1 B 2 C 3 D 4
The melting points of Group I elements ....... 2 ....... down the group.
The melting points of Group VII elements ....... 3 ....... down the group.
1 2 3
22 Metal X reacts with non-metal Y to form an ionic compound with the formula X2Y.
23 Which statements about Group I and Group VII elements are correct?
statement 1 statement 2
A
B
C
D
property 1 property 2
Which equation shows the formation of carbon dioxide during the extraction of aluminium from
aluminium oxide by electrolysis?
C C + O2 → CO2
26 A sample of solid X was added to three different solutions to predict the position of X in the
reactivity series.
27 Which statement about the uses of aluminium, copper and iron is correct?
The melting and boiling points of some gases present in clean, dry air are shown.
Which processes are used to remove solid impurities and to kill bacteria?
to remove to kill
solid impurities bacteria
A chlorination chlorination
B chlorination filtration
C filtration chlorination
D filtration filtration
1 heating limestone
2 burning gasoline in car engines
3 photosynthesis
4 production of nylon
A carbon monoxide
B methane
C nitrogen dioxide
D sulfur dioxide
33 The equation for the formation of sulfur trioxide from sulfur dioxide is shown.
Which combination of pressure and temperature gives the highest equilibrium yield of
sulfur trioxide?
pressure temperature
A high high
B high low
C low high
D low low
34 The diagram shows the pH values of the soil in two parts of a garden, X and Y.
X Y
pH 7.0 pH 5.5
To which part of the garden should the lime be added and why?
A X acidic
B X basic
C Y acidic
D Y basic
Statement 2 When hydrogen burns in the air to form water, heat energy is produced.
Which is correct?
chemical functional
properties group
A different different
B different same
C similar different
D similar same
In which of the reactions does the relative molecular mass of the carbon-containing compound
decrease?
C using steam at 30 °C
CH3 Cl CH3 Cl
C C C C
H F H F
A B C D
CH3 Cl H Cl CH3 F CH3 H
C C C C C C C C
F H CH3 F Cl H Cl F
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
16
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
0620/22/F/M/18
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/32
Paper 3 Theory (Core) March 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the March 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a)(i) E / oxygen / O2 1
1(a)(iii) E / oxygen / O2 1
1(b) protons: 8 1
neutrons: 9 1
electrons: 8 1
relights 1
2(a)(i) 25 (mg) 1
2(a)(ii) potassium / K+ 1
2(b)(ii) C3H6O3 1
© UCLES 2018 Page 4 of 9
0620/32 Cambridge IGCSE – Mark Scheme March 2018
PUBLISHED
Question Answer Marks
2(c)(ii) 46 2
If 2 marks not obtained: 1 mark for 1 row all correct e.g.
hydrogen 6 × 1 = 6
oxygen 1 × 16 = 16
3(b)(i) density of fluorine: ALLOW: values lower than 1.56 (but not 0 or negative numbers) 1
melting point of chlorine: ALLOW values between –220 and –7 ºC (excluding these two values) 1
3(b)(ii) lighter because the trend of colour down (the Group) is towards dark(er) colours / lighter because the trend of colour up (the 1
Group) is towards light(er) colours
3(b)(iii) liquid 1
3(c) Br2 1
2 (KBr) 1
4(b) alkane(s) 1
4(c) compound of carbon and hydrogen only / compound of hydrogen and carbon with no other elements 2
4(d) structure of ethane correct with all atoms and all bonds 1
H H
ǀ ǀ
H–C–C–H
ǀ ǀ
H H
• high temperature
• catalyst
• high pressure
4(e)(ii) C11H24 1
4(f) steam 1
4(g) monomers 1
addition 1
5(a)(ii) chlorine 1
5(a)(iii) to stop the magnesium oxidising / to stop the magnesium reacting with the air / to stop it oxidising / to stop it reacting with the 1
air
5(a)(iv) argon / krypton / xenon 1
5(b)(i) aluminium 1
5(b)(ii) aluminium 1
5(d)(i) mixture of metals / mixture of metal and non-metal / mixture of a metal with another element(1) 1
5(d)(ii) alloy is stronger (than pure metal) / alloy is more resistant to corrosion (than pure metal) / alloy is harder 1
6(a)(i) methane 1
with magnesium
• forms magnesium chloride
• forms hydrogen
• reaction is exothermic / (reaction mixture) gets hot
with indicator
• named acid-base indicator
• correct colour of indicator in acidic solution
7(b)(i) neutralisation 1
7(b)(ii) pH 13 1
7(b)(iii) ammonia 1
8(b)(i) hematite 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/32
Paper 3 Theory (Core) February/March 2018
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 03_0620_32/2RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
Na+ Br – Na+ Br – H H Cl
Br – Na+ Br – Na+ H C C H O C O I O O
Cl Cl
Na+ Br – Na+ Br – Br Br
A B C D E
nswer the following questions using only the substances in the diagram.
A
Each substance may be used once, more than once or not at all.
8O
17
Deduce the number of protons, neutrons and electrons in this isotope of oxygen.
test . ............................................................................................................................................
result . .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 10]
2 (a) The table shows the mass of each type of ion present in a 100 cm3 sample of milk.
(i) Calculate the mass of calcium ions present in a 20 cm3 sample of this milk.
(ii) Which positive ion is present in the highest concentration in this sample of milk?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Name the compound formed from Mg2+ and SO42– ions.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
test . .....................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
result . ..................................................................................................................................
[3]
(b) O
ne of the organic acids present in milk is lactic acid.
The structure of lactic acid is shown.
H
H O O
H C C C
H H O H
(i) On the structure shown draw a circle around the carboxylic acid functional group. [1]
(ii) D
educe the molecular formula of lactic acid showing the number of carbon, hydrogen and
oxygen atoms.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
carbon 2 12 2 × 12 = 24
hydrogen
oxygen
[Total: 11]
(a) A
crystal of iodine was placed at the bottom of a beaker containing the solvent cyclohexane.
After 2 days, a purple colour had spread throughout the cyclohexane.
cyclohexane
crystal of iodine
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) C
omplete the chemical equation for the reaction of aqueous bromine with aqueous
potassium iodide.
[Total: 10]
(a) W
hich two statements about members of a homologous series are correct?
Tick two boxes.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(d) Draw the structure of ethane showing all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[1]
(e) The hydrocarbon tetradecane, C14H30, can be cracked to form a mixture of alkanes and alkenes.
1 . .........................................................................................................................................
2 . .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(ii) C
omplete the chemical equation for the cracking of tetradecane to form two different
hydrocarbons.
Complete the sentence about this reaction using words from the list.
[Total: 12]
unreactive
anode (+)
gas out
(i) W
hat information in the diagram shows that molten magnesium is less dense than molten
magnesium chloride?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
An unreactive gas is blown over the surface of the molten magnesium.
(iii) S
uggest why an unreactive gas and not air is blown over the surface of the molten
magnesium.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
Answer these questions using only the information shown in the table.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) W
hich metal is most suitable to use for overhead power cables?
Give a reason for your answer.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) Give two properties of transition elements which are not shown by Group I elements.
1 .................................................................................................................................................
2 .................................................................................................................................................
[2]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) Give one reason why alloys are used instead of pure metals.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 13]
(i) G
ive the name of the hydrocarbon which is present in the greatest concentration in natural
gas.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) H
ydrogen sulfide is removed from natural gas by reaction with oxygen in the presence of
a catalyst.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) W
hen fossil fuels containing sulfur are burned, sulfur dioxide is formed.
Sulfur dioxide contributes to acid rain.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 5]
(a) D
escribe the reactions of hydrochloric acid with:
●● calcium oxide
●● magnesium
●● a named indicator of your choice.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [5]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) W hich one of the following pH values is the pH of an aqueous solution of sodium hydroxide?
Draw a circle around the correct answer.
pH 2 pH 5 pH 7 pH 13
[1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 10]
(a) A
student investigates the rate of reaction of 1 g of iron powder with 25 cm3 of hydrochloric acid
of concentration 2.0 mol / dm3. The temperature is 20 °C.
What effect do the following have on the initial rate of this reaction?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) U
sing a piece of iron of mass 1 g.
All other conditions are kept the same.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) C
arrying out the experiment at 25 °C.
All other conditions are kept the same.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
(c) Iron can be extracted from its oxide by reduction with carbon.
The table shows how easy it is to reduce four metal oxides by heating with carbon.
se this information to put the metals in order of their reactivity. Put the least reactive metal
U
first.
[2]
[Total: 9]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
16
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/32/F/M/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge Assessment International Education
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/42
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) March 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the March 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a)(i) A 1
1(a)(ii) M1 C 2
M2 D
1(a)(iii) D 1
1(a)(iv) B 1
1(a)(v) M1 F 2
M2 B
1(a)(vi) M1 G 2
M2 H
1(b)(ii) M1 three correct bonding pairs from one N atom to each of three F atoms 3
M2 (3 pairs of) non-bonding electrons on each of three F atoms to complete an octet
M3 (1 pair of) non-bonding electrons on N atom to complete an octet
1(c)(ii) 21(%) 1
M2 rest of structure
2(a)(ii) 18 1
2(a)(iii) Ne or Neon 1
2(b)(ii) hydrogen 3
chlorine
sodium hydroxide
2(c)(iii) M1 evaporation 2
M2 crystallisation
M2 (Mr of NaNO3 =) 85
3(a)(ii) (step) 3 1
3(a)(iv) heating 1
3(c) Mg Si O 2
M3 M1 – M2
4(b)(iii) ((b)(ii) is exothermic then) exothermic and more energy released than used 1
OR
((b)(ii) is endothermic then) endothermic and less energy released than used
4(c)(ii) M1 platinum 2
M2 transition metal / element
5(c)(i) M1 steam 2
M2 catalyst
5(d)(ii) hydrolysis 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/42
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) February/March 2018
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 03_0620_42/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
letter A B C D E F G H
substance SO2 Ar CO Cl 2 NH3 CO2 CH4 C 3H 8
Identify, by letter:
(i) a gas which combines with water to form acid rain ....................................................... [1]
(ii)
two gases which exist as diatomic molecules ............................................................... [2]
(v)
two gases which are found in clean dry air ................................................................... [2]
(vi)
two gases which are found in refinery gas. ................................................................... [2]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(ii) Complete the dot-and-cross diagram to show the electron arrangement in a molecule of
NF3.
Show outer shell electrons only.
F N F
[3]
(c) Air is a mixture. Nitrogen and oxygen are the two most common gases in air.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) State the percentage of oxygen, to the nearest whole number, in clean dry air.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Describe the steps in the industrial process which enables nitrogen and oxygen to be
separated from clean dry air.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [3]
(iv) Which physical property of nitrogen and oxygen allows them to be separated?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 20]
(i) Complete the diagram to show the ions present. Use ‘+’ for Na+ ions and ‘–’ for Cl – ions.
One ion has been completed for you.
[2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Identify an element which has atoms with the same number of electrons as a sodium ion.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
3 ...........................................................................................................................................
[3]
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(c) Silver chloride can be made by reacting aqueous sodium chloride with aqueous silver nitrate.
The other product of the reaction is sodium nitrate. The chemical equation for the reaction is
shown.
A student attempted to make the maximum amount of sodium nitrate crystals. The process
involved three steps.
step 1 The student added aqueous sodium chloride to aqueous silver nitrate and stirred.
Neither reagent was in excess.
step 2 The student filtered the mixture. The student then washed the residue and added
the washings to the filtrate.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Give the names of the two processes which occurred in step 3.
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(v) Write a chemical equation for the action of heat on sodium nitrate crystals.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
[Total: 21]
CaCO3(s) ...................................
step 2
step 4
add
add CO2
limited water
(i) Complete the box to give the chemical name and formula of lime. [2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(vi) Explain why step 4 is a neutralisation reaction. Refer to the substances reacting in your
answer.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
Write a chemical equation for the reaction between magnesium carbonate and dilute nitric acid.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
A sample of forsterite has the following composition by mass: Mg, 2.73 g; Si, 1.58 g; O, 3.60 g.
[Total: 12]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(i) Calculate the volume of chlorine, measured at room temperature and pressure, needed to
react completely with 0.68 g of ammonia.
2 H N H + 3 Cl Cl N N + 6 H Cl
Use the bond energies in the table to determine the energy change, ΔH, for the reaction
between ammonia and chlorine.
bond energy
bond
in kJ / mol
N–H 390
Cl –Cl 240
N≡N 945
H–Cl 430
.............................. kJ
.............................. kJ
●● energy change, ΔH, for the reaction between ammonia and chlorine
.............................. kJ
[3]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(c) Ammonia reacts with oxygen at high temperatures in the presence of a suitable catalyst to
form nitric oxide, NO.
(i) Explain how this chemical equation shows ammonia acting as a reducing agent.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Suggest a suitable catalyst for the reaction from the list of metals. Give a reason for your
answer.
reason ..................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 13]
5 Alcohols are a ‘family’ of organic molecules which have the same general formula.
(a) What is the name given to any ‘family’ of organic molecules which have the same general
formula and similar chemical properties?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(i) Name the reagent and give the conditions needed to convert propene into propan-1-ol.
reagent ................................................................................................................................
conditions ............................................................................................................................
[2]
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
H O O H
(i) Complete the diagram to show part of a carbohydrate polymer made from the simple
sugar shown.
[2]
(ii) Name the chemical process which occurs when a carbohydrate polymer is broken down
into simple sugars.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
A student analysed a mixture of simple sugars by chromatography. All the simple sugars in the
mixture were colourless.
(i) What is the name given to the type of substance used to identify the positions of the simple
sugars on the chromatogram?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
Rf =
[1]
(iii) How could a student identify a simple sugar from its Rf value?
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iv) Sometimes not all the substances in a mixture can be identified from the chromatogram
produced.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 14]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/42/F/M/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/52
Paper 5 Practical Test February/March 2018
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*5591979725*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the Question Paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The Supervisor’s Report to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and enclose
it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of the
Supervisor’s Results and of the Supervisor’s Report are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Suitable eye protection should be provided.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Confidential Instructions, please contact Cambridge stating the Centre
number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
email info@cie.org.uk
phone +44 1223 553554
fax +44 1223 553558
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 03_0620_52CI/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
Question 1
Each candidate will require the following chemicals and apparatus. Labels must not include
concentrations.
(a)
100 cm3 of aqueous sodium carbonate, Na2CO3, of concentration 0.1 mol / dm3 labelled
solution L
(b)
100 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid of concentration 0.2
mol dm3 labelled dilute
/
hydrochloric acid for Question 1
[F][HH] (c)
methyl orange indicator
[MH]
(e)
access to water and distilled water
(f)
25 cm3 or 50 cm3 measuring cylinder
(g)
50 cm3 burette with stand and clamp
(h)
250 cm3 conical flask
(i)
white tile
(j)
funnel for filling burette
Question 2
Each candidate will require the following chemicals and apparatus. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
[C] (a) 15 cm3 of aqueous iron(III) chloride, FeCl 3.6H2O, of concentration 0.25 mol / dm3
labelled solution M
[MH][N] (b) 1 g of basic copper(II) carbonate, for example CuCO3.Cu(OH)2, labelled solid N
(d) aqueous barium nitrate of sufficient concentration to give a positive sulfate test
[MH][N] (e) aqueous silver nitrate of sufficient concentration to give a positive halide test
[MH] (h) limewater and apparatus used to test for carbon dioxide
(k) splints
(r) spatula
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
Supervisor’s Report
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record the
results on a spare copy of the Question Paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’. Failure to
enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably penalised.
2 he Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
T
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination
ther cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported directly to
O
Cambridge on the Special Consideration form.
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
Signed ...................................................
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/52
Paper 5 Practical Test March 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the March 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
comparable to supervisor’s 1
1(d)(ii) effervescence 1
1(e) Experiment 3 1
1(f) pipette / burette 1
1(h)(i) 1:2 1
2 tests on solution M
2(a)(i) yellow / brown 1
2(a)(ii) <7 1
2(c) no reaction / change / precipitate 1
2(d) brown 1
precipitate 1
2(e) iron 1
III / 3 / three 1
chloride 1
2 tests on solid N
2(f) green 1
condensation 1
limewater 1
white precipitate / milky 1
2(h) blue-green 1
copper / transition element
carbonate 1
hydrated / water
CHEMISTRY 0620/52
Paper 5 Practical Test February/March 2018
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 03_0620_52/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 You are going to investigate the reaction between dilute hydrochloric acid and an aqueous solution
of sodium carbonate labelled solution L.
Instructions
You are going to do three experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
● se the measuring cylinder to pour 25 cm3 of solution L into the conical flask.
U
● Add ten drops of thymolphthalein indicator to the conical flask.
● Fill the burette up to the 0.0 cm3 mark with the dilute hydrochloric acid.
● Add dilute hydrochloric acid from the burette to the conical flask, 1.0 cm3 at a time, while
swirling the conical flask, until the solution just changes to colourless.
● Record the burette readings in the table and complete the table.
Experiment 1
difference / cm3
[2]
(b) Experiment 2
● ow add ten drops of methyl orange indicator to the solution in the conical flask from
N
Experiment 1.
● Record the initial burette reading in the table.
● Add dilute hydrochloric acid from the burette to the conical flask, 1.0 cm3 at a time, while
swirling the conical flask, until the solution just changes colour.
● Record the final burette reading in the table and complete the table.
Experiment 2
difference / cm3
[2]
(c) Experiment 3
Experiment 3
difference / cm3
[1]
(d) (i) What colour change was observed in the conical flask in Experiment 3?
(ii) Apart from the colour change, what was observed in the conical flask in Experiment 3?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
Experiment .......... needed the largest volume of dilute hydrochloric acid to change the colour
of the indicator. [1]
(f) Give the name of a more accurate piece of apparatus for measuring the volume of solution L.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(g) What would be the effect on the results if solution L were warmed before adding the dilute
hydrochloric acid? Give a reason for your answer.
reason .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(h) (i) Determine the simplest whole number ratio of volumes of dilute hydrochloric acid used in
Experiments 1 and 3.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) S
uggest why the volumes of dilute hydrochloric acid used in Experiments 1 and 3 are
different.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total:16]
tests on solution M
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
pH = .............................. [1]
(b) A dd a few drops of dilute nitric acid and about 1 cm3 of aqueous silver nitrate to the second
portion of solution M.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) A dd a few drops of dilute nitric acid and about 1 cm3 of aqueous barium nitrate to the third
portion of solution M.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d)
Add an excess of aqueous sodium hydroxide to the fourth portion of solution M.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
Keep the fifth portion of solution M for the test on solid N in (i).
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
tests on solid N
Divide solid N into three approximately equal portions in one hard glass test‑tube and two test‑tubes.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(g) Heat the first portion of solid N in the hard glass test-tube. Heat gently and then more strongly.
Test the gas produced.
Record your observations.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [4]
(h) A dd about 1 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid to the second portion of solid N in a test-tube.
Carry out a flame test on the mixture.
Record the colour of the flame.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(i) A
dd the fifth portion of solution M to the third portion of solid N in a test‑tube. Leave the solution
to stand for about 5 minutes.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total:18]
3 Magnesium reacts with dilute sulfuric acid at room temperature to form hydrogen gas.
Plan an experiment to find the rate of reaction between magnesium ribbon and dilute sulfuric acid.
You are provided with common laboratory apparatus, magnesium ribbon and dilute sulfuric acid.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced will turn
gently and test for the presence of acidified aqueous potassium
sulfur dioxide manganate(VII) from purple to
colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt., or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper(II) (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/62
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical March 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the March 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE®, Cambridge International A and AS Level components and some Cambridge O Level
components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a)(i) line drawn on diagram between base line and bottom of paper and below dot 1
1(a)(ii) water 1
1(e) insoluble 1
0.56–0.64 1
2(b) table of results with final reading and difference completed correctly 1
23.6 and 11.6
2(f) 3 1
2(g) pipette / burette 1
2(i)(i) 1:2 1
3 tests on solution M
3(a) yellow / brown 1
3(b) white 1
precipitate 1
3(c) no reaction / change / precipitate 1
3(d)(i) brown 1
precipitate 1
3 tests on solid N
carbonate 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/62
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical February/March 2018
1 hour
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 03_0620_62/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 A student used paper chromatography to separate a mixture of coloured dyes. The diagram shows
the apparatus used.
clips
rod
paper
mixture of
coloured dyes
baseline
(a) (i) Draw a line on the diagram to show the level of the solvent. [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b) What could be used to put the mixture of coloured dyes onto the paper?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
The diagram shows the chromatogram obtained from four dyes, A, B, C and D.
solvent front
baseline
A B C D
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f)
Rf values are used to identify compounds.
Rf = .............................. [2]
[Total: 8]
2 A student investigated the reaction between dilute hydrochloric acid and an aqueous solution of
sodium carbonate labelled solution L.
Experiment 1
● measuring cylinder was used to pour 25 cm3 of solution L into a conical flask.
A
● Ten drops of thymolphthalein indicator were added to the conical flask.
● A burette was filled up to the 0.0 cm3 mark with dilute hydrochloric acid.
● Dilute hydrochloric acid was added from the burette to the conical flask until the solution just
changed to colourless at the end-point of the titration.
(a) Use the burette diagram to record the final burette reading in the table and complete the table.
11
12
13
Experiment 1
difference / cm3
[1]
Experiment 2
● en drops of methyl orange indicator were added to the solution in the conical flask from
T
Experiment 1.
● Dilute hydrochloric acid was added from the burette to the conical flask until the solution just
changed colour.
(b) Use the burette diagram to record the final burette reading in the table and complete the table.
22
23
24
Experiment 2
difference / cm3
[1]
Experiment 3
● The conical flask was emptied and rinsed with distilled water.
● xperiment 1 was repeated using methyl orange indicator instead of thymolphthalein indicator
E
and adding dilute hydrochloric acid from the burette to the conical flask until the solution just
changed colour.
(c) Use the burette diagrams to record the burette readings in the table and complete the table.
0 23
1 24
2 25
Experiment 3
difference / cm3
[3]
(d) What colour change was observed in the conical flask in Experiment 3?
(e) Why was the conical flask emptied and rinsed with distilled water at the start of Experiment 3?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
Experiment .......... needed the largest volume of dilute hydrochloric acid to change the colour
of the indicator. [1]
(g) Give the name of a more accurate piece of apparatus for measuring the volume of solution L.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(h)
What would be the effect on the results if solution L were warmed before adding the
dilute hydrochloric acid? Give a reason for your answer.
reason .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(i) (i) Determine the simplest whole number ratio of volumes of dilute hydrochloric acid used in
Experiments 1 and 3.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Suggest why the volumes of dilute hydrochloric acid used in Experiments 1 and 3 are
different.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 16]
3 Two substances, solution M and solid N, were analysed. Solution M was aqueous iron(III) chloride.
Tests were done on the substances.
tests on solution M
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) Dilute nitric acid and aqueous silver nitrate were added to the first portion of solution M.
(c) Dilute nitric acid and aqueous barium nitrate were added to the second portion of solution M.
(d) (i) Drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide were added to the third portion of solution M until a
change was seen.
(ii) An excess of aqueous sodium hydroxide was then added to the mixture.
tests on solid N
test 1
test 2
���������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������� [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 10]
4 Magnesium reacts with dilute sulfuric acid at room temperature to form hydrogen gas.
Plan an experiment to find the rate of reaction between magnesium ribbon and dilute sulfuric acid.
You are provided with common laboratory apparatus, magnesium ribbon and dilute sulfuric acid.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/11
Multiple Choice (Core)
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 B 21 A
2 A 22 A
3 B 23 C
4 D 24 D
5 B 25 B
6 A 26 B
7 C 27 B
8 C 28 C
9 C 29 C
10 B 30 C
11 B 31 D
12 D 32 C
13 B 33 D
14 A 34 A
15 B 35 A
16 C 36 B
17 C 37 C
18 A 38 C
19 C 39 A
20 B 40 D
General comments
The following responses were popular wrong answers to the questions listed.
Question 2
Response D was slightly more popular than the correct one. Candidates did not appreciate that a burette is
necessary to measure 0.1 cm3 accurately.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Questions 3
This had an approximately equal number of candidates choosing each alternative. This indicates that a high
proportion of candidates were guessing the answer.
Question 8
Response B. This was slightly more popular that the correct one. Candidates simply divided 120 by 12 rather
than correctly using the information given.
Question 10
Question 13
Response A. More candidates chose this response than chose the correct one. They recognised the correct
colour change and read no further.
Questions 17
Question 19
Response A. Candidates did not read the question properly and opted for an element in the same group.
Question 25
Response C. The chemistry of the blast furnace was poorly understood. Few candidates selected the correct
response.
Question 27
Response C. This was more popular than the correct response. Candidates found the mathematics
challenging and may have been unfamiliar with the experiment.
Question 29
Response D. This response was much more popular than the correct one. Candidates did not know that tap
water contains dissolved substances and missed the term soluble in option 2.
Question 32
Response A. This was more popular than the correct response. Candidates were not familiar with
sulfur dioxide and its uses.
Questions 38
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/12
Multiple Choice (Core)
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 D 21 C
2 D 22 D
3 B 23 A
4 D 24 C
5 A 25 B
6 B 26 B
7 C 27 B
8 C 28 C
9 D 29 C
10 D 30 A
11 A 31 B
12 D 32 C
13 D 33 A
14 A 34 A
15 B 35 A
16 C 36 B
17 C 37 A
18 B 38 C
19 B 39 B
20 C 40 C
General comments
The following responses were popular wrong answers to the questions listed.
Question 1
Response A. Candidates did not know the meaning of the term sublimation.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 4
Response B. This response was more popular than the correct response. Candidates did not appreciate that
hydrogen has no neutrons.
Question 8
Response B. Candidates did not understand the mathematical process involved and simply divided 120 by
12.
Question 9
Response C. This response was more popular than the correct response. Candidates knew that lead moves
to the negative electrode but selected the wrong option.
Question 11
Response D. It was a common misconception that because the reaction loses energy candidates assumed
that temperature goes down whereas the energy released by the reaction causes it to increase.
Question 13
Response C. Candidates may not have read the second column of the table.
Question 15
Responses A and D were both more popular than the correct answer. Candidates did not know the tests for
the different gases listed in the syllabus.
Question 18
This had an approximately equal number of candidates choosing each alternative. This indicates that a high
proportion of candidates were guessing the answer.
Question 22
Response B was more popular than the correct one. Candidates often forget that helium, a noble gas, has
only two electrons.
Question 24
Question 25
Response C was more popular than the correct response. Candidates did not know all the chemical
reactions that take place in the blast furnace.
Question 26
Question 30
Question 34
Response C. Candidates realised that the result was ‘neutral’ but were unsure of the initial nature of the
waste.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/13
Multiple Choice (Core)
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 B 21 D
2 A 22 D
3 D 23 B
4 B 24 C
5 B 25 A
6 A 26 A
7 C 27 B
8 C 28 C
9 B 29 C
10 B 30 C
11 C 31 A
12 D 32 D
13 B 33 B
14 A 34 A
15 B 35 A
16 C 36 B
17 C 37 B
18 C 38 C
19 B 39 A
20 A 40 C
General comments
Questions 10, 16, 18, 22, 23, 24, 30 and 31 proved to be particularly challenging.
The following responses were popular wrong answers to the questions listed.
Question 6
Response B. Candidates realised that Q was a metal but did not know the bonding in hydrogen.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 7
Response B. Candidates elected an option which, whilst true, does not answer the question.
Question 8
Response B. Candidates did not understand the mathematical process involved and simply divided 120 by
12.
Question 9
Response A. Candidates missed the term molten in the stem of the question.
Question 10
Response A. This response was more popular than the correct response. Hydrogen, a fuel, does not release
carbon dioxide whereas all fuels release heat.
Question 11
Response D. This response was more popular than the correct response. Candidates were confused by the
two prefixes ‘exo’ and ‘endo’.
Question 16
This had an approximately equal number of candidates choosing each alternative. This indicates that a high
proportion of candidates were guessing the answer.
Question 18
Response D. This was more popular than the correct response. Candidates rejected the three previous
options, not realising that a carbonate would have fizzed producing carbon dioxide.
Question 22
Response A. This response was more popular than the correct one. Candidates did not consult their Periodic
Table and assumed all noble gases have eight electrons in their outer shell.
Question 23
Response A. This was more popular than the correct response. Candidates did not know that an alloy shows
a random distribution of the atoms of the second metal.
Question 24
Response D. This response was more popular than the correct response. The least reactive metals have
oxides which react with carbon.
Question 31
Response B. This response was more popular than the correct response. Candidates knew that greenhouse
gases absorb heat but did not think their answer through.
Question 39
Response B. Candidates knew about fermentation but did not remember the ethene process as an addition
reaction.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/21
Multiple Choice (Extended)
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 A 21 C
2 D 22 B
3 A 23 A
4 C 24 C
5 B 25 C
6 D 26 D
7 D 27 B
8 B 28 B
9 B 29 C
10 D 30 C
11 C 31 D
12 A 32 A
13 B 33 C
14 C 34 D
15 B 35 A
16 B 36 D
17 C 37 C
18 D 38 A
19 C 39 A
20 C 40 B
General comments
The following responses were popular wrong answers to the questions listed.
Question 8
Response C. Candidates realised from the equation that there was a difference with a factor of two.
However, they applied it in the wrong direction.
Question 16
Response C. Candidates confused oxidising agent with the substance being oxidised.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 23
Response B. Candidates did not realise that both the elements and the compounds show catalytic activity.
Question 24
Response D. Candidates did not realise that copper does not react with dilute acids and missed the electrical
conduction.
Question 30
Response D. Candidates did not realise that tap water is not pure as it contains dissolved solids, and missed
the term soluble in option 2.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/22
Multiple Choice (Extended)
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 C 21 B
2 C 22 C
3 D 23 C
4 C 24 A
5 B 25 B
6 B 26 C
7 D 27 B
8 B 28 B
9 B 29 C
10 D 30 C
11 C 31 D
12 A 32 A
13 A 33 C
14 C 34 A
15 D 35 A
16 D 36 D
17 C 37 C
18 C 38 A
19 C 39 A
20 C 40 D
General comments
The following responses were popular wrong answers to the questions listed.
Question 1
Response A. Candidates chose the lightest gas but omitted to take into account the indicator colour change.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 2
Response D. This response was more popular than the correct response. Candidates did not realise that two
substances with the same Rf value would not separate at all.
Question 30
Response D. Candidates did not realise that tap water contains dissolved solids. They also missed the term
soluble in option 2.
Question 35
Response B. Candidates were not familiar with the names for the fractions given in the syllabus.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/23
Multiple Choice (Extended)
Question Question
Key Key
Number Number
1 C 21 B
2 D 22 A
3 A 23 D
4 C 24 B
5 B 25 C
6 B 26 A
7 D 27 A
8 C 28 B
9 C 29 C
10 C 30 C
11 C 31 D
12 B 32 A
13 B 33 D
14 C 34 B
15 D 35 A
16 C 36 D
17 C 37 C
18 D 38 A
19 B 39 A
20 C 40 B
General comments
The following responses were popular wrong answers to the questions listed.
Question 1
Response B. Candidates knew that the answer involved diffusion but did not understand the reason for this.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 5
Response D is true but does not answer the question. It is electrons which determine chemical properties.
Question 6
Response D. Candidates did not fully understand the structure of solid silicon dioxide, only knowing that it
was similar to diamond.
Question 9
Response B. This response was more popular than the correct response. Candidates got part of the way
with the calculation but added less water instead of more.
Question 10
Response A. Candidates did not take into account the copper electrodes.
Question 15
Response C. Candidates may have been thinking of rate of production rather than yield.
Question 18
This had an approximately equal number of candidates choosing each alternative. This indicates that a high
proportion of candidates were guessing the answer.
Question 24
Response A. Candidates should realise that the second metal atoms are randomly distributed through the
metallic structure.
Question 28
Response C. Candidates knew it must be higher but selected wrongly, possibly without doing the maths.
Question 30
Responses A and D were both more popular than the correct response. Candidates missed the term soluble
in option 2 and then found the question challenging.
Question 34
Question 35
Response B. Candidates did not know the names of the fractions that are given in the syllabus.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/31
Theory (Core)
Key messages
• It is important that candidates read questions carefully in order to understand what is exactly being
asked.
• Many candidates needed more practice in memorising the meaning of chemical terms such as
compound or hydrocarbon.
• The balancing of simple equations and extraction of data from tables was generally well done.
General comments
Many candidates tackled this paper well, showing a good knowledge of core Chemistry. Nearly all
candidates were entered at the appropriate level. The standard of English was generally good. Most
candidates attempted all parts of each question. The exceptions were Questions 4(e)(i), 5(b), 5(e), 7(a)(i),
8(c) and 8(d) where a significant number of candidates did not respond.
Many candidates needed more practice in questions involving qualitative analysis. For example, very few
candidates knew the test for an unsaturated hydrocarbon (Question 3(c)(ii)) or iron(II) ions (Question
4(e)(i)).
Some candidates needed more practice in reading and interpreting questions. The rubric was misinterpreted
or ignored by some candidates. In Question 2(b)(ii) the words ‘on health’ were ignored. In Question 4(d),
many candidates did not refer to the equation as instructed in the stem of the question whilst in Question
5(a) some candidates did not choose words from the list. In Question 6(a) a considerable number of
candidates did not write about the position of the sub-atomic particles in the atom. In Question 6(c) some
candidates ignored the words ‘medical use’.
Many candidates needed more practice in answering questions involving chemical terms without
contradicting themselves. For example, in Question 1(c), many candidates wrote about mixtures and in
Question 2(b)(i) some candidates suggested that hydrocarbons were elements.
Some candidates needed more practice in answering extended questions such as Questions 3(c) (diffusion)
and 6(a) (position and number of sub-atomic particles).
Questions involving general chemistry, including organic chemistry, were generally tackled well by many
candidates. Many candidates were able to balance simple equations and extract relevant information from
tables of data. Others needed more practice in naming salts and understanding the reactions of halogens
with halide ions.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 1
Parts (a) and (d) were generally well answered. Many candidates identified at least three of the gases
correctly in part (a) and gained at least one mark for the electron arrangement in part (d). Fewer gave a
suitable explanation for the use of helium in party balloons (part (b)(i)). A greater number gave a correct use
of argon in part (b)(ii). The definition of the term compound (part (c)) was not well known.
(a) (i) Many candidates realised that ammonia turns red litmus blue. The commonest error was to
suggest sulfur dioxide.
(ii) A majority of the candidates suggested that sulfur dioxide contributes to acid rain. A wide range of
incorrect answers was seen, hydrogen or methane being the commonest.
(iii) A considerable number of candidates appeared not to take account of the term hydrocarbon in the
stem of the question and gave the incorrect answer ‘carbon dioxide’. Another common error was to
suggest ‘argon’.
(iv) A minority of the candidates identified carbon dioxide correctly. The commonest errors were to
suggest either ‘hydrogen’ or ‘ammonia’.
(v) Many candidates identified argon as the noble gas with electronic structure 2.8.8. A wide variety of
incorrect answers was seen, the commonest being carbon dioxide, hydrogen or helium.
(b) (i) A minority of the candidates gave correct answers involving the reactivity or flammability of
hydrogen or the inert nature of argon. Others did not gain the mark because they implied that
helium is reactive, e.g. ‘helium is only slightly reactive’. Many gave answers relating to density; the
majority of these suggesting that helium is less dense than hydrogen.
(ii) Many candidates suggested lights, lamps or similar correct answers. Others thought that argon
was an oil, perhaps by mixing up with argan oil, or a fuel. A minority of candidates either referred to
the filament in the lamp rather than the surrounding gas or gave vague statements about argon in
the atmosphere.
(c) Few candidates were able to define the term compound with the exactitude required. Many
described mixtures or unqualified combinations of atoms or sometimes just substances. Many
candidates confused atoms, molecules and substances. A large number of candidates, despite
referring to bonds or ‘joining of different atoms’, disadvantaged themselves by starting their
explanation with ‘a mixture of’.
(d) Many candidates scored at least one mark, most commonly for the three bonding pairs of
electrons. Common errors included: extra non-bonding electrons on one or more hydrogen atoms;
extra electrons on the nitrogen atom; three bonding electrons or a single non-bonding electron on
the nitrogen. A small number of candidates drew a large number of electrons on a single atom,
e.g. up to 12, either on each atom.
Question 2
This question was well answered in parts. In part (a) many candidates answered parts (i) to (iv) correctly.
Few candidates worked out that the nitrogen came from the air in part (a)(v). Part (b) was less well done with
a minority of the candidates being able to give a satisfactory definition of a hydrocarbon or a suitable effect of
carbon monoxide on health. Many candidates were able to balance the equation in part (b)(iii).
(a) (i) A majority of the candidates gave the correct answer. The commonest errors were to give either
85.5 (the total of the other gases) or a near miss in the calculation, e.g. 15.4.
(ii) Most candidates identified hydrogen as the gas present in the lowest concentration. The
commonest error was to suggest hydrocarbons.
(iii) Many candidates gave the correct elements. The commonest errors were to suggest nitrogen and
carbon dioxide or carbon dioxide and water.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(iv) A significant number of candidates who gave CO2 in part (a)(iii) gave the formula of nitrogen
dioxide as NCO2. Other common errors were N2O3 and N2O.
(v) A minority of the candidates realised that the nitrogen came from the air / atmosphere. Many
suggested that the nitrogen comes from the exhaust, the engine or from the incomplete combustion
of the fuel. Others suggested that it comes from reactions involving hydrogen, carbon dioxide or
water. A significant number of candidates gave answers which bore no relationship to the question,
e.g. ‘from industry’ or ‘from limestone’.
(b) (i) A minority of the candidates defined a hydrocarbon correctly. Many described mixtures of elements
or combinations with other elements. Others omitted the essential idea that there were no other
elements present. A significant number of candidates either suggested that hydrocarbons are
elements rather than compounds.
(ii) A minority of candidates gave an answer that referred to the poisonous nature of carbon monoxide.
Many suggested that it causes cancer or lung diseases or gave biological descriptions involving
haemoglobin (rather than giving the effect on the body). Others gave answers that were too vague,
e.g. ‘effects breathing’.
(iii) Many candidates scored at least one mark for balancing the equation, usually for balancing the
carbon in the carbon dioxide. The commonest examples of incorrect balancing for the water
molecules were 10(H2O) and 8(H2O). A small number of candidates gave the incorrect balance of
2CO2 + 2H2O.
Question 3
Few candidates scored well in parts (a)(i) (diffusion) and (a)(ii) (explaining why limonene is a solid at –80°C).
Many candidates could define a catalyst in part (b)(i) and oxidation in part (b)(ii) but fewer were able to
describe the colour change when bromine is added to an unsaturated compound in part (c)(ii).
(a) (i) Many candidates recognised that diffusion was occurring. Fewer explained diffusion in terms of the
particles moving randomly from areas of higher concentration to areas of lower concentration.
Many just described the smell moving or the limonene moving. A minority of the candidates did not
recognise the physical process of diffusion and described chemical reactions with the air. Very few
candidates wrote about the particles escaping from the liquid to form a vapour.
(ii) A minority of the candidates gained both marks. Those who scored one mark either did not give an
explanation or gave the state as being liquid. Some responses just referred to the melting or boiling
points as changing, which was insufficient. A significant number of candidates misunderstood the
negative signs and wrote statements such as ‘because –80°C is higher than –74°C’.
(b) (i) A majority of the candidates could describe the purpose of a catalyst. Many seemed to think that all
catalysts are enzymes. Common errors were to suggest that a catalyst changes the rate of reaction
and this was not a specific enough answer, or to refer to other properties of catalysts, e.g. ‘they are
not used up in the reaction’. Some candidates suggested incorrectly that catalysts do not take part
in the reaction.
(ii) Many candidates gave a suitable definition of oxidation. Others gave more than one definition and
sometimes contradicted themselves by writing incorrect statements such as ‘gain of electrons’ or
‘when you take the oxygen away’. Some candidates referred to the oxygen alone without reference
to any other element or gave vague answers such as ‘when you oxidise something’.
(c) (i) Many candidates identified the double bond. The commonest errors were to either refer to the CH3
group or to the OH group.
(ii) Some candidates knew the correct colour change when aqueous bromine reacts with an
unsaturated compound. Others either reversed the colours (colourless to orange) or guessed the
colour of the product, green, purple or blue being commonly seen. Common incorrect colours for
aqueous bromine were red or pink. A few candidates suggested white or clear for the colour of the
product, which was not accurate enough.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 4
Many candidates gave good answers to part (a), (c) and (e)(ii). Fewer were able to describe three ways in
which the properties of iron differ from those of potassium in part (b) and many did not use the equation
provided in part (d) to explain how the iron(III) oxide is reduced by hydrogen. The test for iron(II) ions in part
(e)(i) was not well known and in part (f) many candidates did not use all the information in the diagram.
(a) Some candidates gave the correct order of reactivity but many reversed the order completely.
Others seemed to rely on their existing knowledge of the reactivity series rather than using the
information in the table. This was obvious from the large number of candidates who wrote down
lists of relative reactivity either next to the question or on one of the blank pages.
(b) Many candidates gained one or two marks for correct comparisons of the properties of iron and
potassium but few gained all three marks. Many described properties which were common to both
metals e.g. conductivity. Some thought that one was a metal and the other was a non-metal or
described their relative positions in the Periodic Table. A significant number of candidates did not
mention which metal they were writing about. Many candidates did not score because they wrote
about electronic structure, valency or physical state or did not compare properties sufficiently well,
e.g. iron is malleable, rather than less malleable than potassium.
(c) Most candidates balanced the equation successfully. The 3(Fe) was the mark most often scored.
Common errors were 4(Fe) + 2(O2); 2(Fe) + 2(O2) and 2(Fe) + 3(O2).
(d) Many candidates gave a definition of reduction but did not apply the concept of reduction to the
equation. Others described the equation without explaining how it was a reduction. Many
candidates described the iron as losing oxygen rather than the iron oxide losing oxygen.
(e) (i) Very few candidates knew the test for iron(II) ions. A wide variety of incorrect test reagents were
seen including indicators (mainly litmus), flame tests, barium nitrate and hydrochloric acid. Many
described how iron chloride might be formed. A few suggested that a green precipitate would be
formed but used the incorrect test reagent. Of those who gave the correct test reagent, about half
suggested a red-brown precipitate.
(ii) Some candidates gave the correct molecular formula. The commonest error was to suggest FeCl 3.
Other common errors included FeCl 6, 2Fe6Cl or 2Fe + 6Cl. Some candidates disadvantaged
themselves by writing two formulae, one correct and one incorrect.
(f) Few scored more than one mark for this question. Many candidates only chose one bottle. Some
candidates realised that calcium chloride dries the air but then assumed that it removed oxygen as
well. Many candidates wrote conflicting statements. Some realised that air and water were
necessary for rusting but were unable to identify which of the bottles contained only air, only water
or both air and water.
Question 5
Most candidates gave a good answer to part (a) and many answered parts (b) and (c) correctly. Fewer
candidates predicted the correct electrode products in part (d). Even fewer identified the brown solution or
gave a correct explanation in part (e).
(a) Most candidates performed well. The commonest errors were: electroplating or heat, instead of
break down; element, instead of compound; gaseous or electroplating, instead of molten and
electroplating, instead of electricity. A few candidates did not select words from the list.
(b) Most candidates gained at least one mark. Some confused the anode with the cathode; others
labelled the electrolyte incorrectly. The commonest errors being to label the electrodes or the cell.
(c) Many candidates gave a suitable reason for using a graphite electrode. Others just stated that it
was a non-metal or gave irrelevant properties such as density, hardness or catalysis. A
considerable minority referred to cheapness.
(d) Some candidates realised that zinc is formed at the negative electrode. Fewer identified iodine
being formed at the positive electrode. Many reversed the products, having the zinc at the positive
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
electrode. Common errors, applying indiscriminately to each electrode, included hydrogen, oxygen
or zinc iodide. A significant number of candidates gave irrelevant answers such as ‘electrons’ and
‘neutrons’.
(e) A minority of candidates gained one mark and very few gained both marks. The commonest error
was to suggest that the brown colour was caused by the formation of bromine even though there
was no bromine or bromide in the equation. A considerable number of candidates suggested that
zinc chloride is the brown-coloured product. A few candidates recognised that chlorine is more
reactive than iodine, but most made the comparison with bromine, zinc bromide or zinc. Others
tried to give reasons unrelated to the reactivity series.
Question 6
Candidates responded well to some parts of this question, especially parts (b) and (d). The question about
the structure of the atom (part (a)) was less well answered with many candidates ignoring the position of the
sub-atomic particles. In part (c), some candidates knew about the medical uses of radioactive isotopes;
others did not take note of the word ‘medical’ in the stem of the question and wrote about other uses.
(a) The location of electrons was not made clear by many candidates. Statements such as ‘in energy
levels’ or ‘in shells’ were not sufficient to gain the mark. Many candidates suggested that ‘the
electrons are outside the atom’, rather than outside or surrounding the nucleus. Many gained only
three marks because they identified the correct number of number of electrons, protons and
neutrons but did not describe their position. Others described the position by trying to relate it to the
isotopic symbol, e.g. ‘the proton number is lower’ or ‘the neutrons plus protons are up’.
(b) Many candidates performed well. Element was nearly always seen.
Some candidates wrote ‘molecular’ or ‘nucleon’ in place of ‘atomic’ or ‘ions’ in place of ‘atoms’.
Others did not use words from the list as instructed.
(c) Some candidates ignored the word ‘medical’ in the stem of the question and described energy
production or testing for leakages in pipelines. Others wrote vague statements such as ‘in
medicines’ or incorrect statements such as ‘chemotherapy’.
(d) A majority of the candidates recognised the isotope of uranium. The commonest error was to
suggest the isotope of iodine. The isotope of xenon was also selected by a minority of candidates.
Question 7
Parts (a)(i), (a)(iii), (b) and (d) of this question were answered well by a majority of the candidates. In part
(a)(ii) the direction of the trend was not always made clear whilst in part (c), the correlation between the
basic nature of sodium oxide and the position of sodium in the Periodic Table was often missing or the
answers were too vague. In part (e) some candidates were able to complete the word equation correctly.
Others gave names which appeared to be a random arrangement of elements and compounds.
(a) (i) Most candidates gave suitable figures within the ranges so that a trend was followed. More
candidates made errors with the values for atomic radius than with the values for thermal
conductivity.
(ii) Some candidates did not make clear whether the direction of the trend in boiling point was
decreasing up or down the group. Others tried to link the trend in boiling point to the trend in atomic
radius or reactivity, often unsuccessfully.
(iii) Some candidates gave answers that were identical to the observations about the extent of bubbling
for potassium, e.g. ‘very rapid bubbling’. Others just suggested ‘bubbling’ without any further
qualification or suggested that there was ‘no reaction’. A significant number of candidates gave a
description that was not an observation such as ‘reacts rapidly’.
(b) Many candidates realised that an electron is lost when a sodium atom forms a sodium ion. The
commonest error was to suggest electron gain. A few candidates suggested that the sodium atom
gains a proton.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(c) Many candidates realised that sodium oxide is a basic oxide but a considerable number thought
that sodium oxide is an acidic oxide. The best answers focussed on the position of sodium in the
Periodic Table or the fact that sodium is a metal. Common errors included: ‘it is a less reactive
oxide’; ‘sodium gains protons’ or ‘sodium gains oxygen’.
(d) Many candidates calculated the relative formula mass correctly. The commonest errors were: to
use atomic numbers rather than atomic masses; to use a relative atomic mass of carbon of 16,
thus giving an answer of 92, or to not take the number of each atom into account, thus giving an
answer of 36.
(e) A minority of the candidates gained full credit for the word equation. A common error was to
suggest that hydrogen is formed instead of water. The salt was sometimes named as an incorrect
combination of elements and compounds, e.g. ‘sodium sulfuric oxide’, ‘sodium sulfuric acid’. Other
common errors were ‘sodium hydroxide’, ‘sodium sulfite’ or ‘sodium sulfide’.
Question 8
Some candidates gave good answers to most parts of this question but a considerable minority did not
attempt parts (c) and (d). Most candidates were able to read the volume of gas from the graph in part (b).
Fewer gave a convincing explanation of why the volume of hydrogen remains the same in part (a) or could
name the salt in part (d).
(a) Some candidates just paraphrased the stem of the question and wrote answers such as ‘the
hydrogen produced stays the same’. Others described a limit to the maximum amount of hydrogen
released without further explanation. A few candidates described correctly that hydrogen chloride
was the limiting reagent. Others did not take note of the term excess zinc in the stem of the
question and suggested that all the zinc had been used up.
(b) A majority of the candidates deduced the volume of gas correctly. The commonest error was to
misread the scale of the graph and give a value of 48 cm3 instead of 38 cm3.
(c) Many candidates gained credit for drawing a shallower gradient. Fewer gained credit for estimating
the final volume of hydrogen produced when the concentration of hydrochloric acid is halved. Many
drew curves which ended with the same overall volume and a significant number drew curves that
ended up higher than the 54 cm3 on the y-axis.
(d) Some candidates gave the correct name of the salt. Others either made up names such as
zinc hydrochloric acid or added elements that were not present in either reactant, e.g. oxygen
(incorrect answer: zinc oxide) or iodine (incorrect answer: zinc iodide).
(e) A majority of the candidates realised that the pH value of an acid is below pH 7. A significant
number suggested pH 7. Fewer suggested values of pH 9 or pH 13.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/32
Theory (Core)
Key messages
• Questions requiring simple answers to calculations were usually answered well, as were questions
involving balancing equations and organic definitions.
• Questions on more detailed aspects of kinetic particle theory needed to contain a more focused
explanation and attention to detail. Candidates needed to think more carefully when constructing their
answers.
• Some candidates needed more practice on answering questions requiring extended answers, e.g.
Questions 4(a) and 6(a). Questions involving extended writing need to contain the same number of
relevant points as the number of marks available. This should also be applied to any other question that
has more than one mark available.
• It is very important that candidates read the question carefully in order to understand what exactly is
being asked. This was particularly the case in Question 8(b). Practice of reading and interpreting data
based questions should also be prioritised.
• Many candidates needed more practice at answering questions involving the organic parts of the
syllabus. The questions that related to practical techniques, namely electrolysis, need to be
concentrated on and practised. More specific revision of the chemical tests specified in the syllabus
would also be an advantage to many candidates.
General comments
Many candidates tackled this paper well, showing a good knowledge of core Chemistry. Good answers were
shown throughout the paper to a number of different questions. Most candidates found parts of every
question challenging with the longer questions, in particular, being poorly answered. Nearly all candidates
were entered at the appropriate level but there were a few candidates who did not attempt several parts of
the question paper. It was evident that many candidates are now using past paper practice as part of their
revision program, but more revision is needed on some aspects of the syllabus.
Misinterpretation of the rubric did happen in some cases. The most common was in the question that asked
for ‘the greatest temperature rise per gram’. However, not reading the question properly was a key factor of
some making slight mistakes in their answers. The use of ‘chlorine’ instead of ‘chloride’ and ‘chloride’ instead
of ‘chlorine’ was seen and needs to be practiced. For example, in halogen displacement questions most
candidates thought the answer was ‘chlorine’ not ‘chloride’. The balancing of equations indicated that
candidates had practiced these as part of their revision from past papers. Definitions from across the
syllabus were poorly done and candidates need to concentrate on them both when being taught for the first
time and during the revision period.
The vast majority of candidates were able to ‘calculate the relative molecular mass’. However, a few
candidates used atomic numbers instead of mass numbers in this question. Most candidates could give at
least one answer to the comparison of manganese with sodium. Data handling type questions could have
been answered better. Candidates were much better at estimating melting points and densities.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Dot-and-cross diagrams were drawn very well as in the ‘dot-and-cross diagram for chlorine’. Candidates
needed to be more explicit when talking about certain concepts and not use the words ‘it’ and ‘they’ to
answer questions as this can lead to unclear responses. Some candidates wrote their answers as short
phrases or bullet points. Candidates are less likely to write vague statements or contradict themselves if this
is done.
Question 1
Candidates tackled this question reasonably well; some struggled with parts (a)(i) and (ii).
(a) (i) A very small proportion of candidates answered this question correctly. Candidates did not seem to
know that chlorine was the correct answer, with many thinking the answer was ammonia.
(ii) This question proved challenging. Candidates would have benefitted from revising the chemical
tests.
(iii) This was a well answered question – only a few candidates thought it was helium.
(iv) The products of incomplete combustion had not been revised enough and lots of different answers
were seen here.
(v) Candidates did not seem to know the correct answer here and ethane was seen quite a few times.
(b) (i) This was a well answered question with most candidates realising that diatomic meant two atoms
but two atomic was not allowed. Two or more atoms was also seen in a few instances.
(ii) This was one of the least well answered questions on the paper. Only a very small proportion of
candidates knew the definition for this, with it being something that needs to be concentrated on
when teaching this part of the syllabus.
(c) This was a very well answered question. Dot-and-cross diagrams have obviously been worked on.
Candidates needed to make sure that they counted how many electrons were in the outer shell
when they finished this question.
Question 2
Candidates answered this question well. The part question that most struggled with was (c)(i).
(a) (i) Calculators are a must for this type of question. Where candidates did not quite get the correct
answer, calculator error was probably the cause so candidates need to be encouraged to check
their keying in of numbers more than once on the calculator.
(ii) Only a very small minority of candidates did not achieve this mark.
(b) (i) This was a poorly answered question where some candidates thought they ‘caused cancer’ or were
‘poisonous/toxic’. Candidates need to learn at least one adverse effect for any of these gases that
are mentioned in the syllabus.
(ii) This was a very well answered question. Most of the candidates that were entered for this paper
can now balance equations with a degree of confidence.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(iii) More practice is needed on naming salts from formula. NO3– is nitrate not nitrite, as some
candidates thought. Some candidates thought that NO was nobelium and had obviously wasted
time looking through the Periodic Table to find it. Candidates need to know that capital letters are
new elements. NO is nitrogen and oxygen in this case. Sodium nitroxide was also seen in quite a
few different instances.
(c) (i) This question was not answered well. Some candidates thought that the answer was to do with
having enough solid dissolved in water, which showed that they had not read the first part of the
question which said that the ‘petrol contains saturated hydrocarbons’. Some candidates wrote
about single bonds but forgot to mention the word ‘only’.
(ii) Many candidates achieved at least one mark on this question. Candidates needed to realise the
word ‘only’ must be used again and that a hydrocarbon is a ‘compound’. Some candidates thought
that oxygen was present.
(d) This part question was well answered in many cases. The alkanes needed to be added together,
which most candidates could do. Not making slight mistakes on calculators and repeating a
calculation needs to be practiced.
Question 3
This proved to be a challenging question for most candidates. The structure of the alcohol group in (a)(ii)
was a problem to most candidates as well as (a)(iv) the polymer definition.
(a) (i) Many candidates did get five types of element but some missed out one element and got four –
probably not spotting the sulfur. More practice is needed in answering this type of question.
(ii) This question was not answered very well by most candidates, with many candidates circling
carbons as well as the ‘OH’ group. Many candidates also circled the ‘OH’ on the carboxylic acid
which was wrong. Some candidates did not attempt this question at all.
(iii) This was a well answered question. Candidates had obviously been taught this well and had
revised it in readiness for the examination.
(iv) Most candidates did not know this polymer definition and more practice is needed here.
(b) (i) This was a poorly answered question. Typical properties of acids were looked for, which
candidates did not know. ‘Reacts with sodium hydroxide’ or ‘reacts with a carbonate’ were correct
answers. Candidates did not put these down and instead talked about melting and boiling points.
Some candidates did get ‘pH below 7’.
(ii) Not many candidates achieved the mark here. Other groups were seen like alcohols and alkenes.
Candidates needed to practice the drawing of molecules. Some candidates did get the correct
answer but then others were nearly there but forgot the bond between the oxygen and hydrogen.
(c) (i) Many candidates worked out it was a solid. Some candidates realised that –120°C was below
–114°C as the justification for the solid answer. However, some candidates got mixed up with
negative numbers and how they work for temperatures and thought the temperature was above the
melting point. Many candidates had obviously practiced this type of question as part of their
preparation for the examination.
(ii) The second blank proved to be the hardest with not many candidates writing down ‘ethene’ here.
Candidates need to be reminded not to over write the ‘e’ and the ’a’ in an alkene and alkene, as
answers must be unambiguous. It is better for a candidate to cross the work out and rewrite it.
Candidates must be encouraged to do this as part of their examination technique. More revision on
the manufacture of ethanol needs to be done.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 4
Most candidates did well on this question, especially on (c)(ii), the balancing of the equation. Candidates
struggled on (c)(i), showing that chemical tests needed to be revised more. There was an improvement on
answering the ‘kinetic particle model’ question but candidates needed to mention the term molecules or
particles in their answer.
(a) There was some improvement in the answering of this ‘kinetic particle model’ question. However,
some forgot to mention the term particles or molecules ’in their answers. Further practice on this
type of question would be very helpful.
(b) Candidates answered this question well. Some got mixed up with the definition for oxidation and
put the definition for reduction instead. The gain and loss of electrons was also occasionally mixed
up.
(c) (i) Candidates found this part challenging. The chemical tests proved hard for candidates to recall.
More revision time should be used learning these tests and frequent revisiting in class would be
very advantageous. This part of the syllabus needs more time given to it.
(ii) The balancing of the equation was answered very well by most candidates.
(d) Most candidates could get the metals in the correct order. A few candidates used the term metal in
one of the boxes, which showed that they had not processed the boxes correctly.
(e) Not many candidates gained full credit here. Some candidates did not read the question properly
and talked about ‘going down the group’. In this sort of question, it is better for the candidates to
think about transition metal properties rather than just ordinary metal properties. It is also better for
candidates to be taught as part of exam technique to name the metals they are talking about rather
than calling them ‘it’ as sometimes it is hard to decide which metal is being talked about. All
responses must be unambiguous.
Question 5
Candidates struggled with part (a)(i) and did not know how to collect the gas from the electrodes. They also
struggled with (a)(iii), as they forgot the fact that it was an aqueous solution.
(a) (i) Only very few candidates got this question correct. This was probably the most challenging
question on the paper and lots of candidates did not answer it. Candidates did not realise that two
test-tubes placed over the two electrodes was sufficient. Candidates who did attempt the question
tried to cover the two electrodes with the same vessel (for example a beaker) and therefore were
not awarded the mark. Candidates who were experienced with the practical aspects of this course
were more likely to perform well here.
(ii) The vast majority of candidates were able to access and answer this question. A common incorrect
response was ‘canode’.
(iii) This was a poorly answered question, with candidates not reading the question properly and not
noticing the term aqueous. This meant that ‘sodium’ was given as the main product at the negative
electrode, which was incorrect. Some candidates gave ‘chloride’ instead of ‘chlorine’.
(iv) Some candidates did get the correct element here. Other candidates thought that other reactive
elements like copper could be used. Candidates would have benefited from more revision of
electrolysis experiments.
(b) (i) Most candidates got the correct answer here. Candidates must always ensure that they write down
the correct units, as ‘150 cm3’ was an incorrect answer.
(ii) Very few candidates achieved the correct answer here – most of them thinking that the melting
point ‘increased’.
(c) This practical based question was poorly answered. ‘Crystallisation’ or ‘evaporation’ are the main
answers that were seen in some cases but many candidates did not use those words successfully.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 6
Part (a) was answered well by most candidates. Many candidates did not know the in-depth definition of the
term isotopes in part (b).
(a) This was a very well answered question, especially by the candidates who went on to gain the
higher marks on this paper. These candidates were able to easily answer about the numbers of
protons, neutrons and electrons in the stated isotope and also to say where the sub-atomic
particles were in the atom. Some candidates did misinterpret this question by thinking the position
meant where the sub-atomic particles were in terms of how the symbol is written; for example
‘protons are found at the bottom of the symbol’.
(b) Candidates did not seem to know the in-depth definition of the term isotope. Some could say that
there are the ‘same numbers of protons but different numbers of neutrons’ but forgot to use the fact
that they are ‘atoms’. More revision of definitions was needed here.
(c) Candidates needed to read the question carefully, as it was asking for ‘one industrial use’ – many
candidates put a ‘medical’ use of radioactive isotopes.
Question 7
Parts of this question were answered well including (a)(i) and (c). Candidates struggled with the ‘density of
chlorine’ in part (a)(ii) and they had not mastered the displacement word equations from the halogens part of
this course in part (b).
(a) (i) Most candidates could identify the trends in melting points and densities of the halogens and they
put the correct figures into the table. Candidates need to be discouraged from using ranges of
numbers because these usually fall outside the allowed parameters. It is not always a good idea for
candidates to use numbers too near to the lower or upper parameter. It is best to use numbers in
the middle. Not many candidates realised that the colours got darker down the group.
(ii) This was a poorly answered question by most candidates, as they did not realise that chlorine is a
‘gas’ at room temperature and that is why its density is lower than that of bromine and astatine.
(iii) Some candidates needed to expand their answer. ‘Increases’ was not enough, as the trend was
not wholly identified. ‘Increases down the group’ was the appropriate answer and candidates must
be encouraged to practice these questions more.
(b) This question was poorly answered. Candidates struggled with the products of a halogens
displacement reaction. ‘Potassium bromine’ was seen, as well as ‘bromine iodide’. More practice is
needed when studying this part of the course. Not many completely correct answers were seen
here.
(c) Candidates were well practiced at this relative molecular mass question, showing much practice
and revision. Not many wrong answers were seen here. Some candidates did use atomic numbers
instead of masses.
Question 8
Candidates answered parts (e)(i) and (iii) well but struggled with parts (a) and (b).
(a) Some candidates got both answers correct. Candidates struggled with the practical aspects and
this is something that needs to be concentrated on. Typical wrong answers were ‘same amount of
fuel’ and ‘same starting temperature’. Candidates were better to ‘keep the distance of the flame to
the can the same’ and the ‘same volume of water’.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(b) This question was very poorly answered by all candidates. Most candidates used the answer ‘C’
which was wrong – they did not spend enough time on the question and read it carefully enough.
Candidates needed to give the ‘greatest temperature rise per gram’. It was evident that candidates
did not spend enough time reading the question properly.
(c) It is a good idea for candidates to know at least two uses of the substances mentioned for uses in
the syllabus. It was evident that some candidates only knew that ethanol was used as a ‘fuel’, as
they used this in their answer even though it was mentioned at the start of the question. This is a
good reason to know at least two uses.
(d) (i) Candidates did get mixed up with this question and lots of different answers were seen. If a straight
forward word equation for complete combustion had been asked for, then most candidates would
have achieved the two marks but in this question a little bit more reading and thinking was needed.
(ii) Using the information in the diagram to explain the answer was a challenge for most candidates.
Explaining energy profile diagrams needs to be practiced more. Pointing out which has the most
energy, reactants or products, is a good starting point here.
(e) (i) The definition of the term alloy was generally good. Candidates had learned the definition and
obviously practiced it. Some candidates thought it was a ‘combination’ of metals and a few thought
that an alloy just had non-metals in it.
(ii) Not many candidates could answer the ‘arrangement’ part of this question correctly and talked
‘tightly packed’ instead of a ‘lattice’ or ‘regular’ arrangement. More candidates could get the ‘type of
motion’ part with the correct answer of ‘vibration’.
(iii) This last question was very well answered with candidates able to talk about the fact that stainless
steel does not corrode or iron does. Candidates must guard against talking about iron being
‘corrosive’.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/33
Theory (Core)
Key messages
• It is important that candidates read questions carefully in order to understand what is exactly being
asked.
• Many candidates needed more practice in memorising the meaning of chemical terms such as
compound or hydrocarbon.
• The balancing of simple equations and extraction of data from tables was generally well done.
General comments
Many candidates tackled this paper well, showing a good knowledge of core Chemistry. Nearly all
candidates were entered at the appropriate level. Most candidates attempted all parts of each question. The
exceptions were Questions 4(a)(ii), 5(d), 7(a)(i), 7(a)(i), 7(b), 7(c) and (8)(e) where a significant number of
candidates did not respond.
Many candidates needed more practice in questions involving qualitative analysis. For example, very few
candidates knew the test for water using cobalt chloride (Question 3(b)(ii)), the test for an unsaturated
hydrocarbon (Question 4(a)(ii)) or the test for bromide ions (Question 5(f)).
Some candidates needed more practice in reading and interpreting questions. The rubric was misinterpreted
or ignored by some candidates. In Question 2(a)(i) the words ‘on health’ were ignored. In Question 3(g),
many candidates did not refer to the equation as instructed in the stem of the question, whilst in Question
4(b)(iii) some candidates did not choose a ‘use in industry’ as asked for by the question. In Question 6(a) a
considerable number of candidates did not write about the position of the sub-atomic particles in the atom.
Many candidates needed more practice in answering questions involving chemical terms without
contradicting themselves. For example, in Question 1(b)(ii), many candidates wrote about single atoms or
compounds rather than elements and in Question 6(c) some candidates suggested that nucleons were only
protons or the mass of the element.
Some candidates needed more practice in answering extended questions such as 3(a) (diffusion) and 6(a)
(position and number of sub-atomic particles).
Questions involving general chemistry, including organic chemistry, were generally tackled well by many
candidates. Many candidates were able to balance simple equations and extract relevant information from
tables of data. Others needed more practice in naming salts, describing how a soluble salt can be separated
from an insoluble salt and in understanding the reactions of halogens with halide ions.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 1
Most candidates identified two of the gases correctly in part (a) but only a minority of the candidates
identified the gas that forms an acidic solution in part (i) or identified the monatomic gas in part (ii). In part (b)
most candidates identified two elements in (b)(i); fewer gave a convincing explanation of the term element in
(b)(ii). The dot-and-cross diagram in part (c) was generally well answered.
(a) (i) A minority of the candidates identified hydrogen chloride. The commonest error was to suggest
ammonia. The next most common error was to suggest ethene.
(ii) A minority of the candidates correctly identified helium as being monatomic. The commonest error
was to suggest hydrogen. Other common errors were ammonia or methane.
(iii) Some candidates correctly identified nitrogen as forming 78% of dry air. Hydrogen was the
commonest incorrect answer. The next most common error was methane.
(iv) Some candidates correctly identified methane as the main constituent of natural gas. Hydrogen
was the commonest incorrect answer. Hydrogen chloride or ammonia were other errors seen.
(v) Many candidates were able to identify the molecule containing 14 protons. The commonest error
was to suggest hydrogen chloride.
(b) (i) Nearly all the candidates were able to identify two elements from the list.
(ii) A minority of the candidates gave a good definition of the term element. Many answers were too
vague to give credit, e.g. ‘a set of one atom’, ‘two or more atoms together’, ‘a product in the
Periodic Table’. Better performing candidates wrote about substance containing only one sort of
atom. A significant number of candidates wrote ‘the same type of molecule’, which could apply to
ammonia or hydrogen chloride’.
(c) Many candidates drew a correct dot-and-cross diagram for hydrogen chloride. Some only gave a
bonding pair of electrons. Common errors included: too many electrons on the chlorine atom; one
or no bonding electrons or addition of extra non-bonding electrons on the hydrogen atom.
Question 2
This question was generally the best-answered on the paper. Many candidates gained full credit for parts
(a)(i), (b) and (c). Fewer gained full credit for comparing the composition of the exhaust gases in part (a)(ii)
or for giving one adverse effect of sulfur dioxide on health in part (a)(ii).
(a) (i) Most candidates gave the correct answer. The commonest errors arose from not including all the
figures in the addition.
(ii) Many candidates gave at least two differences in the composition of the exhaust gases. Others
wrote statements that were too vague, e.g. ‘there is a greater volume of gases, which are not
harmful in petrol’ or ‘there is more volume of gases in the petrol engine than the diesel’.
(iii) Some candidates gave a correct effect of sulfur dioxide on health. Others did not focus on the word
‘health’ in the stem of the question and gave answers such as ‘hazardous for the environment’ or
‘acid rain’. Some answers were incorrect because they either referred to disease or cancer. A
significant number of candidates appeared to muddle the effect of sulfur dioxide with that of carbon
monoxide.
(b) Nearly all the candidates filled in the gaps in the sentences correctly. The commonest errors were
‘density’ or ‘crystallisation’ (instead of distillation), ‘poly(ethene)’ (instead of kerosene) and
‘poly(ethene)’ (instead of boiling).
(c) Most candidates were able to balance the equation. The commonest errors were 3(H2O) and
2(CO2). Those who made errors, generally gave an incorrect balance for the carbon dioxide. A
significant number of candidates gave a balance of 2(H2O) and 2(CO2).
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 3
Parts (b)(i), (d) and (f) were answered well by many candidates. Many did not give detailed enough answers
to part (a) (diffusion) and (g) (reduction). Few knew the test for water using anhydrous cobalt chloride (part
(b)(ii)). Some candidates were able to give three differences between cobalt and lithium in part (e). Others
wrote answers that were too vague.
(a) Some candidates recognised that diffusion was occurring. Few explained diffusion in terms of the
particles moving randomly from areas of higher concentration to areas of lower concentration.
Many just described the cobalt chloride moving or the colour moving. A minority of the candidates
did not recognise the physical process of diffusion and described chemical reactions in the solution.
(b) (i) Many candidates recognised the symbol for a reversible reaction. Common errors included:
‘balanced equation’; ‘same reactants and products’ or ‘turns into products’.
(ii) Few candidates knew the test for water using anhydrous cobalt chloride. Many confused it with the
test for water using anhydrous copper sulfate, often giving the colours the wrong way round. Others
confused it with the bromine water test for unsaturation. Common incorrect colours for the
anhydrous cobalt chloride included orange, red and white. Common incorrect colours for the
hydrated cobalt chloride included brown, blue and colourless.
(c) Some candidates wrote the correct molecular formula. Others disadvantaged themselves by writing
the formula as CO2C8O8. Other common errors were: 2CoC8O8, CO28CO or 2Co8C8O.
(d) Some candidates gave the correct order of reactivity but many reversed the order completely.
Others seemed to rely on their existing knowledge of the reactivity series rather than using the
information in the table. This was obvious from those candidates who wrote down lists of relative
reactivity either next to the question or on one of the blank pages.
(e) Some candidates gained credit for correct comparisons of the properties of cobalt and lithium but
few gained full credit. Many described properties that were common to both metals, e.g.
conductivity. Some thought that one was a metal and the other was a non-metal or described their
relative positions in the Periodic Table. A significant number of candidates did not mention which
metal they were writing about. It was assumed that if no name was mentioned, that the answer
referred to cobalt. Many candidates did not score because they wrote about electronic structure,
number of protons or physical state or did not compare properties sufficiently well, e.g. cobalt is
malleable (rather than less malleable than lithium). Others wrote statements that were too vague,
e.g. cobalt is heavier than lithium.
(f) Many candidates balanced the equation correctly. The commonest incorrect answer was to
suggest 2(CoO).
(g) Many candidates gave a definition of reduction but did not apply the concept of reduction to the
equation. Others described the equation without explaining how it was a reduction. Many
candidates described the cobalt losing oxygen rather than the cobalt oxide losing oxygen. Others
wrote answers that were too vague, e.g. ‘the oxygen and cobalt split apart’.
Question 4
Parts (a)(i), and (b)(ii) were answered well by many candidates. Many did not know the test for an
unsaturated compound in part (a)(ii) and many candidates did not respond to this part. Better performing
candidates were able to draw the structure of ethanol in part (b). A minority of the candidates gave a suitable
use of ethanol in industry in part (b)(iii) and few could explain the energy level diagram in part (b)(iv) or state
the name of two products formed when ethanol burns in a limited supply of air in part (b)(v).
(a) (i) Many candidates identified the C=C bond as being responsible for unsaturation. The commonest
errors were to refer to either the OH or CH2 group or to suggest that there were ‘missing bonds’.
(ii) A minority of the candidates knew the correct colour change when aqueous bromine reacts with an
unsaturated compound. Others either reversed the colours (colourless to orange) or guessed the
colour of the product, green, white, orange or blue being commonly seen. Common incorrect
colours for aqueous bromine were red or blue. A few candidates suggested white or transparent for
the colour of the product, which was not accurate enough.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(iii) Some candidates gave good answers relating the temperature of –120°C to its position between
the melting point and the boiling point. Most candidates who chose the correct state (liquid) only
wrote about one of the fixed points, e.g. ‘liquid because it is above the melting point’. Others gave
vague answers such as: ‘the melting point is 9 degrees away’ or ‘it’s about to reach its boiling
point’.
(b) (i) A minority of the candidates drew the correct structure of ethanol. The commonest errors were to
show the presence of a double bond, to draw the structure of ethane or to draw the carbon
attached to the OH group with five bonds.
(ii) Most candidates gained at least two marks. The commonest errors were salt (instead of sugar),
300°C (instead of 30°C), sugar (instead of enzymes) and electrolysis (instead of distillation).
(iii) Very few candidates gave a suitable use of ethanol in industry. Many suggested its use as a fuel or
oil despite the word ‘fuel’ being in the stem of the question. Others gave non-industrial uses such
as ‘rubbing alcohol’, ‘for drinking’ or ‘preservatives’. A significant number of candidates thought that
ethanol is used in fertilisers.
(iv) Many candidates did not gain credit because they did not refer to the diagram and only gave a
definition of an endothermic reaction. Others gave vague answers such as ‘energy goes from top to
bottom’ or just referred to the equation.
(v) Many candidates gained only one mark because one of the products suggested was water, which
is in the stem of the question. Other common errors included hydrogen or oxygen. A few suggested
methane.
Question 5
Some candidates responded well to this question, especially in parts (a) and (f). Others suggested that
gases were given off during the electrolysis in part (b) or that elements other than those present in the
electrolyte were formed. Few gave correct descriptions of the salt preparation in part (c) or identified the
orange-brown substance in part (d). The colour of silver bromide in part (e) was known by very few.
(a) Many candidates were able to give the name of the positive electrode. Common incorrect answers
included ‘cnathode, pathode, anion and graphite’.
(b) Some candidates gained one mark but few gained both marks. Some wrote lead(II) (equivalent to
Pb2+) instead of lead. Others suggested that gases such as hydrogen and oxygen were produced,
perhaps thinking that the electrolyte was an aqueous solution. A significant number of candidates
either gave electrode products that did not relate to the electrolyte, e.g. copper, or gave the names
of compounds, e.g. lead bromide.
(c) A minority of the candidates gave a suitable method for getting crystals of lead bromide from the
mixture. Many either did not add water or added acids instead of water. The process of filtration
was absent from many answers. Many suggested evaporating the solids formed. Others did not
explain the process of crystallisation sufficiently and wrote vague answers such as ‘let the solution
rest’.
(d) Some candidates identified bromine as the element responsible for the orange-brown colour.
Others suggested sodium bromide, sodium, an inter-halogen compound or sodium chloride plus
bromine.
Very few candidates gave a suitable reason and some referred to chlorine being reactive instead of
comparing the reactivity with bromine. The most common error was to compare the reactivity of
chlorine with sodium or bromide ions. A significant number of candidates wrote vague statements
about electrons or the balance of the equation.
(e) Few candidates knew the colour of silver bromide. The commonest incorrect answers were white
or yellow.
(f) A majority of the candidates recognised that an electron is gained when a chloride ion is formed
from a chlorine atom. The commonest incorrect answer was to suggest a proton.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 6
Some candidates gave good answers to part (a) (atomic structure). Others did not respond to the part of the
question asking about the position of the subatomic particles. Many candidates gained at least one of the
two marks available in part (b). Fewer could describe the term nucleon number satisfactorily in part (c).
(a) The location of electrons was not made clear by many candidates. Statements such as ‘they are in
energy levels’ or ‘in shells’ were not sufficient to gain the mark. Many candidates suggested that
‘the electrons are outside the atom’, rather than outside or surrounding the nucleus. Many gained
only three marks because they identified the correct number of electrons, protons and neutrons but
did not describe their position. Others described the position by trying to relate it to the isotopic
symbol, e.g. ‘the proton number is lower’ or ‘the neutrons plus protons are up’.
(b) Many candidates gained at least one mark for a correct statement about isotopes. The commonest
error was to tick the top box (isotopes of the same element have different numbers of protons).
(c) A minority of the candidates realised that the term nucleon refers to both neutrons and protons.
The commonest errors were: ‘the number of neutrons’, ‘the mass of the atom’, ‘the number that the
element has’ or ‘the number in the nucleon’.
Question 7
Many candidates performed reasonably well in this question, especially in parts (a)(i) and (d). In part (b)
some candidates could write the electronic structure of sodium correctly. Others did not appear to
understand the meaning of this term. Part (c) was least well answered, with many candidates writing vague
answers for the explanation of alkalinity and the use of indicators to show that a solution is alkaline.
(a) (i) Most candidates gave suitable figures within the ranges so that a trend was followed. More
candidates made errors with the values for melting point than with the values for relative hardness.
(ii) Many candidates gave suitable observations mentioning slow bubbling. The commonest incorrect
answer was ‘no reaction’. Others wrote ‘bubbling’ (unqualified) or wrote general comments about
reactivity instead of giving observations.
(b) Few candidates were able to deduce the electronic structure of sodium. Many just wrote Na or
gave the total number of electrons. A few candidates wrote structures in the form 1s22s2, etc.
These candidates almost invariably gave the incorrect electronic structure.
(c) (i) Some candidates focussed on the sodium hydroxide or hydroxide ions being responsible for the
alkalinity. The commonest error was to suggest that the hydrogen is alkaline in nature. Many
candidates wrote answers about neutralisation or the loss of atoms or electrons.
(ii) Many candidates were able to select a suitable indicator, Universal Indicator generally being the
indicator of choice. Fewer were able to give a correct colour in alkaline solution, yellow, green or
red being the colours most often suggested.
(d) Most candidates calculated the relative formula mass correctly. The commonest incorrect answers
were 20 (using atomic numbers) or 35 (not multiplying the number of hydrogen atoms by 4).
Question 8
Many candidates gave good answers to part (a) and (c). Fewer were able to describe fully how the
apparatus was used in part (b) or to relate the size of the pieces of calcium carbonate to the rate of reaction
in part (d). In part (e) many candidates either named the salt incorrectly or gave products other than carbon
dioxide and water.
(a) Many candidates identified the measuring cylinder. The commonest incorrect answer was ‘test-
tube’. References to beakers or flasks were not uncommon.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(b) Few candidates gave convincing descriptions about how the apparatus could be used to measure
the rate of reaction. A common error was to state ‘measure the volume of the substance’ without
referring to which volume was to be measured. A significant minority thought that it was the volume
of the acid and zinc that should be measured. Many just referred to liquid levels without reference
to the volume of gas. Others suggested counting bubbles or gave answers that were irrelevant to
the question, e.g. ‘the more the gas, the higher the rate of reaction’. Most candidates that gained a
mark did so for a reference to time rather than measuring the volume of gas.
(c) Many candidates recognised that the reaction rate would be less or the reaction would be slower.
Others did not gain the mark because their answers were not comparative, e.g. the reaction is
slow. A significant number of candidates wrote about the reaction decreasing, rather than the
reaction rate decreasing.
(d) Some candidates were able to relate the size of the pieces of calcium carbonate to the rate of
reaction. The commonest error was to suggest small pieces (medium rate of reaction), powder
(slowest reaction) and large pieces (fastest reaction). Some candidates wrote numbers in the left
hand column instead of sizes.
(e) Very few candidates gained two marks for this question. The commonest errors were to write
‘calcium hydroxide’ or ‘salt’ instead of calcium chloride. Hydrogen was often written instead of
carbon dioxide or water. A few candidates wrote sulfur instead of sodium. Others suggested
organic compounds.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/41
Theory (Extended)
Key messages
• Candidates should be reminded to use precise terms and words where applicable. For example, there
was frequent incorrect use of terms in Question 1(a) where it was frequently written that two atoms
make a compound or in 6(b) where it was frequently written that one element replaces a molecule.
• Candidates should be reminded that if a specified number of characteristics of a substance is asked for,
such as Questions 2(e), 3(a), 5(a)(ii), 5(b) and 5(e)(iii), then no more than this number should appear in
the answer; any incorrect characteristics given may be viewed as a contradiction to the correct
responses.
• Better performing candidates had good examination techniques, such as underlining of command words
in the questions. Candidates should be encouraged to read questions carefully.
• Candidates should look to make answers concise and keep to the space available. Better performing
candidates made use of simple bullet points rather than long paragraphs; this was seen frequently in
Question 3(b).
General comments
Working should be shown in calculations and this working should be set out so that it can be followed. This
will allow method marks to be awarded in calculations even if the final answer is incorrect.
When a question asks for a chemical equation a word equation will not be accepted. Where a word equation
is asked for, candidates should refrain from writing a chemical equation as these are more difficult and
increase the likelihood that an error will be made.
Question 1
(a) Most candidates were able to explain the term compound. Candidates who performed less well
showed a lack of understanding of the linking of basic terms such as atoms, molecules and
elements.
(b) Most candidates knew this straight forward method of separation. Many omitted to attempt the
dissolving stage and it was evident that a significant number of candidates assumed that
evaporation and crystallisation were separate stages.
(c) (i) The name of the condenser was well known; a minority realised that cooling water needs to enter
at the lower aperture only.
(ii) Most candidates included a bung in the diagram accompanied with the logical response that it
prevented alcohol vapours escaping. Some candidates opted to draw a thermometer but often left
substantial gaps either sides of it. The need for a thermometer was less well understood.
(iii) A minority of candidates knew that the flammability of alcohols was the reason to avoid using a
Bunsen burner. Several common misconceptions, such as a lack of temperature control of the
mixture or possible cracking of the flask, were seen.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(iv) Some excellent answers were seen; there were also some imprecise answers with much confusion
between evaporation, boiling and melting. Such responses indicated that the candidate was not
familiar with the use of a water bath and did not realise that a water bath could not be heated to the
temperatures needed to boil the alcohols. A common error was to assume that the boiling points of
alcohols C and D were too close together.
Question 2
(a) Most candidates were able to determine that element Z must be calcium; neon was a commonly
seen error.
(b) Nearly all candidates indicated knowledge of what periods are in the Periodic Table; many
mis-counted and assumed Fl was in Period 6.
(c) Most candidates were able to use the copy of the Periodic Table provided to spot that Fl was a
Group 4 element and would have four outer shell electrons.
(d) (i) The term radioisotopes was not well known. The most common error was to attempt a definition of
isotopes.
(e) (i) Most candidates were able to give two physical properties that are typical of metals. Many
candidates opted to give more than two properties. This was not asked for and some candidates
contradicted previously correct responses.
(ii) Many candidates did not understand the difference between physical and chemical properties and
gave physical properties as the answer. Better performing candidates knew that the oxide of a
metal would be basic.
Question 3
(a) The correct answer, hot air, was seldom seen. Oxygen was the popular wrong answer. Many other
incorrect answers were seen, ranging from iron ore to zinc blende.
(b) There were some well written, well-structured and suitably detailed answers. Many candidates
clearly worked hard to learn this industrial process thoroughly. Candidates who performed less well
found this process difficult to recall or difficult to sequence correctly. Candidates are advised to use
a bullet point approach and to use short sentences.
(c) Carbon was well known as the main impurity of iron extracted from the blast furnace; very few
stated that oxygen needs to be blown through molten iron and also did not realise the significance
that carbon dioxide was able to escape as a gas.
Question 4
(a) Relatively few candidates realised that the definition was in fact that of relative atomic mass. ‘Mole’,
‘Avogadro’s constant’ and ‘relative molecular mass’ were popular alternatives.
(b) The origin of the different terms was not well known with most candidates not appreciating the ionic
and covalent nature of the two substances. A common mistake was to focus on butane being
organic and KF being a compound.
(c) Many candidates were able to calculate the correct answer to this demanding question but having
arrived at a relative molecular mass value of 38, did not realise that this gas must be fluorine (F2).
Common incorrect identities included strontium and potassium.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(d) Candidates were not confident in the mathematical method to find an empirical formula. A
significant proportion of candidates rounded calculated values too soon in the calculation, leading
to incorrect whole number ratios of moles. Many candidates did not calculate the mass of oxygen in
the compound as an initial step of the calculation, but credit could still be earned for the rest of the
work provided clear working out was shown.
(e) Candidates found this question challenging. Having determined the molecular formula of the oxide
or the relative formula mass of P2O3 or even P4O6, they went on to do irrelevant calculations
instead of determining the relative molecular mass.
Question 5
(a) (i) The term catalyst was familiar to candidates as something which increased the rate of a reaction
but remained unchanged at the end of the reaction. It is not strictly true that catalysts do not take
any part in the reaction, the key point is that they remain unchanged at the end of the reaction.
Some candidates assumed catalysts had to be enzymes.
(ii) Many candidates repeated properties given in the question such as ‘forms coloured ions’ or gave
physical properties instead of a chemical property which was asked for.
(b) The physical properties given were usually correct; some candidates did not appreciate that this
question referred to physical properties of transition metals, which were not shared with Group 1
metals and gave the same general physical properties of metals as already seen in 2(e)(i).
(c) (i) The products of this reaction were often correct but a significant number of candidates omitted
state symbols or erroneously assumed ZnSO4 to be (s).
(ii) This part was not well-attempted. Where candidates did realise where the activation energy arrow
should go, many arrows were of the wrong length or were double-headed.
(iii) The vast majority identified the reaction as being exothermic but the reason was often inadequately
stated or was flawed. One common flaw was to include comments about the energy needed for
bond formation or the energy released when bonds are broken.
(d) Very few correct energy profiles for a catalysed reaction were seen.
(i) Most candidates attempted an ionic half-equation and copper was frequently seen as the product.
State symbols were often omitted.
(ii) Non-observational responses such as ‘copper is formed’ were frequently given. Candidates should
be aware that observations need two parts: firstly, the colour, secondly the state of the substance.
In this case, ‘pink solid’ was expected.
(iii) Better performing candidates knew that the blue colour of the solution would fade and that
effervescence would also take place. Candidates should remember that a colourless gas cannot be
seen so is not an observation.
(iv) Better performing candidates realised that a green gas would be seen. Non-creditworthy responses
included ‘chlorine is made’, which missed out the key details of what would actually be seen.
Question 6
(b) Better performing candidates knew that saturated referred to all bonds being single. To say ‘it has
single C–C bonds’ is not correct as alkenes (apart from ethene and propene) have at least 2 C–C
bonds. Some candidates incorrectly wrote about saturated solutions.
(c) (i) Many candidates understood the principle of substitution but did not adequately describe the
process in terms of one atom taking the place of another atom.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(ii) The need for ultraviolet light (or sunlight) was known by many candidates
(iii) It was expected that candidates would give the products of mono-substitution (C2H5Cl + HCl ) but
frequently di-substituted C2H4Cl2 was given along with H2, which indicated some understanding of
the idea of substitution.
(d) (i) Candidates were aware of the concept of an addition reaction but did not state the key point that
only one product is formed. As an alternative, the idea of the C=C double bond being broken was
accepted. Imprecise answers included simple statements such as ‘because bromine is added to
the molecule’ and these could not be credited.
(ii) Candidates found this a challenging question. A large number of the candidates who gave a
dibromo- product attached the bromines each to C1 and C3 whereas others attached both bromines
to the same C atom. Some drew dibromoethene.
(e) Most candidates realised that but-2-ene was the unbranched isomer required and could
successfully draw and name the isomer. Some correct structures were shown which were not fully
displayed.
(ii) The completion of the equation was reasonably well attempted. Better performing candidates
included continuation bonds bisecting brackets and the use of a subscript ‘n’.
(g) Most candidates were able to draw at least one amide link but very few were able to orientate both
amide links in the correct alignment for the part of the protein shown.
(h) Better performing candidates recognised the ester as ethyl butanoate and consequently gave the
names of the reactants as ethanol and butanoic acid. Only a small minority of candidates realised
that water is also a product. Some candidates did not notice that a word equation was asked for.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/42
Theory (Extended)
Key messages
• Candidates are advised to write equations on one line as opposed to starting on one line and carrying
on the next line. In such cases, it is often unclear what the products are and what the reactants are.
• Candidates should be aware of the precise meaning of the terms electrolysis, electrolyte and electrode.
Although they all start with the same letters, they have very different meanings.
• Candidates should understand the meanings of the terms filter, filtrate and residue as applied to the
process of filtration.
General comments
Working should be shown in calculations and this working should be set out so that it can be followed. This
will allow method marks to be awarded in calculations even if the final answer is incorrect.
When a question asks for a chemical equation a word equation will not be accepted. Where a word equation
is asked for, candidates should refrain from writing a chemical equation as these are more difficult and
increase the likelihood that an error will be made.
Question 1
(e) Spelling occasionally proved to be a problem but phonetic answers were credited.
Question 2
Candidates generally answered this question well and were familiar with the Period 3 elements.
(c) Magnesium was seen occasionally but was incorrect as it does not need to be stored in oil.
(e) Argon was well known as a gas that provides an inert atmosphere in lamps.
(f) Some candidates were under the impression that they had to identify two elements rather than one
element that can form two oxides.
(g) Sulfur was seen occasionally rather than phosphorus in phosphate fertilisers.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 3
This was answered extremely well by the majority of candidates. The charge on the iron(II) ion was a
common omission. The number of electrons was occasionally given as 16 or 17. Ba was occasionally given
as an alternative to Fe.
Question 4
(a) Br was often seen as the formula of bromine. K2 was occasionally seen as potassium (the 2 being
used to balance the equation). The formulae of both elements were occasionally shown with
charges. State symbols were often incorrect and candidates need to take care when choosing state
symbols. It was often stated that bromine was a gas at room temperature and that potassium
bromide was formed in aqueous solution.
(b) (i) Attempts to explain the term ionic lattice required candidates to state that positive and negative
ions are arranged in a regular pattern rather than simply using the terms ionic and/or lattice that
were given in the question.
(ii) Incorrect use of the term free instead of moving / mobile was seen frequently. It is unnecessary to
use the word free to answer this question because it contributes nothing to the answer. Free and
moving are different things.
(c) (i) Answers to this question were often confused. Candidates are advised to start an answer to similar
questions with ‘An electrolyte is a substance...’
(ii) Potassium, rather than hydrogen, was occasionally given as the product at the cathode. Hydrogen
and bromine were occasionally given as products at the wrong electrodes (oppositely charged).
Potassium oxide and occasionally potassium bromide were given as the name of the potassium
compound formed.
(iii) Even though potassium bromide is a compound containing potassium and bromine only, it was not
uncommon to see elements other than potassium and bromine given in answer to this question.
Hydrogen was sometimes seen as the answer, particularly by those who gave potassium as the
cathode product in (c)(ii).
(d) (i) I and Cl were regularly seen instead of I2 and Cl 2. Some equations that used correct formulae
were unbalanced. Species with charges were occasionally seen.
Some candidates unsuccessfully attempted to work out the electron configuration of an iodine atom
using the atomic number of 53. This often led to iodine atoms with 17 (or sometimes 3) electrons in
the outer shell. Candidates who answered this question successfully realised that because iodine is
in Group VII, an iodine atom has seven electrons in its outer shell.
Better performing candidates gave the following response to achieve all three marks:
• When potassium bromide melts, its strong ionic bonds break. When iodine monochloride
melts, its weak intermolecular forces break.
The presence of ionic bonds in potassium bromide was often qualified as meaning forces of
attraction between atoms or molecules.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Bonds should be described as strong or weak as opposed to high or low or even large or small.
(f) (i) The most common errors were using Cl instead of Cl 2 and showing electrons on the wrong side.
(ii) Statements such as ‘bromide oxidises’ should be avoided. It is not clear whether the meaning is
that bromide becomes oxidised itself or bromide oxidises something else. ‘They oxidise
themselves’ is similarly ambiguous. Bromide ion is oxidised is preferable.
Question 5
(a) The forward reaction is equal to the backward reaction was frequently seen. Very few candidates
referred to concentrations of all reactants and products being constant (unchanging) when
equilibrium was established. If there was reference to concentration, it was usually to say
concentrations become equal rather than constant.
(b) (i) ‘The gas syringe was blocked’ was seen quite often. Responses should have stated that there
were the same number of moles of gas on both sides of the equilibrium.
(ii) Candidates found this challenging. Despite being told that ‘the position of the equilibrium did not
change’, many candidates suggested that the mixture turned darker purple because more iodine
had been produced. Some candidates attempted an explanation in terms of increase in
temperature or in terms of kinetics. Those who said ‘the gas was compressed’ were merely
rewriting the question instead of suggesting why there was a change in colour intensity.
(c) (i) Candidates should be aware that if temperature increases, equilibrium will shift in the direction of
endothermic change. In this case, the equilibrium shifts to the left.
(ii) It was very common to see answers of both increase and decrease. This is because candidates
confuse rate with equilibrium. All chemical reactions (with the exception of enzyme catalysed
reactions) occur at increased rates if temperature is increased. Thus, in an equilibrium such as the
one referred to in this question both forward and reverse reactions occur at increased rates if the
temperature is increased.
Question 6
(a) Many candidates gave formulae of reactants, even though names were requested. Many
candidates started with barium carbonate. Others started with insoluble or otherwise inappropriate
reactants. Many candidates omitted to mention that a precipitation reaction requires the mixing of
two aqueous solutions. Candidates should be careful with terminology, the filtrate is the liquid
which passes through the filter paper in filtration. The term filtrate has a different meaning to filter.
Washing the residue was often omitted.
The equation often contained incorrect formulae such as BaNO3 and/or NaCO3. It was not
uncommon to see Br as symbol for barium in the equation. Those with correct formulae were often
unbalanced.
(b) (i) O2 was the product most likely to be identified. NaO and NO2 were commonly seen as incorrect
products. Other incorrect products included NO3, Na2O and Na. The thermal decomposition of the
nitrates referred to on the syllabus continues to be an area that is neglected by candidates.
(ii) Most candidates had 2CuO and 4NO2 as correct answers but balanced the H2O with a 3 rather
than a 6.
(iii) There was confusion with colour change of anhydrous cobalt(II) chloride, blue to pink being
correct.
(iv) Those who mentioned that melting point or boiling point should be measured often did not state the
values or did not state that the data book value should be used or that melting point or boiling point
should be sharp. ‘It boils at 100°C’ is not the same as stating that the boiling point is 100°C.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 7
(a) It is essential to show full working out for all calculations. A common error was to divide all three
percentages by 13.33. Over approximation often lead to an incorrect final answer, sometimes
resulting in C5H13O2 in this case.
(b) This was answered very well and candidates successfully calculated the molecular formula.
2(C2H4O) was occasionally seen.
(c) (i) Candidates were able to name structural isomers from the definition. Isotope was a common
incorrect answer.
(ii) Candidates found this challenging. Some candidates drew the same compound twice to represent
both T and V.
Some candidates incorrectly thought that when asked to ‘show all of the atoms and all of the
bonds’, the O−H bond did not need to be included; this is not the case and the O−H should be
shown.
The rules that carbon atoms have four bonds, oxygen atoms two bonds and hydrogen atoms one
bond should always be applied.
(iii) Those that used correct formulae often had problems with balancing, largely concerning the
oxygen atoms. Some were unaware that fractions can be used in balancing equations. It was
perfectly acceptable to put a two in front of C3H6O2, which meant that fractions did not have to be
used.
(d) (i) Ester was an occasional answer from those candidates who may not have read the question
carefully enough. Ethanol was also seen occasionally.
(ii) The O−H bond was not always included. This was sometimes the only error in the answer.
(e)(i) The definition for hydrocarbon was well known and candidates clearly stated that it was a
substance formed from only carbon and hydrogen atoms.
(f) Equations that did not contain ethene were occasionally seen and octane did not always appear as
the reactant in cracking. Fermentation and hydrolysis were frequent incorrect names for the
conversion of ethene to ethanol.
The temperature of hydration was frequently incorrect. The reaction is generally conducted at
300°C but a range was accepted. Temperatures much higher than 350°C were often seen for
hydration. Catalysts of iron and nickel appeared occasionally for both processes.
Candidates were expected to give more specific reaction conditions rather than high temperature /
high pressure / catalyst.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/43
Theory (Extended)
Key messages
• Candidates need to take care when using technical terms, such as filtrate or residue and ensure they are
using them in the correct context.
• Electrolysis and the chemistry of esters proved to be weaker areas. These topic areas do contain some
demanding content and additional time should be spent covering these areas with students.
General comments
Working should be shown in calculations and this working should be set out so that it can be followed. This
will allow method marks to be awarded in calculations even if the final answer is incorrect.
When a question asks for a chemical equation a word equation will not be accepted. Where a word equation
is asked for, candidates should refrain from writing a chemical equation as these are more difficult and
increase the likelihood that an error will be made.
Question 1
(a) The majority of candidates could identify chlorine as the substance used to kill bacteria in drinking
water.
(b) Most candidates gave the correct answer of sulfur dioxide; a number suggested argon or
calcium hydroxide or chlorine could be used.
(c) Almost all candidates correctly identified copper as the electrical conductor used in cables.
(d) Most answers seen were correct; an appreciable number of candidates suggested substances that
were not gases.
(f) A very common answer was iron, showing some confusion between the contact process and the
Haber process.
Question 2
(a) (i) Despite the question asking for a description in terms of protons, neutrons and electrons, an
appreciable number of candidates ignored this and tried to answer the question in terms of only two
of the three particles. Candidates need to read questions with care – some candidates ignored the
instruction regarding the three subatomic particles and answered in terms of atomic number and
mass number.
(ii) Some candidates missed the fact that the species in the question was an aluminium ion rather than
an atom and so stated there were 13 electrons.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(b) (i) The name of the main ore of aluminium proved was not well known. A common error was to give
‘aluminium oxide’ or ‘alumina’ as the ore – these are not correct, they are both Al 2O3 and are
obtained from the ore.
(ii) An answer comparing the reactivity of aluminium with that of carbon was required. Vague answers
such as ‘aluminium is reactive’ were not sufficient to be awarded the mark.
(iii) Cryolite is used in the extraction of aluminium oxide since it is a solvent for aluminium oxide. The
solution has a far lower melting point than aluminium oxide alone and is a better conductor of
electricity. Many candidates claimed that the cryolite changed the boiling (rather than melting) point
or that it was the melting point of aluminium that was very high. It should be noted that cryolite is
not a catalyst.
(iv) Some candidates thought that because there was a ‘+ 4e– ’ that electrons had been gained and so
this was reduction. Of those who realised this was electron loss and so oxidation often then went
on to say that oxygen had been oxidised; this is incorrect, oxygen is formed in this reaction, the
species being oxidised is oxide ions.
(v) Better performing candidates gave clear explanations of how oxygen formed at the anode reacted
with the graphite from which the anode was made to form carbon dioxide. Common weaker
answers referred to the carbon coming from the electrolyte or the oxygen from the air.
(c) (i) The answer needed to include a comparison of the reactivity of zinc and copper. While ‘zinc is
more reactive than copper’ was an acceptable answer, ‘zinc is more reactive’ was not, since we are
not told what zinc is more reactive than; given the wording of the question ‘zinc is more reactive’
actually means zinc is more reactive than copper(II) sulfate.
(ii) Most candidates were able to identify this correctly as a redox or displacement reaction.
(iii) The existence of an inert coating of aluminium oxide on the surface of aluminium was not well
known. A common error was for candidates to claim that aluminium was unreactive.
Question 3
(a) Better performing candidates generally had no difficulty in selecting a property that was common to
all metals – such as the ability to conduct electricity.
(b) (i) Better performing candidates generally had no difficulty in selecting a property that was different for
the two metals. A common error was to identify a property common to all metals, which should
have been given as the answer to (a).
(c) Most candidates gave two correct observations. Some candidates repeated the observations given
in the question and so did not gain credit, or gave the same observation twice, such as ‘fizzes’ and
‘bubbles’ thinking they were two different observations. In this reaction, it is the hydrogen gas that
is made that catches fire, not the potassium.
(d) (i) The test for hydrogen should be known by almost all candidates and while most had some idea
about the test there was also some confusion – a burning and not a glowing splint is required in
order to ignite the hydrogen.
(ii) Some candidates did not read the question and stated that increasing the temperature would
increase the rate, which, while true, did not gain credit since that information was in the question.
The most common correct answer was to increase the concentration. A few candidates stated that
the pressure should be increased – this will not work as the substances involved were a solid and
an aqueous solution, neither of which are compressible.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
1. Increasing the temperature gives the particles more energy, this results in them moving faster.
2. As a result of moving faster the particles have more collisions per second. (Note: the reference
to time or frequency is essential).
3. As the particles have more energy, a bigger proportion of particles have energy greater than the
activation energy and so a greater percentage of collisions are successful.
(e) (i) Candidates were expected to realise that the equilibrium would move right and so become (more)
pink. However, many candidates did not refer to the equilibrium and just gave a colour. Some
candidates confused themselves and having worked out the equilibrium moved right and formed
more (Co(H2O)6)2+ they then thought that this would shift the equilibrium left to make the blue
species.
(f) Some excellent answers were seen, although some candidates incorrectly chose to give the
charge shown on a species other than Co, such as Co(OH)33+.
Question 4
(a) The characteristics of a homologous series were well known. Common errors were to mix up
chemical and physical properties (giving incorrect answers such as ‘a trend in chemical properties’)
and confusion between general and molecular formulae (giving answers such as ‘have the same
molecular formula’).
(b) Many fully correct answers were seen. The two most common errors were to omit the non-bonding
electrons on the oxygen or to omit the bonding pair between the two carbon atoms.
(c) (i) This was not well answered; equations often had incorrect formulae for ethanol and ethene or
additional incorrect products.
(ii) Very few candidates could recall the equation for fermentation, a number of candidates tried to
write an equation for aerobic respiration.
(iii) Both the greater speed and greater purity of the product were well known advantages. Some
candidates mixed up the advantages of each method and stated that catalytic hydration used
renewable materials.
(iv) The most common answer given was based on the renewable nature of the raw materials used.
Those who mixed the two methods up often incorrectly stated the product was purer.
(d) Very few candidates could identify the reagent used to oxidise ethanol.
(e) (i) Few fully correct structures were seen. Only a minority of candidates could draw an ester group.
Structures showing trivalent or pentavalent carbon atoms were common.
(ii) Better performing candidates could correctly name the ester formed.
(iii) The name of the homologous series was known by some but polyester was a common incorrect
answer.
(f) (i) This was not well answered. The difference between a strong and weak acid is not based on pH; a
very dilute strong acid can have a pH higher than a more concentrated weak acid. Candidates are
expected to refer to the fact that weak acids ionise only partially in aqueous solution.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(ii) Candidates are expected to be familiar with the preparation of soluble salts from acids. There are
three steps to the process:
1. Add excess copper carbonate to the acid. Most candidates did not state the copper carbonate
should be in excess.
2. Filter the solution to remove unreacted copper carbonate. The copper ethanoate solution is the
filtrate. There was some confusion between the terms ‘filtrate’ and ‘residue’.
3. The filtrate should be heated to the point of crystallisation and then allowed to cool so that
crystals form. It should not be evaporated to dryness.
(iii) Correct word equations were not common; often carbon dioxide or water were omitted as products.
Some candidates decided to attempt a chemical equation rather than a word equation. This made
the question much more difficult.
Question 5
(a) Many fully correct answers to the empirical formula calculation were seen. A common error was to
divide the percentages given in the question by the smallest percentage, so missing out the first
step of calculating a number of moles of each element. Some candidates mixed up Ni and N, and
so divided by the relative atomic mass of nitrogen. A significant number of candidates attempted to
guess a formula and made no attempt at showing any working; in these cases, the answer given
was invariably incorrect.
(b) (i) The movement of electrons in the wires was well known.
(ii) Both anions and cations transfer charge through the solution. It was a common error to specify just
one of these two as the answer.
(iii) Many candidates were able to correctly identify the electrolysis products. Some candidates thought
a solution was being electrolysed and so stated hydrogen would be made; this is despite the
nickel(II) iodide being identified as molten in both the diagram and the stem to (b). It was expected
that candidates would write the equation for the formation of nickel (since ionic half-equations for
the cathode reactions are on the syllabus) but many attempted the equation for anodic reaction and
were often successful.
(c) (i) While many candidates were able to correctly state that copper was deposited on the negative
electrodes, a number of candidates simply stated that copper ions go the negative electrode
without any mention of copper being formed and coating the electrode.
(ii) This was often correct with hydrogen as the most common incorrect gas formed.
(iii) The fact that copper atoms lose electrons and form copper ions which pass into the solution was
not well known. Some answers put the mass loss down to just the loss of electrons.
(iv) Some fully correct answers were seen with clear explanations of the colour changes seen in both
sets of apparatus. Other candidates clearly did not understand the difference in electrolysis
products when using an inert cathode compared to using a reactive cathode.
Question 6
(a) (i) This part involved two stages; the calculation of the relative formula mass of calcium hydroxide and
using this value to calculate the number of moles of calcium hydroxide. There were some common
errors in the calculation of the relative formula mass – having just one hydroxide ion being the most
common. Where candidates set their work out so that it could be followed, the error could be
carried forward and credit given for the correct use of the incorrect relative formula mass.
Consequential marks can only be awarded if candidates set out their working in a clear and logical
manner.
(ii) A common error was to use the value as 24 dm3 rather than 24 000 cm3. Candidates needed to
consider the units used for volume in the question.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(iii) Better performing candidates were able to use the 6:1 ratio in the equation to obtain a correct
value. A common error was to not use the limiting reagent identified from the values in (a)(i) and
(a)(ii).
(iv) This two-step calculation firstly required the relative formula mass to be determined and then using
that figure to work out the mass of the number of moles stated in (a)(iii). An error in the calculation
of the relative formula mass could be carried forward, but only if the working was presented in a
clear and logical manner by the candidate.
(b) (i) Most candidates were able to state that heating was required to bring about thermal
decomposition.
(ii) This question part was generally very well answered. Many candidates identified oxygen as the
colourless gas and were able to construct a fully correct equation.
(c) (i) The colour of methyl orange in an acid was well known.
(ii) There were many errors in the definition of an acid; many candidates incorrectly stated it was a
proton receiver.
(iii) Candidates found this part challenging and few were able to complete the equation to show the
transfer of a proton from HCl O3 (the acid) to H2O (the base).
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/51
Practical Test
Key messages
• In the planning question (Question 3) there is no need to write a list of apparatus at the start of the
answer, any apparatus used should be referred to in the description of the experiment so that it is clear
for what purpose that apparatus has been used.
• Plotted points on a grid should be clearly visible, e.g. crosses. Smooth line graphs should be curves with
no straight-line sections drawn with a ruler
• Observations are those which you can see. For example, ‘fizzing, bubbles or effervescence’ is an
observation; ‘a gas or carbon dioxide was given off’ is not an observation.
• Candidates should avoid giving lists of answers, as an incorrect response can contradict a correct one.
For example, if the correct answer is ‘precipitate dissolves’ and a candidate writes ‘precipitate dissolves
and a white solid forms’, no mark can be awarded.
General comments
The vast majority of candidates successfully attempted all of the questions. Almost all centres were able to
gain the expected results in Question 1, with Experiment 5 showing a large increase in time compared to
Experiments 1–4.
Question 1
(a) The table of results was often completed correctly. A common error was completing the time for
Experiment 5, leaving the time in minutes and seconds.
(b) Most candidates plotted the points correctly but often not clearly. Poorly drawn line graphs were
evident, without a smooth curve. The section between 10 cm3 and 30 cm3 proved challenging with
some candidates drawing a straight line with a ruler. Others drew a best-fit straight line through all
of the points.
(c) The formation of a yellow precipitate was the expected description of the appearance of the mixture
in the flask. Vague references to milky and white were ignored.
(d) (i) Candidates should be encouraged to show clear construction lines and ensure that these lines are
parallel to the axes. A significant number of candidates did not show clearly on the grid how they
worked out their answer.
(ii) The question asked for a calculation and marks were lost for leaving the answer as a fraction.
Incorrectly rounded numbers could not be awarded credit.
(e) (i) A few candidates confused rate and time and so incorrectly stated Experiment 5, as it had the
longest time.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(ii) Good responses referred to the presence of more particles and hence more frequent collisions
between the particles. A lack of understanding was seen with many candidates suggesting that at
higher concentration the particles had more energy or that more collisions released more energy.
(f) Many candidates gave a burette or pipette. Some candidates did not read the question and stated
that a measuring cylinder is more accurate than a measuring cylinder.
(g) The difference to the results caused by using a smaller conical flask was only realised by better
performing candidates. Many candidates thought the concentration or pressure of the reactants
would increase and the rate of reaction would increase. Candidates who have done this sort of
experiment should be familiar with how changing the reaction vessel will change the results
obtained. In this case, a greater depth of reacting mixture would lead to the cross disappearing
from view in shorter times.
(h) A common mistake was to join their sketch line to their plotted line so having decided the reaction
would be slower they then showed the reaction slower most of the time but having the same rate at
the highest or lowest concentration. A significant number of candidates did not follow the instruction
to draw their sketch on the grid and filled the space at (h) with a sketch of a graph which was not
comparable with the original on the previous page.
Question 2
(b) This was generally well answered with candidates observing bubbles or effervescence.
(c) Only a minority recorded that a blue solution was formed, The formation of a black
colouration/precipitate showed a lack of understanding, having just added copper(II) oxide to the
solution. The mention of green solutions and blue precipitates being formed scored no credit.
(d) Marks were awarded for noticing that the solid turned yellow on heating. A significant number of
candidates did not describe that the solid returned to a white colour after standing for a minute.
Credit was given for recording the formation of water droplets/condensation.
(e) Candidates were required to realise that the gas produced was carbon dioxide and then give the
test for carbon dioxide. Blue litmus is not an appropriate test since candidates should know that
there are other acidic gases. Similarly, the use of a lighted splint is not appropriate. The fact that
the splint goes out tells us that the gas does not support combustion and is not flammable – the
same result is obtained with nitrogen and ammonia.
(f) (i) The expected observation was that a white precipitate formed.
(g) (i) The expected observation was that a white precipitate formed.
(h) The majority of candidates tested the gas with litmus paper, which turned blue. Many did not record
the bubbles in the mixture. Credit was awarded for reference to a pungent smell but identifying
ammonia was ignored as the name of a gas is not an observation.
(i) Only the better performing candidates realised that a positive nitrate test showed the solution was
nitric acid. Some candidates realised that A was an acid.
(j) Candidates found identifying solid B challenging. Calcium and ammonium compounds were
frequently named. Despite the correct observations to the tests some candidates did not use the
notes given on pages 11 and 12 to help identify the solid B.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 3
There were a number of acceptable methods for determining the solubility of a salt in water. Many
candidates scored credit for specifying a measured volume of water and heating it to 40°C. The commonest
method was to add potassium chloride to the water until no more dissolved, filtering off the excess salt,
drying the solid and weighing the residue. This mass was then subtracted from the initial mass taken. Many
candidates using this method did not mention ‘add the potassium chloride to the water until no more
dissolves/until in excess’ and could not be awarded that mark.
Variants involved heating the filtrate to dryness or weighing the beaker of water initially and then reweighing
when the solution was saturated.
Credit was given for naming the apparatus used to measure the volume of water and indicating that the
mixture of the potassium chloride and water should be stirred to facilitate the dissolving.
A common error was to produce a plan based on the time it took the salt to dissolve or the speed of the
process rather than the mass that would dissolve. Candidates should read the question carefully as this
clearly related the solubility of the salt to the mass of the salt.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/52
Practical Test
Key messages
● If, when two solutions are added to together, the product is cloudy this will be because a precipitate has
formed. The solid formed should be called a precipitate.
● When reporting the result of a qualitative test, if there has been no change then candidates should say
this, or state that the solution remains colourless; saying the solution becomes colourless is saying that
a change took place and so is incorrect.
● In the planning question (Question 3) there is no need to write a list of apparatus at the start of the
answer, any apparatus used should be referred to in the description of the experiment so that it is clear
for what purpose that apparatus has been used.
General comments
Almost all Centres were able to gain the expected results in Question 1, with Experiment 1 showing a
decrease in temperature and Experiment 2 an increase.
If glassware is washed in a dishwasher then it would be wise to rinse items such as test-tubes (which do not
always get rinsed very well in a dishwasher) with water; the substance used as a cleaner in dishwashers is
often strongly alkaline and can leave a residue in test-tubes.
Candidates should complete graph work in pencil so that errors can be erased.
Solutions should be made up using distilled or deionised water to avoid false positive tests for ions such as
chloride.
Question 1
(a) The vast majority of candidates obtained three sets of results with an increasing magnitude of
temperature change as the mass of solid C increased. Almost all candidates correctly included the
sign of the temperature change in their table. Most candidates gained results that were comparable
to the Supervisor’s result.
(b) The vast majority of candidates gained the expected results. A small percentage of candidates did
not record all temperatures and temperature changes to the same degree of accuracy, i.e. a
consistent number of decimal places, and so did not gain full credit.
(c) Few errors in plotting were noted, although the most common error was to plot the points for 6 g of
solid C or solid D at 5 g on the x-axis. A minority of candidates did not read the instruction regarding
drawing two straight lines but a much larger number did not have their lines meeting at (0,0). If no
solid has been added, then there cannot be a temperature change and so both lines had to pass
through the pre-plotted point at (0,0). Some candidates plotted points or drew graph lines in ink –
this means that if an error is made the point/line that is wrong cannot be erased.
(d) Most candidates successfully extrapolated their graph line to 8 g, but there were then some errors
in reading from the scale.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(e) A number of candidates suggested the reaction was endothermic. It is suspected that some of
these candidates had not read the question carefully and so had not noticed this question part was
about solid D while the previous question part had been about solid C.
(f) Most candidates realised the reaction would be over after two hours, but not all of these suggested
the solution would return to room temperature. Incorrect answers included that the solution would
remain at its highest temperature indefinitely or that the temperature would continue to increase at
the same rate – so giving temperature changes 120 times the ones reported in the experiments.
(g) The majority of candidates realised that if the quantity of water was increased, the temperature
change would be smaller; many did not give the expected quantitative answer – namely that with
twice the volume of water the temperature changes would be halved. A few candidates considered
water as the limiting reactant and so incorrectly stated the temperature change would double.
(h) This question asked for a change to the experiment. Repeating the experiment is not a change to
the experiment, it is simply doing the same experiment again. Of those who did suggest a suitable
change the split between adding extra insulation or a lid as opposed to changing the way in which
the water is measured was approximately equal. Some candidates forgot about the practical they
had just completed and suggested using a polystyrene cup – despite the fact they had just used
one.
(i) The reliability of an experiment can be checked by repeating it and comparing results.
Unfortunately, some candidates suggested repeating it with different volumes of water; this would
produce different results and would not allow you to check comparability.
Question 2
(a) Solid E was hydrated iron(II) sulfate. This is a pale green solid. Old samples may have had some
brown tint to the solid due to oxidation to iron(III). However, a number of candidates reported that
the solid was blue-green.
(b) Most candidates correctly noted the colour change to yellow or brown, but relatively few noticed the
steam being given off or the condensation forming at the top of the test-tube.
(c) As iron(II) sulfate does not contain a halide ion, there should not have been a precipitate formed. A
precipitate is only obtained with sulfates if the concentrations used are much too high. A wide
variety of observations were reported, ranging from ‘no change’ to ‘black precipitate’.
(d) Most candidates correctly reported the formation of a white precipitate. It should be noted that the
term precipitate is required.
(e) Iron(II) salt solutions normally give a deep green precipitate under laboratory conditions, these will
then slowly become brown as the iron(II) is oxidised to iron(III). Despite this, some candidates
reported a blue precipitate (signifying copper(II) ions) or a grey-green precipitate (the colour
obtained for chromium(III) with aqueous ammonia but not sodium hydroxide), some candidates
reported that the precipitate re-dissolved – this does not happen with iron(II) ions.
(f) Solid E was often identified correctly, although it was a common error to omit the oxidation state of
iron despite the fact that the Notes for use in qualitative analysis makes it clear that the test results
for iron(II) and iron(III) are not the same. Candidates are advised to write the name rather than the
formula when giving identities of compounds.
(g) Solid F was calcium chloride. Solutions of calcium chloride should show a weakly acidic pH
(around pH 6). However, a wide range of pH values were reported, ranging from strongly acidic to
strongly alkaline. One possible explanation is that the glassware/stopper used was not clean.
Glassware should be rinsed before use.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(h) (i) Most candidates correctly reported the formation of a white precipitate. However, some candidates
also reported additional impossible observations such as ‘fizzing’. It should be noted that a solution
cannot be ‘white’; solutions are clear. If a solution looks white in these qualitative ion tests, it will be
due to the formation of a white precipitate.
(ii) Most candidates correctly reported that the precipitate did not dissolve.
(i) Most candidates report that no change occurred. However, some candidates stated that the
solution became colourless – suggesting that it was not colourless before, which is incorrect.
Question 3
Candidates who opted to carry out a titration generally performed well on this question. The most common
errors encountered in this method were:
1. Using Universal Indicator, which is not suitable for using in a titration as it shows a series of gradual
colour changes rather than having a sharp end point.
2. Not adding the reagent in the burette slowly or dropwise to the other reagent. Rapid addition will lead to
the end point being overshot.
Candidates would be well advised to plan their answers out before starting to write, this would avoid the
need to try and insert missing parts at a later stage. There is no need to write a list of apparatus at the start,
if a mark is available for selecting suitable apparatus then it must be clear what that apparatus is being used
for and so it must be mentioned in the method.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/53
Practical Test
Key messages
● If, when two solutions are added together, the product is cloudy this will be because a solid has formed.
The solid formed should be called a precipitate.
● In the planning question (Question 3) there is no need to write a list of apparatus at the start of the
answer. Any apparatus used should be referred to in the description of the experiment so that it is clear
for what purpose that apparatus has been used.
● Candidates should be familiar with the technique of a flame test. A flame test involves placing a small
amount of an ionic solid (normally on a wire) into a roaring Bunsen flame. The colour of the Bunsen
flame then changes. Flame tests do not involve using a lighted splint and the result cannot be ‘squeaky
pop’ or ‘flame goes out’.
General comments
Almost all centres were able to gain the expected results in Question 1, with Experiment 1 and Experiment 2
showing an increase in temperature followed by a decrease.
Candidates should complete graph work in pencil so that errors can be erased.
Question 1
(a) Almost all candidates were able to obtain the expected results showing an increase in temperature
followed by a decrease.
(b) A number of errors in plotting were noted. Most candidates followed the instruction to draw two
intersecting straight lines. Some candidates did ‘dot to dot’ lines or curves. Some candidates are
plotted points or drew graph lines in ink – this means that if an error is made the point/line that is
wrong cannot be erased.
(c) Almost all candidates were able to obtain the expected results showing an increase in temperature
followed by a decrease.
(d) A number of errors in plotting were found and some candidates ignored the instruction to draw two
intersecting straight lines.
(e) (i) A number of candidates misread their graph scales despite having just successfully plotted the
graph. A small number of answers stated the temperature rather than the volume.
(ii) Most candidates worked out that a smaller volume would be required; they did not go on to give a
quantitative answer and reason.
(f) Candidates need to ensure that when writing exothermic that the ‘x’ does not look like an ‘n’ as the
intended answer must be unambiguous.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(g) (i) Almost all candidates realised that the burette needed to be cleaned, with most candidates
focussing on the acid left from the previous experiment.
(ii) Many candidates focused on removing the acid from the previous experiment despite having
already removed it with water. Only the better performing candidates realised the water would
dilute the acid used in the second experiment and so had to be removed.
(h) Many candidates did not realise that a source of error is not removed by repeating an experiment –
if the same method and apparatus is used then that source of error in still there. Better responses
identified heat loss or using a measuring cylinder as a source of error.
Question 2
(a) (i) A number of candidates confused flame test with testing a gas with a lighted splint. The result of a
flame test should be a colour, not ‘the flame went out’.
(b) By this stage candidates could have identified solution T as aqueous sodium hydroxide. The results
given by some candidates suggested that having worked out this was the reaction between an
aqueous zinc salt and aqueous sodium hydroxide all that they needed to do was give observations
similar to those in the Notes for use in qualitative analysis. However, in this instance the tests were
reversed, with the zinc salt being added to the sodium hydroxide. Almost all candidates missed the
initial formation of a white precipitate, which then quickly dissolves before any more of the zinc salt
is added.
(c) The gas given off should have been ammonia. Some candidates reported positive tests for
chlorine, presumably thinking that because ammonium chloride was used that chlorine would be
made, it is not possible for chlorine to be made in this way. The expected test and result was that
for ammonia.
(d) Many candidates missed the initial green precipitate, which rapidly dissolves giving a green
solution. The final green precipitate that should have been formed when excess was added was
often reported as being a green solution.
(f) Most candidates stated that liquid U was colourless. It should be noted that ‘clear’ is not accepted
as an alternative to colourless; coloured solutions, such as aqueous copper(II) sulfate, are
coloured and clear.
(h) Most candidates reported that liquid U caught fire, some incorrectly stated that it extinguished the
lighted splint.
(i) A common error was to state that liquid U contained iodide ions; this was presumably because of
the yellow precipitate seen in Question 2(g), despite the fact that silver nitrate had not been used.
Question 3
This question required candidates to extract the mixture of pigments from the leaves and then to analyse the
pigments. Unfortunately, most answers seen concentrated on either extracting the pigment from the leaves
or on conducting chromatography rather than addressing both aspects; relatively few answers described how
to obtain the pigment from the leaves and then conduct chromatography. It was not uncommon for
candidates who missed out the pigment extraction stage to place the leaf directly on chromatography paper.
Some candidates were not sure what to do with the sand and so used it as a filtration medium or even the
stationary phase in chromatography.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/61
Alternative to Practical
Key messages
• Plotted points on a grid should be clearly visible, e.g. crosses. Smooth line graphs should be curves with
no straight-line sections drawn with a ruler.
• Observations are those which you can see. For example, ‘fizzing, bubbles or effervescence’ is an
observation; ‘a gas or carbon dioxide was given off’ is not.
• Candidates should avoid giving lists of answers, as an incorrect response can contradict a correct one.
For example, if the correct answer is ‘precipitate dissolves’ and a candidate writes ‘precipitate dissolves
and a white solid forms’, no mark can be awarded.
• In the planning question, Question 4, there is no need to write a list of apparatus at the start of the
answer, any apparatus used should be referred to in the description of the experiment so that it is clear
for what purpose that apparatus has been used.
General comments
The vast majority of candidates successfully attempted all of the questions. Candidates found the last
question, Question 4, challenging.
The majority of candidates were able to complete tables of results from readings on diagrams, as in
Question 2.
Question 1
(a) Some candidates had difficulty identifying the burette. Pipette, funnel and measuring tube were
common incorrect answers.
(b) Methyl orange, phenolphthalein and litmus gained credit. Universal Indicator is not suitable for use
in titrations.
(c) (i) This was generally well-answered with most candidates identifying the anomalous point.
(ii) Many answers were vague referring to human error, misreading the burette or parallax errors.
Credit was awarded for difficulties in judging the end point and consequent overshooting. Using too
much sodium hydroxide was a high-level response.
(iii) Some candidates were able to calculate the average volume of nitric acid and give their answer to
an appropriate number of decimal places.
(d) Marks were awarded for realising that less acid was used and therefore the acid was more
concentrated. Confused answers were common. Descriptions of a displacement reaction showed a
lack of knowledge and understanding. Some candidates stated that the nitric acid must be less
concentrated as it was called ‘dilute nitric acid’.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 2
(a) The table of results was often completed correctly. A common error was completing the volume for
Experiment 1, suggesting candidates may not have read through the experiment details carefully.
Errors were also seen recording the times for Experiments 4 and 5 leaving the time in minutes and
seconds or just recording the seconds and ignoring the minutes.
(b) Most candidates plotted the points correctly but often not clearly. Poorly drawn line graphs were
evident, without a smooth curve. The section between 10 cm3 and 30 cm3 proved challenging, with
some candidates drawing a straight line with a ruler. Others drew a curve with a point of inflection
and so had the curve becoming less steep to the left rather than steeper.
(c) (i) Candidates should be encouraged to show clear construction lines on the graph and ensure that
these lines are parallel to the axes. A significant number of candidates did not show clearly on the
grid how they worked out their answer.
(ii) The question asked for a calculation and marks were lost for leaving the answer as a fraction.
Incorrectly rounded numbers could not be awarded credit.
(d) (i) A few candidates confused rate and time and so incorrectly stated Experiment 5 as it had the
longest time.
(ii) Good responses referred to the presence of more particles and hence more frequent collisions
between the particles. A lack of understanding was seen with many candidates suggesting that at
higher concentration the particles had more energy or that more collisions released more energy.
(e) Many candidates gave a burette or pipette. Some candidates did not read the question and stated
that a measuring cylinder is more accurate than a measuring cylinder.
(f) The difference to the results caused by using a smaller conical flask was only realised by better
performing candidates. Many candidates thought the concentration or pressure of the reactants
would increase and the rate of reaction would increase. Candidates who have done this sort of
experiment should be familiar with how changing the reaction vessel will change the results
obtained. In this case a greater depth of reacting mixture would lead to the cross disappearing from
view in shorter times.
(g) A common mistake was to join their sketch line to their plotted line so having decided the reaction
would be slower they then showed the reaction slower most of the time but having the same rate at
the highest or lowest concentration.
Question 3
(a) The majority correctly identified hydrogen as the gas given off in test 2. Responses indicated that
some candidates found this challenging.
(b) Solution A was often identified as an acid but many did not use the result of test 3 to identify
sulfate ions.
(c) Candidates were required to realise that the gas produced was carbon dioxide and then give the
test for carbon dioxide. Blue litmus is not an appropriate test since candidates should know that
there are other acidic gases. Similarly the use of a lighted splint is not appropriate. The fact that the
splint goes out tells us that the gas does not support combustion and is not flammable – the same
result is obtained with nitrogen and ammonia.
(d) (i) The expected observation was white precipitate formed. Many responses mixed up this test with
the nitrate ion test and produced ammonia despite no aluminium being added and the mixture not
being heated.
(e) (i) The expected observation was that a white precipitate formed.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
Question 4
There were a number of acceptable methods of determining the solubility of a salt in water. Many candidates
scored credit for specifying a measured volume of water and heating it to 40°C. The commonest method was
to add potassium chloride to the water until no more dissolved, filtering off the excess salt, drying the solid
and weighing the residue. This mass was then subtracted from the initial mass taken.
Variants involved heating the filtrate to dryness or weighing the beaker of water initially and then reweighing
when the solution was saturated.
Credit was given for naming the apparatus used to measure the volume of water and indicating that the
mixture of the potassium chloride and water should be stirred to facilitate the dissolving.
A common error was to produce a plan based on the time it took the salt to dissolve or the speed of the
process rather than the mass that would dissolve. Candidates should read the question carefully as this
clearly related the solubility of the salt to the mass of the salt.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/62
Alternative to Practical
Key messages
• Observations are those which you can see. For example, ‘fizzing’ is an observation, whereas ‘a gas was
given off’ is not. Smells, such as the pungent smell of ammonia, or the bleach or swimming pool smell of
chlorine, are acceptable as observations.
• When a question asks for the name of a chemical, a correct formula is acceptable. However, if a
candidate answers with an incorrect formula, then the mark cannot be awarded.
General comments
This session, Question 4 was a planning task based on the determination of the concentration of an alkaline
solution. The most common method was by titration, although other methods could gain credit
The vast majority of candidates were able to complete tables of results from readings on diagrams in
Question 2.
Question 1
(b) The label on the y-axis proved challenging. Candidates had to say ‘volume’ or give the units as
cm3, whilst referring to the gas or carbon dioxide.
Most realised that the graph was horizontal because the reaction had finished, but fewer mentioned
that calcium carbonate was the limiting factor.
(c) The graph for lumps of calcium carbonate was well drawn by the majority of candidates. However,
a significant number of candidates left this question blank.
Question 2
(a) Most candidates could read the thermometers correctly, although a minority omitted the minus
sign.
(c) The points were usually plotted correctly and the lines were generally well drawn; many did not go
through the origin. Many candidates did not label the lines.
(d) Most candidates successfully extrapolated their graph line to 8 g; some errors in reading from the
scale were seen.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(e) A number of candidates suggested the reaction was endothermic. It is suspected that some of
these candidates had not read the question carefully and so had not noticed this question part was
about solid D while the previous question part had been about solid C.
(f) Most candidates realised the reaction would be over after two hours, but not all of these suggested
the solution would return to room temperature. Incorrect answers included that the solution would
remain at its highest temperature indefinitely or that the temperature would continue to increase at
the same rate – so giving temperature changes 120 times the ones reported in the experiments.
(g) The majority of candidates realised that if the quantity of water was increased, the temperature
changed would be smaller; many did not give the expected quantitative answer – namely, that with
twice the volume of water the temperature changes would be halved. A few candidates considered
water as the limiting reactant and so incorrectly stated that the temperature change would double.
(h) This question asked for a change to the experiment. Repeating the experiment is not a change to
the experiment, it is simply doing the same experiment again. Of those who did suggest a suitable
change the split between adding extra insulation or a lid as opposed to changing the way in which
the water is measured was approximately equal.
(i) The reliability of an experiment can be checked by repeating it and comparing results.
Unfortunately, some candidates suggested repeating it with different volumes of water; this would
produce different results and would not allow you to check comparability.
Question 3
(a) Some candidates realised that iron(II) sulfate is green. Despite the fact that the question referred to
the solid, a significant minority incorrectly called it a solution.
(b) The qualitative analysis tests were generally well known. Most candidates realised that there would
be no change or no precipitate with silver nitrate solution.
(f) Most candidates correctly identified calcium as the cation; a few could not be awarded the mark as
they wrote Ca+.
Question 4
Candidates who opted to carry out a titration normally scored highly on this question. The most common
errors encountered in this method were:
1 Using Universal Indicator, which is not suitable for using in a titration as it shows a series of gradual
colour changes rather than having a sharp end point.
2 Not adding the reagent in the burette slowly or dropwise to the other reagent. Rapid addition will lead to
the end point being overshot.
Candidates would be well advised to plan their answers out before starting to write, this would avoid the
need to try and insert missing parts at a later stage. There is no need to write a list of apparatus at the start,
if a mark is available for selecting suitable apparatus then it must be clear what that apparatus is being used
for and so it must be mentioned in the method.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
CHEMISTRY
Paper 0620/63
Alternative to Practical
Key messages
• If, when two solutions are added together, the product is a solid, the solid formed should be called a
precipitate.
• In the planning question, Question 4, there is no need to write a list of apparatus at the start of the
answer. Any apparatus used should be referred to in the description of the experiment so that it is clear
for what purpose that apparatus has been used.
• Plotted points on a grid should be clearly visible, e.g. crosses. Straight line graphs should be drawn with
a ruler.
General comments
The majority of candidates were able to complete the tables of results from readings on diagrams and plot
points successfully on a grid as in Question 2.
Question 1
(ii) Only a minority of candidates identified the crucible. This suggests that most candidates have not
heated solids strongly over a Bunsen burner. Beaker and flask were common responses.
(b) Many candidates did not know what the ‘air hole’ was. Contradictory answers such as closed and
blue flame were common. This suggests that many candidates had not used a Bunsen burner on a
regular basis.
(c) Very few candidates understood the idea of heating the solid to constant mass. Common incorrect
answers heated the crystals and looked for steam or tested with anhydrous copper sulfate.
(d) Lots of physical tests were seen. Candidates who understood what a chemical test was scored
credit; some got the colour changes reversed or mixed up copper sulfate and cobalt chloride.
Question 2
(a) Almost all candidates were able to complete the temperatures from the thermometer diagrams.
(b) A number of errors in plotting were noted. Most candidates followed the instruction to draw two
intersecting straight lines. The vast majority used a ruler to draw the straight lines.
(c) Almost all candidates were able to complete the temperatures from the thermometer diagrams.
© 2018
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
0620 Chemistry June 2018
Principal Examiner Report for Teachers
(d) A number of errors in plotting were found and some candidates ignored the instruction to draw two
intersecting straight lines. Some drew a straight line from point 1 to point 4 instead of point 3, so
the lines crossed at 15 cm3.
(e) (i) A number of candidates misread their graph scales despite having just successfully plotted the
graph. A small number of answers stated the temperature rather than the volume. Many did not
show any working on the grid.
(ii) Most candidates worked out that a smaller volume would be required; others did not give a
quantitative answer and explanation.
(f) Candidates need to ensure that when writing exothermic that the ‘x’ does not look like an ‘n’ as the
intended answer must be unambiguous.
(g) (i) Almost all candidates realised that the burette needed to be cleaned, with most candidates
focussing on the acid left from the previous experiment.
(ii) Many candidates still focussed on removing the acid from the previous experiment despite having
already removed it with water. Only the better performing candidates realised the water would
dilute the acid used in the second experiment and so had to be removed.
(h) Many candidates did not realise that a source of error is not removed by repeating an experiment –
if the same method and apparatus is used then that source of error is still there. Better responses
identified heat loss or using a measuring cylinder as a source of error.
Question 3
(a) (i) There was a number of candidates that confused a flame test with testing a gas with a lighted
splint. The result of a flame test should be a colour, not ‘the flame went out’. Many candidates
showed confusion and gave answers based on bubbling, precipitates or squeaky pops.
(ii) Many candidates thought that sodium hydroxide was either an acid or a weak alkali. A minority
realised that it was strongly alkaline and so gave a pH from 11–14.
(b) Most candidates gave the observations you would expect for adding sodium hydroxide to an
aqueous solution of a zinc salt, hence thinking that the sodium hydroxide was in excess in the
second step rather than the first. Therefore, the correct response was a white precipitate that is
soluble and then reappears.
(c) The expected test and result was that for ammonia and was that red litmus turns blue. Blue litmus
is not a suitable test for ammonia. Some performed tests with lighted splints or thought that
chlorine would be produced and would bleach litmus.
(d) Many candidates missed the final green precipitate that should have been formed when excess
chromium(III) chloride solution was added. This was often reported as being soluble, forming a
green solution.
(e) Many candidates could correctly conclude that solution T was a fuel, an alcohol or an organic
substance. A common answer was to say it was a copper compound due to the blue flame in the
second test, not understanding that touching something with a lighted splint is not a flame test.
Question 4
This investigation has two stages; extraction of the pigment and then separation by chromatography.
The question required candidates to describe the extraction of the pigments from the leaves and then to
analyse the pigments. Unfortunately, most answers concentrated on either extracting the pigment or on
conducting chromatography rather than addressing both aspects.
Relatively few answers described how to obtain the pigment from the leaves and then conduct
chromatography. Good answers gave descriptions of the formation of coloured spots up the paper and the
calculation of Rf values. It was not uncommon for candidates who missed out the pigment extraction stage to
place the leaf directly on chromatography paper.
© 2018
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2018
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*9277446556*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the Question Paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The Supervisor’s Report to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and enclose
it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of the
Supervisor’s Results and of the Supervisor’s Report are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Suitable eye protection should be provided.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Confidential Instructions, please contact Cambridge stating the Centre
number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
email info@cie.org.uk
phone +44 1223 553554
fax +44 1223 553558
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_51CI/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
Question 1
Each candidate will require the following chemicals and apparatus. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
(b) 100 cm3 of hydrochloric acid of concentration 2.0 mol / dm3 labelled dilute hydrochloric acid
The bucket must contain 1 dm3 of approximately 5% sodium carbonate solution (made up by dissolving
50 g of Na2CO3 [MH] or 135 g of Na2CO3.10H2O [MH] in 1 dm3 of water) and Universal Indicator.
The Supervisor must monitor the colour of the Universal Indicator in each quenching bath to check that
the solution has not become acidic. If the solution becomes acidic, the Supervisor must add more 5%
sodium carbonate solution to the quenching bath.
Question 2
Each candidate will require the following chemicals and apparatus. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
[C] (a) 12 cm3 of dilute nitric acid of concentration 1 mol / dm3 in a stoppered test-tube labelled
solution A
(b) 0.3 g of basic zinc carbonate or zinc carbonate, ZnCO3, in a stoppered test-tube labelled
solid B
[MH] (h) limewater and apparatus used to test for carbon dioxide
(l) splints
(t) spatula
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
Supervisor’s Report
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record the
results on a spare copy of the Question Paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’. Failure to
enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably penalised.
2 he Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
T
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination
ther cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported directly to
O
Cambridge on the Special Consideration form.
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
Signed ...................................................
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/52
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2018
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*1996980903*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the Question Paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The Supervisor’s Report to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and enclose
it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of the
Supervisor’s Results and of the Supervisor’s Report are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Suitable eye protection should be provided.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Confidential Instructions, please contact Cambridge stating the Centre
number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
email info@cie.org.uk
phone +44 1223 553554
fax +44 1223 553558
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_52CI/2RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
Question 1
(i) spatula
Note
Confirmatory tests to be performed before the examination.
● 4 g of hydrated sodium carbonate added to 40 cm3 of distilled water should give a temperature
decrease of about 4 °C.
● 4 g of anhydrous sodium carbonate added to 40 cm3 of distilled water should give a temperature
increase of about 5 °C.
If you do not observe these temperature changes, then you must replace your stocks of hydrated
sodium carbonate and anhydrous sodium carbonate accordingly.
Question 2
Each candidate will require the following chemicals and apparatus. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
[MH] (a) 0.5 g of hydrated iron(II) sulfate, FeSO4.7H2O, in a stoppered test-tube labelled solid E
[MH][N] (d) aqueous silver nitrate of sufficient concentration to give a positive halide test
(r) spatula
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
Supervisor’s Report
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record the
results on a spare copy of the Question Paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’. Failure to
enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably penalised.
2 he Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
T
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination
ther cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported directly to
O
Cambridge on the Special Consideration form.
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
Signed ...................................................
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/53
CONFIDENTIAL INSTRUCTIONS
Great care should be taken to ensure that any confidential information given does not reach the
*5488919999*
The teacher responsible for preparing the examination is not allowed to consult the Question Paper before the
examination. Teachers should, as part of the preparation of the examination requirements, carry out any tests
indicated on pages 2 and 3 in order to satisfy themselves that the supplied materials are satisfactory.
The Supervisor’s Report to be included with the scripts is given on pages 7 and 8. Please detach and enclose
it with the scripts. If scripts are despatched in more than one envelope, it is essential that a copy of the
Supervisor’s Results and of the Supervisor’s Report are sent inside each envelope.
More material may be issued if required, without penalty, but this should not be necessary.
Supervisors are advised to remind candidates that all substances in the examination should be treated with
caution. Suitable eye protection should be provided.
In accordance with COSHH (Control of Substances Hazardous to Health) Regulations, operative in the UK, a
hazard appraisal of the examination has been carried out.
Attention is drawn, in particular, to certain materials used in the examination. The following codes are used
where relevant.
If you have any queries regarding these Confidential Instructions, please contact Cambridge stating the Centre
number, the nature of the query and the syllabus number quoted above.
email info@cie.org.uk
phone +44 1223 553554
fax +44 1223 553558
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_53CI/2RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
Question 1
Each candidate will require the following chemicals and apparatus. Labels must not include
concentrations.
[C] (c) 100 cm3 of dilute sulfuric acid of concentration 2.0 mol / dm3 labelled acid S
Question 2
Each candidate will require the following chemicals and apparatus. Labels do not need to include
concentrations.
[C] (a) 8 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide of concentration 1 mol / dm3 in a stoppered test‑tube
labelled solution T
(m) splints
(u) spatula
This form must be completed and returned in the envelope with the scripts.
Supervisor’s Report
The Supervisor is asked to carry out the experiments in Questions 1 and 2 and to record the
results on a spare copy of the Question Paper clearly labelled ‘Supervisor’s Results’. Failure to
enclose these results and this report form may lead to candidates being unavoidably penalised.
2 he Supervisor is invited to report details of any difficulties experienced by candidates giving names
T
and candidate numbers. The report should include reference to:
(a) any general difficulties encountered in making preparations for the examination
ther cases of individual hardship, e.g. illness, temporary disability, should be reported directly to
O
Cambridge on the Special Consideration form.
The preparation of this practical examination has been carried out so as to maintain fully the security
of the examination.
Signed ...................................................
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
The maximum total mark for this syllabus, after weighting has been applied, is 200.
The overall thresholds for the different grades were set as follows.
Combination of
Option A* A B C D E F G
Components
BX 21, 41, 51 142 119 96 74 65 56 46 36
BY 22, 42, 52 160 133 106 79 68 57 46 35
BZ 23, 43, 53 156 129 102 76 65 55 45 35
CX 21, 41, 61 148 123 98 74 65 56 46 36
Learn more! For more information please visit www.cambridgeinternational.org/igcse or contact Customer Services
on +44 (0)1223 553554 or email info@cambridgeinternational.org
Grade thresholds continued
Cambridge IGCSE Chemistry (0620)
Combination of
Option A* A B C D E F G
Components
CY 22, 42, 62 163 135 107 79 68 57 45 33
CZ 23, 43, 63 157 130 103 76 65 55 45 35
FX 11, 31, 51 – – – 115 97 80 62 44
FY 12, 32, 52 – – – 104 88 72 57 42
FZ 13, 33, 53 – – – 113 95 78 60 42
GX 11, 31, 61 – – – 115 97 80 62 44
GY 12, 32, 62 – – – 104 88 72 56 40
GZ 13, 33, 63 – – – 113 95 78 60 42
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2018
INSERT
1 hour 15 minutes
*8393780945-I*
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS
CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE
INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL EXAMINATIONS CAMBRIDGE INTERNATIONAL
IB18 06_0620_51/RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
BLANK PAGE
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 B 1
2 A 1
3 B 1
4 D 1
5 B 1
6 A 1
7 C 1
8 C 1
9 C 1
10 B 1
11 B 1
12 D 1
13 B 1
14 A 1
15 B 1
16 C 1
17 C 1
18 A 1
19 C 1
20 B 1
21 A 1
22 A 1
23 C 1
24 D 1
25 B 1
26 B 1
27 B 1
28 C 1
29 C 1
30 C 1
31 D 1
32 C 1
33 D 1
34 A 1
35 A 1
36 B 1
37 C 1
38 C 1
39 A 1
40 D 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/12
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 D 1
2 D 1
3 B 1
4 D 1
5 A 1
6 B 1
7 C 1
8 C 1
9 D 1
10 D 1
11 A 1
12 D 1
13 D 1
14 A 1
15 B 1
16 C 1
17 C 1
18 B 1
19 B 1
20 C 1
21 C 1
22 D 1
23 A 1
24 C 1
25 B 1
26 B 1
27 B 1
28 C 1
29 C 1
30 A 1
31 B 1
32 C 1
33 A 1
34 A 1
35 A 1
36 B 1
37 A 1
38 C 1
39 B 1
40 C 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/13
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 B 1
2 A 1
3 D 1
4 B 1
5 B 1
6 A 1
7 C 1
8 C 1
9 B 1
10 B 1
11 C 1
12 D 1
13 B 1
14 A 1
15 B 1
16 C 1
17 C 1
18 C 1
19 B 1
20 A 1
21 D 1
22 D 1
23 B 1
24 C 1
25 A 1
26 A 1
27 B 1
28 C 1
29 C 1
30 C 1
31 A 1
32 D 1
33 B 1
34 A 1
35 A 1
36 B 1
37 B 1
38 C 1
39 A 1
40 C 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 A 1
2 D 1
3 A 1
4 C 1
5 B 1
6 D 1
7 D 1
8 B 1
9 B 1
10 D 1
11 C 1
12 A 1
13 B 1
14 C 1
15 B 1
16 B 1
17 C 1
18 D 1
19 C 1
20 C 1
21 C 1
22 B 1
23 A 1
24 C 1
25 C 1
26 D 1
27 B 1
28 B 1
29 C 1
30 C 1
31 D 1
32 A 1
33 C 1
34 D 1
35 A 1
36 D 1
37 C 1
38 A 1
39 A 1
40 B 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/22
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 C 1
2 C 1
3 D 1
4 C 1
5 B 1
6 B 1
7 D 1
8 B 1
9 B 1
10 D 1
11 C 1
12 A 1
13 A 1
14 C 1
15 D 1
16 D 1
17 C 1
18 C 1
19 C 1
20 C 1
21 B 1
22 C 1
23 C 1
24 A 1
25 B 1
26 C 1
27 B 1
28 B 1
29 C 1
30 C 1
31 D 1
32 A 1
33 C 1
34 A 1
35 A 1
36 D 1
37 C 1
38 A 1
39 A 1
40 D 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/23
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
1 C 1
2 D 1
3 A 1
4 C 1
5 B 1
6 B 1
7 D 1
8 C 1
9 C 1
10 C 1
11 C 1
12 B 1
13 B 1
14 C 1
15 D 1
16 C 1
17 C 1
18 D 1
19 B 1
20 C 1
21 B 1
22 A 1
23 D 1
24 B 1
25 C 1
26 A 1
27 A 1
28 B 1
29 C 1
30 C 1
31 D 1
32 A 1
33 D 1
34 B 1
35 A 1
36 D 1
37 C 1
38 A 1
39 A 1
40 B 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Theory (Core) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a)(i) ammonia / NH3 1
1(a)(iii) methane / CH4 1
1(a)(v) argon / Ar 1
1(c) (substance containing) two (or more) types of atom bonded / two (or more) types of atom joined / two (or more) types of 1
atoms chemically combined
2(a)(i) 15.5(%) 1
2(a)(ii) hydrogen / H2 1
2(a)(iv) NO2 1
2(b)(i) compound of carbon and hydrogen only / compound of hydrogen and carbon with no other elements 2
2(b)(ii) poisonous / toxic 1
2(b)(iii) 5 (CO2) 1
6 (H2O) 1
• diffusion
• (bulk) movement of particles from higher to lower concentration / movement of particles down concentration gradient
3(a)(ii) solid 1
– 80 ºC is below the melting point / it is below the melting point / it has not yet reached its melting point / melts above – 80 ºC 1
3(b)(i) (substance which) speeds up a reaction / substance which increases the rate of reaction 1
3(c)(ii) orange / red-brown / brown 1
to colourless 1
4(a) nickel<iron<chromium<magnesium 2
• iron compounds have variable oxidation states / form ions with different charges / ORA for K
• one suitable difference in chemical properties e.g. iron is less reactive than potassium ORA / potassium reacts with
cold water / iron does not react with cold water / iron rusts / potassium does not rust
4(c) 3 (Fe) 1
2 (O2) 1
4(d) it loses oxygen / oxygen is removed from the iron oxide / hydrogen gains the oxygen from the iron oxide 1
4(e)(ii) Fe2Cl 6 1
5(a) breakdown 1
compound 1
molten 1
electricity 1
5(e) iodine 1
• electrons outside the nucleus / electrons surrounding the nucleus / electrons orbiting the nucleus
• 9 protons
• 9 electrons
• 10 neutrons
6(b) element 1
atomic 1
nucleons 1
6(c) any suitable e.g. treating cancer / checking thyroid function / tracer (in the body) 1
6(d) 235 1
U
92
7(a)(i) atomic radius of Rb: any value between 228 and 264 (inclusive of these values) 1
relative thermal conductivity of K: any value between 3.8 and 1.7 (inclusive of these values) 1
7(a)(ii) decreases down (the Group) / increases up (the Group) / decreases from sodium to caesium ORA 1
7(d) 76 2
water 1
8(c) line starts from 0 cm3 AND initial gradient less steep 1
8(e) pH 1 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/32
Paper 3 Theory (Core) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a)(i) chlorine / Cl 2 1
1(a)(ii) ammonia / NH3 1
1(a)(iii) neon / Ne 1
1(a)(v) ethene / C2H4 1
2(a)(i) 72 (%) 1
2(a)(ii) hydrogen / H2 1
2(b)(ii) 2 (NO2) 1
2 (NaOH) 1
2(c)(ii) compound of carbon and hydrogen only / compound of hydrogen and carbon with no other elements 2
3(a)(i) 5 1
3(a)(iv) idea of very long chains of repeating units / idea of lots of monomers joined together 1
3(b)(i) any typical property of an acid e.g. reacts with sodium hydroxide / reacts with hydroxides / reacts with carbonates / reacts 1
with metals / has pH below 7 / colourless / turns litmus red
3(c)(i) solid 1
–120 °C is below the melting point / it is below the melting point / it has not yet reached its melting point / melts above 1
–120 °C
3(c)(ii) addition 1
ethene 1
high 1
catalyst 1
• diffusion
• random movement of particles / particles move anywhere / particles move in all directions / particles move away
• (bulk) movement of particles from higher to lower concentration / movement of particles down concentration gradient
relights 1
4(c)(ii) 4 (HCl ) 1
2 (H2O) 1
4(d) lead<tin<manganese<magnesium 2
• Mn compounds have variable oxidation states / form ions with different charges / ORA for Na
• one suitable difference in chemical properties e.g. Mn is less reactive than Na ORA / Na reacts with cold water / Mn
does not react with cold water
5(a)(ii) cathode 1
5(a)(iv) carbon / platinum 1
5(b)(i) 150 (g) 1
• electrons outside the nucleus / electrons surrounding the nucleus / electrons orbiting the nucleus
• 7 protons
• 7 electrons
• 8 neutrons
6(b) atoms (of an element) with the same number of protons but different number of neutrons 2
6(c) any suitable use e.g. measuring the thickness of paper / energy from nuclear reactors / finding leaks (in pipelines) / smoke 1
alarms / energy production
7(a)(i) density of iodine: values between 3.10 and 6.35 (excluding these two values) 1
melting point of At2 values greater than 114 °C but less than 500 °C 1
7(a)(iii) (boiling point) increases down (the group) / (boiling point) decreases up (the group) / increases from chlorine to astatine ORA 1
7(b) iodine 1
potassium bromide 1
7(c) 171 2
• length of wick
• same can
8(b) B 1
8(d)(ii) exothermic because energy level of reactants above energy level of products / exothermic because the arrow is going 1
downwards
8(e)(i) mixture of metals / mixture of metal and non-metal / mixture of metal with another element 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/33
Paper 3 Theory (Core) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a)(ii) helium / He 1
1(a)(iii) nitrogen / N2 1
1(a)(iv) methane / CH4 1
1(a)(v) nitrogen / N2 1
• helium
• hydrogen
• nitrogen
1(b)(ii) (substance) containing only one type of atom / (substance) which cannot be broken down chemically into any other 1
substance
2(a)(i) 12(%) 1
2(b) distillation 1
kerosene 1
boiling 1
2(c) 3 (CO2) 1
4 (H2O) 1
• diffusion
• random movement of particles / particles move anywhere (in the liquid) / particles move in all directions
• (bulk) movement of particles from higher to lower concentration / movement of particles down concentration gradient
3(b)(ii) blue 1
to pink 1
3(c) Co2C8O8 1
3(d) cobalt<zinc<magnesium<barium 2
• Co compounds have variable oxidation states / form ions with different charges ORA
• one suitable difference in chemical properties e.g. cobalt is less reactive ORA / lithium reacts with cold water
3(f) 6 (CoO) 1
3(g) Co3O4 loses oxygen / it loses oxygen / oxygen is removed from the cobalt oxide / the cobalt oxide loses oxygen 1
4(a)(ii) orange / red-brown / brown 1
to colourless 1
4(a)(iii) liquid 1
4(b)(i) correct structure of ethanol showing all atoms and all bonds 1
4(b)(ii) sugar 1
30 ºC 1
enzymes 1
distillation 1
4(b)(iv) energy level of reactants above energy level of products / the arrow is going downwards / energy (level) goes 1
down / product has less energy than reactants
carbon 1
5(a) anode 1
5(c) add (sufficient) water and stir (to dissolve) / add the mixture to water 1
evaporate (some of the) water from the solution / warm solution to crystallisation point then leave (to crystallise) 1
5(d) bromine 1
5(e) cream 1
5(f) electron 1
• electrons outside the nucleus / electrons surrounding the nucleus / electrons orbiting the nucleus
• 8 protons
• 8 electrons
• 9 neutrons
7(a)(i) relative hardness of potassium: between 1 and 3 (exclusive of these two values) 1
melting point of rubidium: less than 63 ºC but not lower than 20 ºC 1
7(b) 2,8,1 1
turns blue 1
OR
turns blue / purple
7(d) 38 2
8(b) measure the volume of gas given off / measure volume of carbon dioxide produced 1
OR
measure time taken
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
chemically combined 1
1(b) dissolving 1
filtration 1
evaporation / crystallisation 1
1(c)(i) condenser 1
2(a) calcium / Ca 1
2(b) 7 1
2(c) 4 1
2(d)(i) radioisotopes 1
286
2(d)(ii) Fl 114p 172n 114e 1
289
Fl 114p 175n 114e 1
KF is ionic 1
fluorine 1
ratio of P to O 1
P = 0.054 / 0.054 O = 0.13 / 0.054
=1 = 2.5
mass = 220 (g) 1
without being used up (at the end) / remains unchanged or unaffected or without changing mass 1
5(c)(i) ZnSO4 1
5(c)(ii) (labelled) arrow pointing upwards starting level with reactants and finishing level with top of the hump. 1
1 mark for any equation which has Cu as the product or Cu2+ ions on left
1 mark for correct species
1 mark for correct state symbols
only 1
but-2-ene 1
6(f)(i) poly(ethene) 1
both amide links shown in the correct orientation for three amino acids 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/42
Paper 2 Theory (Extended) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a) distillation 1
1(b) electrolysis 1
1(c) filtration 1
1(e) chromatography 1
2(a) silicon / Si 1
2(b) aluminium / Al 1
2(c) sodium / Na 1
2(e) argon / Ar 1
2(f) sulfur / S 1
2(g) phosphorus / P 1
3 6
particles number of protons number of electrons number of neutrons number of nucleons
12 (1)
Fe (1) 2+ (1)
4(b)(i) (ionic): made of, positive and negative ions / anions and cations / oppositely charged ions / unlike charged ions / different 1
charged ions
(lattice): regular / sequence / pattern / alternating / repeated / framework / ordered / organised / network / uniform 1
decomposed / chemically changed 1
OR
molten or liquid or solution or aqueous AND containing ions/or ionic
4(c)(iii) potassium 1
(iodine monochloride): intermolecular forces / forces between molecules / named intermolecular forces, e.g. van der 1
Waals / London forces / dispersion forces / dipole- dipole
5(a) the rate of forward reaction equals (the rate of the) reverse reaction 1
5(b)(i) same number of gas moles on both sides of the equilibrium / same number of gas molecules on both sides of the 1
equilibrium
5(b)(ii) (increased pressure) particles or molecules (forced) closer together / same number of particles or molecules in a smaller 1
volume
5(c)(ii) increase / faster 1
increase / faster 1
6(b)(iii) blue 1
pink 1
6(b)(iv) boiling point sharp / melting point sharp / freezing point sharp / boiling point 100 (°)C / freezing point or melting point 0 (°)C 1
C3H8O 1
7(b) (C2H4O =) 44 1
C4H8O2 1
7(c)(ii) T V OR 2
7(d)(i) alcohol / alkanol 1
7(d)(ii) 1
only 1
alkene: CnH2n 1
(step 1) equation with only C8H18 on left hand side and C2H4 + other correct product(s) on right hand side 1
e.g. C8H18 → C2H4 + C6H14
(step 2) hydration / addition 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/43
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 80
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a) Cl2 / chlorine 1
1(c) Cu / copper 1
1(d) Ar / argon 1
2(a)(ii) nucleons: 27 1
neutrons: 14 1
electrons: 10 1
2(b)(i) bauxite 1
2(b)(iii) to lower the operating temperature / the mixture has a lower melting point than aluminium oxide 1
conduct electricity
conduct heat
malleable
ductile
shiny
melting point
hardness
strength
density
more of the colliding molecules have sufficient energy (activation energy) to react 1
3(f) 3+ 1
4(b) all bonding pairs correct and no extra incorrect non-bonding electrons 1
pure(r) product
fast(er) reaction
continuous process
renewable feedstock
lower temperature
lower pressure
4(e)(iii) ester 1
filter 1
4(f)(iii) ethanoic acid + copper carbonate → copper ethanoate + carbon dioxide + water 1
NiI2H12O6 1
5(b)(i) electrons 1
5(b)(iii) nickel 1
iodine 1
Ni2+ + 2e− → Ni OR 2 I− → I2 + 2 e − 1
5(c)(ii) oxygen 1
(explanation):
copper ions removed (but not added) copper ions not replaced in A
OR
copper ions both removed and added (at the same rate) copper ions are being replaced (continually)
6(a)(i) 74 1
0.12 1
6(a)(ii) 0.3 1
6(a)(iii) 0.02 1
6(a)(iv) 207 1
4.14 1
6(a)(v) 75% 1
6(b)(i) heat it 1
6(c)(i) red 1
6(c)(iii) → Cl O3 − + H3O+ 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
comparable to supervisor’s 1
indication 1
1(e)(i) experiment 1 1
1(f) pipette / burette 1
2(a) pH 1–3 1
white on standing 1
2(e) limewater 1
milky / cloudy / white ppt. 1
2(f)(ii) clears / dissolves / colourless / soluble 1
2(g)(ii) clears / dissolves / colourless / soluble 1
2(h) bubbles / fizz / effervescence 1
2(i) nitric 1
acid 1
2(j) zinc 1
carbonate 1
evaporation
• measured volume of water
• using measuring cylinder / pipette / burette
• heat to 40 °C / heat to >40 °C
• add KCl until no more dissolves / add excess KCl
• stir
• filter mixture (if heated to >40 °C then need to cool and filter)
• evaporate filtrate to dryness
• weigh solid
mass undissolved
• measured volume of water
• using measuring cylinder / pipette / burette
• heat to 40 °C
• stir
• filter
• weigh residue (do not award if residue washed)
• add weighed (excess) KCl to water – only awarded if mass of residue measured
• mass KCl dissolved = initial mass – final mass
CHEMISTRY 0620/52
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a) initial AND final AND temperature change boxes completed correctly 1
1(b) initial AND final temperature AND temperature change boxes completed correctly AND all temperature AND temperature 1
changes recorded to the same number of decimal places
1(e) exothermic 1
compare 1
turns white / brown / yellow 1
2(e) green 1
precipitate 1
2(f) iron(II) / Fe2+ 1
sulfate / SO42– 1
2(g) pH 4–9 1
2(h)(i) white 1
precipitate 1
2(h)(ii) no change / remains 1
2(i) no change / reaction / precipitate 1
2(j) calcium / Ca2+ 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/53
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a) all temperature boxes completed with all temperatures completed to same number of decimal places 1
1(c) all temperature boxes completed with all temperatures completed to same number of decimal places 1
1(f) exothermic 1
improvement: 1
use a pipette / burette or lag / insulation / lid
2(a)(i) yellow 1
clears / dissolves 1
white precipitate 1
turns blue 1
clears / dissolves 1
green precipitate 1
2(e) sodium / Na+ 1
hydroxide / OH– 1
2(f) colourless 1
precipitate / suspension 1
2(i) organic / fuel / flammable 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a) burette 1
1(c)(iii) 18.2 1
cm3 1
2(d)(i) experiment 1 1
3(a) hydrogen / H2 1
3(b) sulfuric 1
acid 1
3(c) limewater 1
milky / cloudy / white ppt. 1
3(d)(i) white 1
precipitate 1
evaporation
• measured volume of water
• using measuring cylinder / pipette / burette
• heat to 40 °C / heat to >40 °C
• add KCl until no more dissolves / add excess KCl
• stir
• filter mixture (if heated to >40 °C then need to cool and filter)
• evaporate filtrate to dryness
• weigh solid
mass undissolved
• measured volume of water
• using measuring cylinder / pipette / burette
• heat to 40 °C
• stir
• filter
• weigh residue (do not award if residue washed)
• add weighed (excess) KCl to water – only awarded if mass of residue measured
• mass KCl dissolved = initial mass – final mass
CHEMISTRY 0620/62
Paper 6 Alterative to Practical May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
milky / cloudy / white ppt. 1
extrapolation 1
2(e) exothermic 1
compare / average 1
3(d) green 1
precipitate 1
3(f) calcium 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/63
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2018
MARK SCHEME
Maximum Mark: 40
Published
This mark scheme is published as an aid to teachers and candidates, to indicate the requirements of the
examination. It shows the basis on which Examiners were instructed to award marks. It does not indicate the
details of the discussions that took place at an Examiners’ meeting before marking began, which would have
considered the acceptability of alternative answers.
Mark schemes should be read in conjunction with the question paper and the Principal Examiner Report for
Teachers.
Cambridge International will not enter into discussions about these mark schemes.
Cambridge International is publishing the mark schemes for the May/June 2018 series for most
Cambridge IGCSE™, Cambridge International A and AS Level and Cambridge Pre-U components, and
some Cambridge O Level components.
This syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
These general marking principles must be applied by all examiners when marking candidate answers. They should be applied alongside the
specific content of the mark scheme or generic level descriptors for a question. Each question paper and mark scheme will also comply with these
marking principles.
• the specific content of the mark scheme or the generic level descriptors for the question
• the specific skills defined in the mark scheme or in the generic level descriptors for the question
• the standard of response required by a candidate as exemplified by the standardisation scripts.
Marks awarded are always whole marks (not half marks, or other fractions).
• marks are awarded for correct/valid answers, as defined in the mark scheme. However, credit is given for valid answers which go beyond the
scope of the syllabus and mark scheme, referring to your Team Leader as appropriate
• marks are awarded when candidates clearly demonstrate what they know and can do
• marks are not deducted for errors
• marks are not deducted for omissions
• answers should only be judged on the quality of spelling, punctuation and grammar when these features are specifically assessed by the
question as indicated by the mark scheme. The meaning, however, should be unambiguous.
Rules must be applied consistently e.g. in situations where candidates have not followed instructions or in the application of generic level
descriptors.
Marks should be awarded using the full range of marks defined in the mark scheme for the question (however; the use of the full mark range may
be limited according to the quality of the candidate responses seen).
Marks awarded are based solely on the requirements as defined in the mark scheme. Marks should not be awarded with grade thresholds or
grade descriptors in mind.
1(a)(i) balance 1
1(a)(ii) crucible 1
1(b) open 1
improvement 1
use a pipette / use a burette / lag / insulation / lid
3(a)(i) yellow 1
3(a)(ii) pH 11–14 1
clears / dissolves 1
white precipitate 1
3(d) grey-green 1
precipitate 1
3(e) organic / fuel / flammable 1
CHEMISTRY 0620/11
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2018
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*9563332168*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_11/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 2 3
A B C D
3 The melting points and boiling points of pure substances W, X and Y are shown.
W X Y
W X Y
What is Q?
A ammonia, NH3
B chlorine, Cl 2
C methane, CH4
D water, H2O
‘lead’
When the percentage of graphite is increased, the pencil slides across the paper more easily.
8 The equation for the reaction between magnesium and dilute sulfuric acid is shown.
Mg + H2SO4 → MgSO4 + H2
Which mass of magnesium sulfate is formed when 12 g of magnesium completely reacts with
dilute sulfuric acid?
A 5g B 10 g C 60 g D 120 g
9 What is observed at each electrode when molten lead(II) bromide is electrolysed using platinum
electrodes?
A argon
B hydrogen
C nitrogen
D oxygen
A A gas is produced.
B Energy is released.
C Heat is absorbed.
D The mass of the fuel decreases.
hydrogen
excess dilute
magnesium hydrochloric acid at 25 °C
Increasing the concentration of the acid and increasing the temperature both affect the rate of
reaction.
A The copper(II) sulfate turns blue and the solution formed gets colder.
B The copper(II) sulfate turns blue and the solution formed gets hotter.
C The copper(II) sulfate turns white and the solution formed gets colder.
D The copper(II) sulfate turns white and the solution formed gets hotter.
A C + O2 → CO2
D N2O4 → 2NO2
A gas, G, is produced which is denser than air and extinguishes a burning splint.
solid F gas G
A calcium hydrogen
B calcium carbonate carbon dioxide
C calcium hydroxide hydrogen
D calcium oxide carbon dioxide
17 Which methods are suitable for preparing both zinc sulfate and copper(II) sulfate?
1 reacting the metal oxide with warm dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
2 reacting the metal with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
3 reacting the metal carbonate with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
test X Y
a few drops of aqueous green precipitate red-brown
sodium hydroxide are added formed precipitate formed
a few drops of dilute nitric acid and no change seen white precipitate
a few drops of barium nitrate are added formed
a few drops of dilute nitric acid and white precipitate no change seen
a few drops of silver nitrate are added formed
X Y
A germanium
B scandium
C sodium
D strontium
21 Which row shows the catalytic activity of transition elements and their compounds?
A good good
B good poor
C poor good
D poor poor
23 The following statements are made about the metals copper, iron, magnesium and zinc.
The oxides of the same three metals were also heated strongly with carbon.
25 In a blast furnace, iron ore is mixed with coke and limestone, and heated in hot air.
A C + O2 → CO2
B CO2 + C → 2CO
27 Dry air is passed over hot copper until all the oxygen has reacted.
heat
28 A steel bicycle which had been left outdoors for several months was starting to rust.
A 1, 2, 3 and 4
B 1, 2 and 3 only
C 1, 3 and 4 only
D 2, 3 and 4 only
30 Farmers use fertilisers to replace minerals in the soil that have been removed by the crops they
grow.
A Ca, P, O B K, O, S C N, K, P D N, O, S
B Sulfur dioxide turns acidified aqueous potassium manganate(VII) from purple to colourless.
A electrolysis
B fractional distillation
C incomplete combustion
D thermal decomposition
untreated treated
waste waste
lime
A acidic → neutral
B alkaline → acidic
C alkaline → neutral
D neutral → acidic
ethane
ethanoic acid
ethanol
ethene
F F F F F F
F C F F C C F F C C C F
F F F F F F
40 Polymers are long-chain molecules made from small molecules linked together.
1 carbohydrates
2 nylon
3 proteins
4 Terylene
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/11/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/12
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2018
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*8053932751*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_12/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
when liquid
when iodine when ice
ammonia
is heated is heated
is cooled
A boiling freezing melting
B freezing sublimation boiling
C sublimation condensation freezing
D sublimation freezing melting
2 Which piece of apparatus cannot be used to collect and measure the volume of gas produced in
an experiment?
A burette
B gas syringe
C measuring cylinder
D pipette
3 Pure ethanol has a melting point of –114 °C and a boiling point of 78 °C.
What are the melting and boiling points of a sample of ethanol with glucose dissolved in it?
melting boiling
point / °C point / °C
A –116 77
B –116 79
C –112 77
D –112 79
A alloy
B compound
C element
D non-metal
Y X Y
Which row shows the type of bond in XY2 and the type of element X?
A covalent metal
B covalent non-metal
C ionic metal
D ionic non-metal
‘lead’
When the percentage of graphite is increased, the pencil slides across the paper more easily.
8 The equation for the reaction between magnesium and dilute sulfuric acid is shown.
Mg + H2SO4 → MgSO4 + H2
Which mass of magnesium sulfate is formed when 12 g of magnesium completely reacts with
dilute sulfuric acid?
A 5g B 10 g C 60 g D 120 g
power
supply
+ –
molten
lead(II) bromide
A Endothermic reactions show a temperature decrease because energy is absorbed from the
surroundings.
B Endothermic reactions show a temperature increase because energy is released into the
surroundings.
C Exothermic reactions show a temperature increase because energy is absorbed from the
surroundings.
D Exothermic reactions show a temperature decrease because energy is released into the
surroundings.
hydrogen
excess dilute
magnesium hydrochloric acid at 25 °C
Increasing the concentration of the acid and increasing the temperature both affect the rate of
reaction.
13 Reaction X shows a test for water. Reaction Y occurs in the blast furnace for extracting iron.
1 2
A irreversible oxidised
B irreversible reduced
C reversible oxidised
D reversible reduced
A C + O2 → CO2
D N2O4 → 2NO2
15 Which two gases each give the same result for the test shown?
17 Which methods are suitable for preparing both zinc sulfate and copper(II) sulfate?
1 reacting the metal oxide with warm dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
2 reacting the metal with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
3 reacting the metal carbonate with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
What is compound X?
A chromium(III) carbonate
B chromium(III) chloride
C iron(II) carbonate
D iron(II) chloride
A Elements in the same group have the same number of electron shells.
B It contains elements arranged in order of increasing proton number.
C Metals are on the right and non-metals are on the left.
D The most reactive elements are at the bottom of every group.
20 Chlorine, bromine and iodine are elements in Group VII of the Periodic Table.
property 1 property 2
A
B
C
D
The student does some experiments to find out the position of metal Z in the reactivity series.
Which statement about the position of metal Z in the reactivity series is correct?
raw
materials
waste gases
zone 3
zone 2
zone 1
hot air
slag
molten iron
26 Which row describes the use of an alloy and the property upon which the use depends?
27 Dry air is passed over hot copper until all the oxygen has reacted.
heat
28 A steel bicycle which had been left outdoors for several months was starting to rust.
A 1, 2, 3 and 4
B 1, 2 and 3 only
C 1, 3 and 4 only
D 2, 3 and 4 only
30 Ammonium nitrate is a common fertiliser used by farmers to increase the yield of their crops.
A calcium hydroxide
B potassium nitrate
C sodium chloride
D sodium phosphate
A manufacture of alkenes
B manufacture of cement
C manufacture of iron
D manufacture of lime
untreated treated
waste waste
lime
A acidic → neutral
B alkaline → acidic
C alkaline → neutral
D neutral → acidic
ethane
ethanoic acid
ethanol
ethene
39 The equations for two important processes used to manufacture ethanol are shown.
starch
ethanoic acid
sodium chloride
sugar
A ethanoic acid
B sodium chloride
C starch
D sugar
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/12/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/13
Paper 1 Multiple Choice (Core) May/June 2018
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*4491578785*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_13/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
After five minutes, the damp red litmus paper turned blue.
A crystallisation
B diffusion
C distillation
D sublimation
The initial temperature of the dilute sulfuric acid and the final temperature of the solution are
shown.
25 25
20 20
15 15
10 10
A –6 B –4 C 4 D 6
3 The melting points of four impure samples of lead(II) bromide were measured. The results are
shown.
A 342 355
B 353 360
C 365 371
D 372 373
40 41 2+ 37 37
20 W 20 X 18 Y 17 Z
5 Which name is given to a pure substance made from more than one type of atom?
A alloy
B compound
C element
D mixture
6 The diagram shows solid element Q reacting with an acid to produce gas R.
gas R
acid
solid element Q
Q R
‘lead’
When the percentage of graphite is increased, the pencil slides across the paper more easily.
8 The equation for the reaction between magnesium and dilute sulfuric acid is shown.
Mg + H2SO4 → MgSO4 + H2
Which mass of magnesium sulfate is formed when 12 g of magnesium completely reacts with
dilute sulfuric acid?
A 5g B 10 g C 60 g D 120 g
9 What is produced at each electrode when molten rubidium chloride is electrolysed using platinum
electrodes?
A chlorine hydrogen
B chlorine rubidium
C hydrogen chlorine
D rubidium chlorine
A carbon dioxide
B heat energy
C smoke
D water
hydrogen
excess dilute
magnesium hydrochloric acid at 25 °C
Increasing the concentration of the acid and increasing the temperature both affect the rate of
reaction.
X → Y
blue white
A C + O2 → CO2
D N2O4 → 2NO2
15 Pieces of damp red litmus paper and damp blue litmus paper are placed in three different gas
jars.
In which gas jars does at least one piece of litmus paper change colour?
17 Which methods are suitable for preparing both zinc sulfate and copper(II) sulfate?
1 reacting the metal oxide with warm dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
2 reacting the metal with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
3 reacting the metal carbonate with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
A small amount of dilute nitric acid is added followed by aqueous silver nitrate.
A calcium
B chlorine
C chromium
D copper
Element Q has a low boiling point, low density and does not conduct electricity.
Which element is Q?
A
B
C D
A B C D
X no yes
Y yes no
Z yes yes
most least
reactive reactive
A X Z Y
B Y X Z
C Y Z X
D Z Y X
27 Dry air is passed over hot copper until all the oxygen has reacted.
heat
28 A steel bicycle which had been left outdoors for several months was starting to rust.
A 1, 2, 3 and 4
B 1, 2 and 3 only
C 1, 3 and 4 only
D 2, 3 and 4 only
Which compounds can be mixed to provide the three elements needed for healthy plant growth?
31 Carbon dioxide and methane are both greenhouse gases which contribute to climate change.
● bleaching agent
● killing bacteria
What is Z?
A carbon
B lead
C nitrogen
D sulfur
1 2
A lime neutralisation
B lime thermal decomposition
C slaked lime neutralisation
D slaked lime thermal decomposition
untreated treated
waste waste
lime
A acidic → neutral
B alkaline → acidic
C alkaline → neutral
D neutral → acidic
ethane
ethanoic acid
ethanol
ethene
1 2
H H H H H
H C C O H H C C C H
H H H H H
3 4
H H H H H O
H C C C O H H C C C
H H H H H O H
39 Sugars and ethene can both be made into ethanol using different reactions.
A fermentation addition
B fermentation cracking
C incomplete combustion addition
D incomplete combustion cracking
A
B
C
D
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/13/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/21
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2018
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*1264661612*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_21/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 A student investigated the diffusion of ammonia gas, NH3, and hydrogen chloride gas, HCl.
Two sets of apparatus were set up as shown at room temperature and pressure.
apparatus 1 apparatus 2
The damp red litmus paper in apparatus 1 changed colour after 30 seconds.
How long does it take for the damp blue litmus paper to change colour in apparatus 2?
A 64 seconds
B 30 seconds
C 21 seconds
D The blue litmus paper would not change colour.
solvent front
baseline
A B C D
dyes
A B C D
‘lead’
When the percentage of graphite is increased, the pencil slides across the paper more easily.
Which statement explains why the two isotopes are of the same element?
A diamond
B graphite
C silicon(IV) oxide
D sulfur
1 Copper is malleable because layers of ions are in fixed positions and cannot move.
2 The structure of copper consists of negative ions in a lattice.
3 Copper conducts electricity because electrons can move through the metal.
4 Electrons hold copper ions together in a lattice by electrostatic attraction.
Which volume of carbon dioxide, at room temperature and pressure, is formed when 0.5 moles of
ethane burn?
What are the ionic half-equations for the reactions that take place at each electrode?
Which row describes and explains the energy change that occurs?
type of
explanation
energy change
A endothermic less energy is released making bonds than is absorbed to break bonds
B endothermic more energy is released making bonds than is absorbed to break bonds
C exothermic less energy is released making bonds than is absorbed to break bonds
D exothermic more energy is released making bonds than is absorbed to break bonds
13 Hydrogen bromide decomposes to form hydrogen and bromine. The equation is shown.
The bond energies are shown in the table. The reaction is endothermic.
bond energy
bond
in kJ / mol
Br–Br +193
H–Br +366
H–H +436
14 Which row describes the effects of increasing both concentration and temperature on the
collisions between reacting particles?
C more collisions per second only more collisions per second and more
collisions with sufficient energy to react
D more collisions per second and more more collisions per second and more
collisions with sufficient energy to react collisions with sufficient energy to react
pressure temperature
A high high
B high low
C low high
D low low
Cl 2 + 2I– → I2 + 2Cl –
A chloride ions
B chlorine
C iodide ions
D iodine
19 A student mixes silver nitrate and barium chloride to form a white precipitate of silver chloride.
soluble insoluble
A silver nitrate barium chloride, barium nitrate
and silver chloride
B silver nitrate and barium chloride barium nitrate and silver chloride
C silver nitrate, barium chloride silver chloride
and barium nitrate
D silver nitrate, barium chloride barium nitrate
and silver chloride
20 Which methods are suitable for preparing both zinc sulfate and copper(II) sulfate?
1 reacting the metal oxide with warm dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
2 reacting the metal with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
3 reacting the metal carbonate with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
A germanium
B scandium
C sodium
D strontium
23 Which row shows the catalytic activity of transition elements and their compounds?
A good good
B good poor
C poor good
D poor poor
24 The following statements are made about the metals copper, iron, magnesium and zinc.
28 Dry air is passed over hot copper until all the oxygen has reacted.
heat
29 A steel bicycle which had been left outdoors for several months was starting to rust.
A 1, 2, 3 and 4
B 1, 2 and 3 only
C 1, 3 and 4 only
D 2, 3 and 4 only
Which row describes the sources of hydrogen and nitrogen and the conditions used in the
manufacture of ammonia in the Haber process?
B Sulfur dioxide turns acidified aqueous potassium manganate(VII) from purple to colourless.
A electrolysis
B fractional distillation
C incomplete combustion
D thermal decomposition
A bromination
B hydration
C hydrogenation
D hydrolysis
A CH3CH2COOCH3
B CH3COOCH2CH2CH3
C CH3CH2CH2COOCH3
D HCOOCH2CH2CH3
B monomers have a C=C double bond the monomers react to form the
and the polymer is the only product polymer and a small molecule
C the monomers react to form the monomers have a C=C double bond
polymer and a small molecule and the polymer is the only product
D the monomers react to form the the monomers react to form the
polymer and a small molecule polymer and a small molecule
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/21/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/22
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2018
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*2609976664*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_22/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
Which gas turns the damp Universal Indicator paper red most quickly?
A ammonia, NH3
B chlorine, Cl 2
C hydrogen chloride, HCl
D sulfur dioxide, SO2
The Rf values measured for these substances were 0.3, 0.5, 0.8 and 0.8.
A B C D
solvent front
baseline
3 Which piece of apparatus cannot be used to collect and measure the volume of gas produced in
an experiment?
A burette
B gas syringe
C measuring cylinder
D pipette
‘lead’
When the percentage of graphite is increased, the pencil slides across the paper more easily.
23 24
B 11 M and 11M
23 23
C 11 M and 12 M
24 + 24 +
D 11M and 12 M
A diamond
B graphite
C silicon(IV) oxide
D sulfur
8 The equation for the reaction between potassium carbonate and nitric acid is shown.
What are the ionic half-equations for the reactions that take place at each electrode?
12 Which diagram is a correctly labelled energy level diagram for an endothermic reaction?
A B
products products
overall
activation
energy energy
overall energy energy
change activation
energy
energy
change
reactants reactants
C D
activation
reactants reactants energy
products products
bond energy
bond
in kJ / mol
C–H +410
C=O +805
O–H +460
O=O +496
14 Which row describes the effects of increasing both concentration and temperature on the
collisions between reacting particles?
15 Sulfur dioxide reacts with oxygen at 2 atmospheres pressure. The forward reaction is exothermic.
How and why does the amount of sulfur trioxide formed change?
Which two aqueous solutions produce an insoluble salt when mixed together?
20 Which methods are suitable for preparing both zinc sulfate and copper(II) sulfate?
1 reacting the metal oxide with warm dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
2 reacting the metal with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
3 reacting the metal carbonate with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
A Elements in the same group have the same number of electron shells.
B It contains elements arranged in order of increasing proton number.
C Metals are on the right and non-metals are on the left.
D The most reactive elements are at the bottom of every group.
22 Chlorine, bromine and iodine are elements in Group VII of the Periodic Table.
property 1 property 2
A
B
C
D
25 Metal X is more reactive than metal Y. Metal Y is more reactive than metal Z.
27 Which row describes the use of an alloy and the property upon which the use depends?
28 Dry air is passed over hot copper until all the oxygen has reacted.
heat
29 A steel bicycle which had been left outdoors for several months was starting to rust.
A 1, 2, 3 and 4
B 1, 2 and 3 only
C 1, 3 and 4 only
D 2, 3 and 4 only
Which row describes the sources of hydrogen and nitrogen and the conditions used in the
manufacture of ammonia in the Haber process?
A manufacture of alkenes
B manufacture of cement
C manufacture of iron
D manufacture of lime
38 Two processes used for the large-scale production of ethanol are shown.
CH3COOH + CH3CH2OH →
A ethyl ethanoate
B ethyl methanoate
C methyl ethanoate
D methyl propanoate
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/22/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
CHEMISTRY 0620/23
Paper 2 Multiple Choice (Extended) May/June 2018
45 minutes
Additional Materials: Multiple Choice Answer Sheet
Soft clean eraser
*8762427084*
There are forty questions on this paper. Answer all questions. For each question there are four possible
answers A, B, C and D.
Choose the one you consider correct and record your choice in soft pencil on the separate Answer Sheet.
Each correct answer will score one mark. A mark will not be deducted for a wrong answer.
Any rough working should be done in this booklet.
A copy of the Periodic Table is printed on page 16.
Electronic calculators may be used.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_23/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 Ammonia gas is reacted with hydrogen chloride gas using the apparatus shown.
Which statement explains why the solid ammonium chloride is formed nearer to the
hydrogen chloride?
2 Paper chromatography is done in the same way with three different mixtures of dyes. Each
mixture contains at least one of the dyes W, X, Y and Z.
A Dye W is nearest the solvent front and is present only in mixture 1 and mixture 3.
B Dye X has travelled furthest up the chromatography paper.
C Dye Y is the only dye present in all three mixtures.
D Dye Z is nearest the solvent front and is found in only two of the mixtures.
The initial temperature of the dilute sulfuric acid and the final temperature of the solution are
shown.
25 25
20 20
15 15
10 10
A –6 B –4 C 4 D 6
‘lead’
When the percentage of graphite is increased, the pencil slides across the paper more easily.
5 Iron has an atomic number of 26. It occurs as the isotopes 54Fe, 56Fe, 57Fe and 58Fe.
Which statement explains why these isotopes have the same chemical properties?
6 How many silicon atoms are bonded to each oxygen atom in a crystal of silicon(IV) oxide?
A 1 B 2 C 3 D 4
A diamond
B graphite
C silicon(IV) oxide
D sulfur
10 cm3 of the gaseous hydrocarbon, CxHy, was burned in an excess of oxygen to form 20 cm3 of
carbon dioxide and 30 cm3 of water vapour.
What is CxHy?
9 4.00 g of solid sodium hydroxide is added to water to make a solution with a concentration of
0.200 mol / dm3.
What are the ionic half-equations for the reactions that take place at each electrode?
• The neutralisation reaction between citric acid and sodium hydrogencarbonate is endothermic.
1 The energy of the products formed in the neutralisation reaction is greater than the
energy of the reactants.
2 The energy of magnesium and carbon dioxide is greater than the energy of
magnesium oxide and carbon.
3 In an exothermic reaction, the energy required to break the bonds is greater than the
energy released when the new bonds are formed.
CH2=CH2 + H2 → C2H6
The bond energies are shown in the table. The reaction is exothermic.
bond energy
bond
in kJ / mol
C–C +350
C=C +610
C–H +410
H–H +436
14 Which row describes the effects of increasing both concentration and temperature on the
collisions between reacting particles?
15 In the Contact process, sulfur dioxide is converted into sulfur trioxide in a reversible reaction.
pressure
temperature
/ atmospheres
A 0.5 high
B 0.5 low
C 1.5 high
D 1.5 low
A as a strong acid
B as a strong base
C as a weak acid
D as a weak base
19 An excess of aqueous sodium sulfate was added to aqueous barium chloride and the mixture
was filtered.
Which row shows the identity of the residue and the substances present in the filtrate?
20 Which methods are suitable for preparing both zinc sulfate and copper(II) sulfate?
1 reacting the metal oxide with warm dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
2 reacting the metal with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
3 reacting the metal carbonate with dilute aqueous sulfuric acid
A calcium
B chlorine
C chromium
D copper
Element Q has a low boiling point, low density and does not conduct electricity.
Which element is Q?
A
B
C D
A B C D
Z + X2+ → Z2+ + X
Z + 2W+ → Z2+ + 2W
X + 2W+ → X2+ + 2W
Y + Z2+ → Y2+ + Z
most least
reactive reactive
A W X Z Y
B X W Y Z
C Y Z X W
D Z W X Y
26 Which equation represents the first stage in the extraction of zinc from zinc blende?
C ZnO + CO → Zn + CO2
28 Dry air is passed over hot copper until all the oxygen has reacted.
heat
29 A steel bicycle which had been left outdoors for several months was starting to rust.
A 1, 2, 3 and 4
B 1, 2 and 3 only
C 1, 3 and 4 only
D 2, 3 and 4 only
Which row describes the sources of hydrogen and nitrogen and the conditions used in the
manufacture of ammonia in the Haber process?
● bleaching agent
● killing bacteria
What is Z?
A carbon
B lead
C nitrogen
D sulfur
1 2
A lime neutralisation
B lime thermal decomposition
C slaked lime neutralisation
D slaked lime thermal decomposition
advantage disadvantage
1 ethyl propanoate
2 propyl ethanoate
3 butyl methanoate
4 methyl butanoate
A 1, 2, 3 and 4
B 1, 2 and 3 only
C 1 and 2 only
D 3 and 4 only
type of
formed by
polymer
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every
reasonable effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the
publisher will be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge
International Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at
www.cie.org.uk after the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/23/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*9841440026*
CHEMISTRY 0620/31
Paper 3 Theory (Core) May/June 2018
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_31/2RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
ammonia
argon
carbon dioxide
helium
hydrogen
methane
neon
sulfur dioxide
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iv) is a product of the reaction of copper(II) carbonate with hydrochloric acid
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(v) is a monatomic gas which has atoms with the electronic structure 2,8,8.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b) (i) Explain why helium and not hydrogen is used to fill party balloons.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) Complete the dot-and-cross diagram to show the electron arrangement in a molecule of
ammonia. Show outer shell electrons only.
H N H
[2]
[Total: 10]
2 The table shows the percentage by volume of each of the gases present in the exhaust gases from
a petrol engine.
(a) (i) Calculate the percentage by volume of carbon dioxide in the exhaust gases.
..............................% [1]
(ii) Which gas shown in the table is present in the lowest percentage by volume?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Which two elements in the table combine to form nitrogen dioxide?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(v) Where does the nitrogen in the exhaust gases come from?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b)
The carbon monoxide in the exhaust gases comes from the incomplete combustion of
hydrocarbons.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Balance the chemical equation for the complete combustion of pentane.
[Total: 10]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [3]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(b) An enzyme present in peppermint plants is a catalyst for the oxidation of limonene.
(i) catalyst
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) oxidation
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
H
H
H CH3
C C
H3C C C C OH
C C H CH3
H H
H H
(i) What feature of the structure of the α-terpineol molecule shows that it is an unsaturated
compound?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Describe how the colour of aqueous bromine changes when an excess of α-terpineol is
added to it.
[Total: 10]
(a) The table shows how easy it is to reduce four metal oxides by heating with carbon.
Use this information to put the metals in order of their reactivity. Put the least reactive metal
first.
[2]
(b) Iron is a transition element. Potassium is an element in Group I of the Periodic Table.
Describe three ways in which the properties of iron differ from those of potassium.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
3 ..................................................................................................................................................
[3]
(d) Pure iron can be made by reducing iron(III) oxide, Fe2O3, with hydrogen.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) When iron reacts with dilute hydrochloric acid, iron(II) chloride is formed.
test .......................................................................................................................................
result ....................................................................................................................................
[2]
Cl Cl Cl
Fe Fe
Cl Cl Cl
Deduce the molecular formula of this compound showing the number of iron and chlorine
atoms.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(f) Some iron nails were placed in bottles under different conditions.
A B C D
moist boiled
air water
water
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 13]
5 (a) Complete the sentence about electrolysis using words from the list.
(b) Molten zinc iodide can be electrolysed using the apparatus shown.
+ –
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) When chlorine is bubbled through a colourless aqueous solution of zinc iodide, the solution
turns brown.
Name the brown substance. Suggest, using ideas about reactivity of the halogens, why this
reaction occurs.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 11]
9F
19
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [5]
(b) Complete the sentence about isotopes using words from the list.
Isotopes are atoms of the same .............................. which have the same
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[1]
[Total: 10]
(a) The properties of some Group I elements are shown in the table.
(ii) Describe the trend in the boiling points of the Group I elements.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Use the information in the table to predict what you would observe when rubidium reacts
with cold water.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b) Which one of the statements about the formation of a sodium ion from a sodium atom is
correct?
Tick one box.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) Complete the word equation for the reaction of sodium hydroxide with sulfuric acid.
[2]
[Total: 10]
80
60
volume of
hydrogen 40
gas / cm3
20
0
0 2 4 6 8 10 12
time / min
(a) Explain why the volume of hydrogen gas remains constant after six minutes.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) What volume of hydrogen gas was released in the first two minutes of the reaction?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) The experiment is repeated using the same volume of 0.1 mol / dm3 hydrochloric acid.
All other conditions are kept the same.
On the grid, draw the graph for the experiment using 0.1 mol / dm3 hydrochloric acid.
[2]
(d) Give the name of the salt formed when zinc reacts with hydrochloric acid.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) Which one of the following pH values could be the pH of dilute hydrochloric acid?
Draw a circle around the correct answer.
pH 1 pH 7 pH 9 pH 13 [1]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
16
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/31/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*3868593465*
CHEMISTRY 0620/32
Paper 3 Theory (Core) May/June 2018
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_32/2RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
ammonia
carbon monoxide
chlorine
ethane
ethene
helium
hydrogen
neon
oxygen
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(c) Complete the dot-and-cross diagram to show the electron arrangement in a molecule of
chlorine. Show outer shell electrons only.
Cl Cl
[2]
[Total: 9]
2 The table shows the percentage by volume of each of the gases present in the exhaust gases from
a petrol engine with a catalytic converter.
(a) (i) Calculate the percentage by volume of nitrogen in the exhaust gases.
..............................% [1]
(ii) Which gas shown in the table is present in the lowest percentage by volume?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Balance the chemical equation for the reaction of nitrogen dioxide with sodium hydroxide.
(iii) State the name of the salt with the formula NaNO3.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(d) The table shows the composition of a sample of dry natural gas.
Calculate the percentage by volume of hydrocarbons in the sample of dry natural gas.
..............................% [1]
[Total: 10]
H H O H H O
N C C N C C
H H C HO H H H C HO H
S O
H H
compound A compound B
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) On structure B draw a circle around the alcohol functional group. [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Complete the structure of ethanoic acid showing all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
H C
H
[1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(ii) Complete the sentences about the manufacture of ethanol using words from the list.
.............................. . [4]
[Total: 12]
crystal of
potassium
manganate(VII)
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Potassium manganate(VII) decomposes when heated. The products are oxygen and
manganese(IV) oxide.
test .......................................................................................................................................
result ....................................................................................................................................
[2]
(d) The table compares the reactivity of four metals with hydrochloric acid of the same concentration.
Use this information to put the metals in order of their reactivity. Put the least reactive metal
first.
[2]
(e) Manganese is a transition element. Sodium is an element in Group I of the Periodic Table.
Describe three ways in which the properties of manganese differ from those of sodium.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
3 ..................................................................................................................................................
[3]
[Total: 13]
5 (a) Electrolysis of concentrated aqueous sodium chloride can be done using the apparatus shown.
electrolyte
electrodes
+ –
power supply
Complete the diagram to show how the gases can be collected. [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Predict the main products of the electrolysis of concentrated aqueous sodium chloride at:
(iv) Give the name of a suitable element to use as the electrodes in this electrolysis.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) What effect would impurities have on the melting point of sodium hydroxide?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(c)
Describe how you could prepare a sample of solid sodium chloride from a solution of
sodium chloride.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 8]
7N
15
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [5]
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 8]
7 (a) The properties of some Group VII elements are shown in the table.
(ii) Suggest why the density of chlorine at room temperature is much lower than the density
of bromine and astatine at room temperature.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[2]
(c) A compound has the formula C2F4Cl 2.
[Total: 9]
8 The energy released by burning four different fuels is compared using the apparatus shown.
A known mass of each fuel is burned and the temperature rise of the water is measured.
thermometer
clamp
steel can
water
flame
fuel
(a) Suggest two factors that should be kept constant in this experiment.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(b) The table shows the temperature changes when four different fuels, A, B, C and D, are burned.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) The energy level diagram for the complete combustion of ethanol is shown.
ethanol + ..............................
energy
progress of reaction
(i) Complete the diagram by filling in the missing reactant and the missing product. [2]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Describe the arrangement and type of motion of the particles in solid iron.
arrangement ........................................................................................................................
(iii) Suggest why stainless steel is used instead of pure iron for making cutlery.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 11]
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
16
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/32/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*3497163988*
CHEMISTRY 0620/33
Paper 3 Theory (Core) May/June 2018
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_33/2RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
ammonia
ethene
helium
hydrogen
hydrogen chloride
methane
nitrogen
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(c) Complete the dot-and-cross diagram to show the electron arrangement in a molecule of
hydrogen chloride. Show outer electrons only.
H Cl
[2]
[Total: 9]
2 (a) The table shows the percentage by volume of each of the gases present in the exhaust gases
from a petrol engine and a diesel engine.
(i) In the diesel engine, nitrogen, carbon dioxide and water vapour account for 90.00% of the
exhaust gases by volume.
Calculate the percentage by volume of carbon dioxide in the exhaust gases from the
diesel engine.
..............................% [1]
(ii) Describe three ways in which the composition of the exhaust gases from the petrol engine
differ from the composition of the exhaust gases from the diesel engine.
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
3 ...........................................................................................................................................
[3]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b) Complete the sentences about the separation of petroleum into fractions using words from the
list.
and ............................... . Within each fraction, the molecules have a particular range of
.............................. points.
[3]
(c) Balance the chemical equation for the complete combustion of propane.
[Total: 10]
(a) A coloured crystal of cobalt(II) chloride was placed at the bottom of a beaker containing water.
After 2 days, the colour had spread throughout the water.
water
crystal of
cobalt(II) chloride
at the start after 2 hours after 2 days
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
Describe how the colour of anhydrous cobalt(II) chloride changes when water is added to it.
(ii)
key
= cobalt, Co
= carbon, C
= oxygen, O
Deduce the molecular formula of this compound showing the number of cobalt, carbon and
oxygen atoms.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) The table compares the reactivity of cobalt with that of three other metals.
Use this information to put the metals in order of their reactivity. Put the least reactive metal
first.
[2]
(e) Cobalt is a transition element. Lithium is an element in Group I of the Periodic Table.
Describe three ways in which the properties of cobalt differ from those of lithium.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
3 ..................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(f) When cobalt(II) oxide, CoO, is heated in air, an oxide with the formula Co3O4 is formed.
.....CoO + O2 2Co3O4
[1]
(g) When Co3O4 is heated with hydrogen, cobalt metal can be formed.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 13]
H H H
C C C O
H H H
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Describe how the colour of aqueous bromine changes when an excess of compound P is
added to it.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(i) Draw the structure of ethanol showing all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[1]
Complete the sentences about fermentation using words from the list.
30
°C 300
°C distillation electrolysis
The yeast contains .............................. which catalyse the reaction. The ethanol is
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iv) The energy level diagram for the complete combustion of ethanol is shown.
ethanol + oxygen
energy
progress of reaction
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(v) Carbon dioxide and water can be formed when ethanol burns in a limited supply of air.
State the name of two other products which can be formed when ethanol burns in a limited
supply of air.
[Total: 14]
5 (a) Molten lead(II) bromide can be electrolysed using the apparatus shown.
+ –
inert electrodes
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
Describe how you could obtain crystals of sodium bromide from a mixture of solid lead(II) bromide
and solid sodium bromide.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
(d) When chlorine is bubbled through a colourless aqueous solution of sodium bromide, the
solution turns orange‑brown.
Name the orange-brown substance. Suggest, using ideas about reactivity of the halogens,
why the reaction occurs.
.....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(e) What is the colour of the precipitate formed when aqueous silver nitrate is added to aqueous
sodium bromide?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) Complete the sentence about the formation of a chloride ion from a chlorine atom.
A chloride ion is formed when a chlorine atom gains one .............................. . [1]
[Total: 10]
8O
17
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [5]
6C
14
and 147N are isotopes of each other.
[2]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 8]
(a) The properties of some Group I elements are shown in the table.
lithium 181 23
(ii) Use the information in the table to predict what you would observe when lithium reacts with
cold water.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(i) Use the information in the equation to explain why the solution formed is alkaline.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Describe how you could use a named indicator solution to show that the solution is alkaline.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
[Total: 9]
8 The apparatus shown is used to investigate the rate of reaction between calcium carbonate and
hydrochloric acid at 30 °C.
calcium carbonate
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) Describe how this apparatus can be used to find the rate of reaction.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(c) The experiment is repeated at 20 °C. All other conditions are kept the same.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) The experiment is repeated using the same mass of different size pieces of calcium carbonate.
All other conditions are kept the same.
Complete the table by writing the sizes of the pieces in the first column.
12
[1]
(e)
Give the names of the three products formed when calcium carbonate reacts with
hydrochloric acid.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
3 ..................................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 7]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
20
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/33/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*2711517754*
CHEMISTRY 0620/41
Paper 4 Theory (Extended) May/June 2018
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_41/5RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
Give the order and the correct scientific term for the physical processes used to separate the
common salt from the mixture.
1 .................................................................................................................................................
2 .................................................................................................................................................
3 .................................................................................................................................................
[4]
alcohol A B C D
boiling point / °C 56 78 122 160
(c) A
student suggested that the apparatus shown could be used to separate the mixture of
alcohols.
fractionating column X
mixture of
hot water alcohols
A, B, C and D
electric heater
● Draw an arrow on the diagram to show where the cold water enters apparatus X.
● Name apparatus X.
. ............................................................................................................................................
[2]
(ii) Part of the fractionating column is missing. This means that the experiment will not work.
● Draw on the diagram the part of the fractionating column which is missing.
● xplain why the experiment will not work with this part of the fractionating column
E
missing.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
[2]
(iii) Suggest why a Bunsen burner is not used to heat the flask.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
Explain why.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 13]
2 Flerovium, Fl, atomic number 114, was first made in research laboratories in 1998.
(a) F
lerovium was made by bombarding atoms of plutonium, Pu, atomic number 94, with atoms of
element Z.
●● The nucleus of one atom of plutonium combined with the nucleus of one atom of element Z.
●● his formed the nucleus of one atom of flerovium.
T
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(d) T
wo isotopes of flerovium are 286Fl and 289Fl. The nuclei of both of these isotopes are unstable
and emit energy when they split up.
(i) State the term used to describe isotopes with unstable nuclei.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(ii) C
omplete the table to show the number of protons, neutrons and electrons in the atoms of
the isotopes shown.
289
Fl
[2]
(e) O
nly a relatively small number of atoms of flerovium have been made in the laboratory and the
properties of flerovium have not yet been investigated.
1 . .........................................................................................................................................
2 . .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 9]
(a) T
hree of the raw materials added to a blast furnace used to extract iron from hematite are
coke, hematite and limestone.
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
(b) A series of reactions occurs in a blast furnace during the extraction of iron from hematite.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [5]
(c) The iron extracted from hematite using a blast furnace is impure.
Identify the main impurity in this iron and explain how it is removed in the steel‑making process.
....................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................
[3]
[Total: 9]
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
xplain why the term relative molecular mass can be used for butane but cannot be used for
E
potassium fluoride.
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
(c) A 0.095 g sample of gaseous element Y occupies 60.0 cm3 at room temperature and pressure.
●● Calculate the relative molecular mass of element Y and hence suggest the identity of
element Y.
(d) A 1.68 g sample of phosphorus was burned and formed 3.87 g of an oxide of phosphorus.
[Total: 12]
5 (a) T
he table gives some chemical properties of transition elements and their compounds, and of
Group I elements and their compounds.
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
(ii) Give one other chemical property shown by transition elements which is not shown by
Group I elements.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) Give two physical properties shown by transition elements which are not shown by Group I
elements.
1 .................................................................................................................................................
2 .................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(c) T
he energy level diagram shows the energy profile for the reaction between zinc and dilute
sulfuric acid.
progress of reaction
(i) Complete the diagram by adding the formulae of the products. Include state symbols. [3]
(ii) Draw an arrow on the diagram to represent the activation energy. [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) T
he reaction between zinc and dilute sulfuric acid can be catalysed by the addition of aqueous
copper(II) sulfate.
On the diagram, add the energy profile for the catalysed reaction.
progress of reaction
[1]
power supply
+ –
carbon electrodes
aqueous
copper(II) sulfate
(i) W
rite an ionic half‑equation for the reaction at the negative electrode (cathode). Include
state symbols.
. ...................................................................................................................................... [3]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
(iii) Give two other observations which the student makes during the electrolysis.
1 . .........................................................................................................................................
2 . .........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(iv) W
hat difference would the student observe at the positive electrode if the aqueous
copper(II) sulfate were replaced by concentrated aqueous copper(II) chloride?
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 18]
P Q R S
CH3–CH3 CH2=CH2 CH2=CH–CH3 CH2=CH–CH2–CH3
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [2]
....................................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. [1]
. ............................................................................................................................................
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
Draw the structure of this compound. Show all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[1]
(e) D
raw the structure of an unbranched isomer of compound S. Show all of the atoms and all of
the bonds. Name this unbranched isomer of compound S.
structure
name ..........................................................................................................................................
[2]
. ...................................................................................................................................... [1]
n CH2=CH2
[2]
(g) A
mino acids undergo polymerisation to form proteins. Part of a protein molecule with the
linkages missing is shown.
Draw the linkages on the diagram. Show all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
H O
N C
[2]
O CH2 CH3
Write the word equation for a reaction which could be used to make this ester.
.............................................................................................................................................. [3]
[Total: 19]
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
12
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/41/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*0107966450*
CHEMISTRY 0620/42
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_42/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 5]
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
For each of the following, identify a Period 3 element which matches the description. Each element
may be used once, more than once or not at all.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 7]
11Na
23
11 11 23
................
17Cl
37 –
20
................ ................ ................
56
26.............
26 24 30 56
[6]
[Total: 6]
(a) Write a chemical equation for this reaction. Include state symbols.
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(ii) Explain why potassium bromide does not conduct electricity when solid but does conduct
electricity when molten.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
Include:
●● an ionic half-equation for the reaction at the cathode
●● the name of the product at the anode
●● the name of the potassium compound formed.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [4]
(iii) When molten potassium bromide is electrolysed, the product at the cathode is different.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(d) Iodine reacts with chlorine to form iodine monochloride, ICl, as the only product.
(i)
Write a chemical equation for this reaction.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(ii)
Draw a dot-and-cross diagram to show the electron arrangement in a molecule of
iodine monochloride. Show outer shell electrons only.
[2]
In terms of attractive forces, explain why there is a large difference between these melting
points.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [3]
(f) When chlorine gas is passed through aqueous potassium bromide, a redox reaction occurs.
The ionic equation is shown.
(i) Write an ionic half-equation showing what happens to the chlorine molecules, Cl 2, in this
reaction.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Explain why the bromide ions, Br –, act as reducing agents in this reaction.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 23]
5 Hydrogen and iodine react together in a reversible reaction. Hydrogen iodide is formed.
A gas syringe containing an equilibrium mixture of hydrogen, iodine and hydrogen iodide gases
was sealed and heated to 250 °C. The equilibrium mixture was a pale purple colour.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(b) The plunger of the gas syringe was pressed in while the end of the gas syringe was blocked.
This increased the pressure. The position of the equilibrium did not change. The colour of the
gaseous mixture turned darker purple.
(i) Give a reason why the position of the equilibrium did not change.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Suggest why the gaseous mixture turned darker purple, even though the position of the
equilibrium did not change.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(i)
What happened to the position of the equilibrium when the temperature of the gas syringe
was increased from 250 °C to 300 °C?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) What happened to the rate of the forward reaction and the rate of the backward reaction
when the temperature of the gas syringe was increased from 250 °C to 300 °C?
[Total: 7]
6 (a) All sodium salts are soluble in water. All nitrates are soluble in water. Barium carbonate is
insoluble in water.
Describe how you would make a pure, dry sample of barium carbonate by precipitation.
Include:
●● the names of the starting materials
●● full practical details
●● a chemical equation.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [5]
(i) Write a chemical equation for the decomposition of sodium nitrate when it is heated.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(ii) The unbalanced chemical equation for the decomposition of hydrated copper(II) nitrate
crystals is shown.
(iii) When the hydrated copper(II) nitrate crystals are heated, steam is produced. When the
steam condenses on a cool surface, it turns into a colourless liquid.
Anhydrous cobalt(II) chloride is used to show that the colourless liquid contains water.
(iv) How would the student test to determine if the water produced in (b)(iii) is pure?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 12]
7 Many organic compounds, such as alcohols, carboxylic acids and esters, contain the elements
carbon, hydrogen and oxygen only.
(a) Compound R has the following composition by mass: C, 60.00%; H, 13.33%; O, 26.67%.
(b) Compound S has the empirical formula C2H4O and a relative molecular mass of 88.
(i) What is the name given to compounds with the same molecular formula but different
structures?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Draw the structures of compounds T and V. Show all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
compound T
compound V
[2]
(iii) All compounds with the molecular formula C3H6O2 can undergo complete combustion in
an excess of oxygen.
(d) Compound W has the molecular formula C2H6O. Compound W reacts when heated with
ethanoic acid and a catalyst to produce a sweet‑smelling liquid.
(i) Give the name of the homologous series to which compound W belongs.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Draw the structure of compound W. Show all of the atoms and all of the bonds.
[1]
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
alkanes ................................................................................................................................
alkenes ................................................................................................................................
[2]
step 1 step 2
long‑chain alkane ethene ethanol
Describe the two‑stage manufacture of ethanol from the long‑chain alkane octane, C8H18.
Include:
●● the names of the types of chemical reactions that occur
●● reaction equations
●● reaction conditions.
step 1 .........................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
step 2 .........................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [5]
[Total: 20]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
12
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/42/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*6229193737*
CHEMISTRY 0620/43
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_43/4RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 The following are the symbols and formulae of some elements and compounds.
Answer the following questions using only the elements or compounds in the list.
Each element or compound may be used once, more than once or not at all.
[Total: 6]
2 (a)
29
Al is a radioactive isotope of aluminium. The only non‑radioactive isotope of aluminium is
27
Al.
(i) Describe, in terms of protons, neutrons and electrons, how the isotopes 29Al and 27Al are
similar and how they are different.
13Al
27
(ii) Complete the table to show the number of nucleons, neutrons and electrons in an 3+
ion.
13Al
number in 27 3+
nucleons
neutrons
electrons
[3]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Why is aluminium not extracted from its ore by reduction with carbon?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) The main ore of aluminium contains aluminium oxide. Aluminium oxide is dissolved in
molten cryolite before it is electrolysed.
1 ...........................................................................................................................................
2 ...........................................................................................................................................
[2]
(iv) The reaction at the anode during the extraction of aluminium by electrolysis is shown.
2O2– O2 + 4e–
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(v) During the extraction of aluminium by electrolysis, carbon dioxide is formed at the anode.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(c) When a piece of zinc metal is added to copper(II) sulfate solution there is an immediate
reaction.
Zn + CuSO4 ZnSO4 + Cu
When a piece of aluminium metal is added to copper(II) sulfate solution the initial reaction is
very slow.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Explain why the initial reaction between aluminium metal and copper(II) sulfate is very
slow.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 15]
(a) State one physical property that is similar for cobalt and potassium.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) (i) State one physical property that is different for cobalt and potassium.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Describe how the physical property given in (b)(i) is different for cobalt compared to
potassium.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(c) W
hen a small piece of potassium is added to cold water, the potassium floats and disappears
as it reacts.
Give two other observations that would be made when a small piece of potassium is added to
cold water.
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
[2]
(d) Cobalt reacts with dilute hydrochloric acid to make the salt cobalt(II) chloride. Bubbles of
hydrogen gas are produced.
test .......................................................................................................................................
result ....................................................................................................................................
[2]
(ii) The rate of reaction of cobalt with dilute hydrochloric acid can be made faster by heating
the acid or by increasing its concentration.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Use collision theory to explain how heating the dilute hydrochloric acid makes the rate of
reaction faster.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [3]
Describe what the student observes. Give a reason for your answer in terms of the position
of the equilibrium.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(ii) Another student cools a blue solution containing [CoCl 4]2–. The blue solution turns pink.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 15]
1 ..................................................................................................................................................
2 ..................................................................................................................................................
[2]
H H
H C C O H
H H
H H
H C C O H
H H
[2]
(c) Ethanol can be produced by the catalytic addition of steam to ethene or by the fermentation of
glucose.
(i) Write a chemical equation for the production of ethanol by the catalytic addition of steam
to ethene.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Write a chemical equation for the production of ethanol by the fermentation of glucose,
C6H12O6.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) State one advantage of producing ethanol by the catalytic addition of steam to ethene.
Your answer must not refer to cost.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(e) Ethanoic acid reacts with ethanol in the presence of an acid catalyst. The products are an
organic compound and water.
(i) Draw the structure of the organic compound formed. Show all of the atoms and all of the
bonds.
[2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Which homologous series does the organic compound formed belong to?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(f) Ethanoic acid, CH3COOH, is a weak acid. It reacts with copper(II) carbonate to form the salt
copper(II) ethanoate, Cu(CH3COO)2.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Describe how a crystalline sample of copper(II) ethanoate can be prepared starting with
ethanoic acid and copper(II) carbonate.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [3]
(iii) Write the word equation for the reaction between ethanoic acid and copper(II) carbonate.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
[Total: 18]
5 (a) Nickel(II) iodide crystals are hydrated. A sample of hydrated nickel(II) iodide crystals has the
following composition by mass: Ni, 14.01%; I, 60.33%; H, 2.85%; O, 22.81%.
power supply
copper wires
platinum
electrodes
molten
nickel(II) iodide
During electrolysis, charge is transferred through the copper wires and through the molten
nickel(II) iodide.
(i) Name the type of particles which transfer charge through the copper wires.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Name the type of particles which transfer charge through the molten nickel(II) iodide.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
products................................................................................................................................
(c) A student electrolysed copper(II) sulfate solution using the two sets of apparatus shown.
carbon copper
electrodes electrodes
apparatus A apparatus B
The mass of the negative electrode increased. The mass of the negative electrode increased.
The mass of the positive electrode stayed the same. The mass of the positive electrode decreased.
Bubbles were seen at the positive electrode. No bubbles were seen at the positive electrode.
(i) Explain why the mass of the negative electrode increased in both sets of apparatus.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Name the gas that formed the bubbles seen in apparatus A.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Explain why the mass of the positive electrode decreased in apparatus B.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iv) Suggest what happens to the colour of the solution in apparatus A and apparatus B as the
electrolysis progresses.
Explain your answer.
explanation ..........................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
[3]
[Total: 13]
(iii) What is the maximum number of moles of calcium chlorate(V) that can be made from
8.88 g of calcium hydroxide and 7200 cm3 of chlorine gas?
(iv) What is the maximum mass of calcium chlorate(V) that can be made from 8.88 g of
calcium hydroxide and 7200 cm3 of chlorine gas?
.............................. g [2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Complete the chemical equation to show HCl O3 behaving as an acid in water.
[Total: 13]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
© UCLES 2018
I II III IV V VI VII VIII
1 2
H He
hydrogen helium
Key 1 4
3 4 atomic number 5 6 7 8 9 10
Li Be atomic symbol B C N O F Ne
lithium beryllium name boron carbon nitrogen oxygen fluorine neon
7 9 relative atomic mass 11 12 14 16 19 20
11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar
sodium magnesium aluminium silicon phosphorus sulfur chlorine argon
23 24 27 28 31 32 35.5 40
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
K Ca Sc Ti V Cr Mn Fe Co Ni Cu Zn Ga Ge As Se Br Kr
potassium calcium scandium titanium vanadium chromium manganese iron cobalt nickel copper zinc gallium germanium arsenic selenium bromine krypton
39 40 45 48 51 52 55 56 59 59 64 65 70 73 75 79 80 84
37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
Rb Sr Y Zr Nb Mo Tc Ru Rh Pd Ag Cd In Sn Sb Te I Xe
rubidium strontium yttrium zirconium niobium molybdenum technetium ruthenium rhodium palladium silver cadmium indium tin antimony tellurium iodine xenon
16
85 88 89 91 93 96 – 101 103 106 108 112 115 119 122 128 127 131
55 56 57–71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86
0620/43/M/J/18
lanthanoids
Cs Ba Hf Ta W Re Os Ir Pt Au Hg Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn
caesium barium hafnium tantalum tungsten rhenium osmium iridium platinum gold mercury thallium lead bismuth polonium astatine radon
133 137 178 181 184 186 190 192 195 197 201 204 207 209 – – –
87 88 89–103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 114 116
actinoids
Fr Ra Rf Db Sg Bh Hs Mt Ds Rg Cn Fl Lv
francium radium rutherfordium dubnium seaborgium bohrium hassium meitnerium darmstadtium roentgenium copernicium flerovium livermorium
– – – – – – – – – – – – –
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
lanthanoids La Ce Pr Nd Pm Sm Eu Gd Tb Dy Ho Er Tm Yb Lu
lanthanum cerium praseodymium neodymium promethium samarium europium gadolinium terbium dysprosium holmium erbium thulium ytterbium lutetium
139 140 141 144 – 150 152 157 159 163 165 167 169 173 175
89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103
actinoids Ac Th Pa U Np Pu Am Cm Bk Cf Es Fm Md No Lr
actinium thorium protactinium uranium neptunium plutonium americium curium berkelium californium einsteinium fermium mendelevium nobelium lawrencium
– 232 231 238 – – – – – – – – – – –
The volume of one mole of any gas is 24 dm3 at room temperature and pressure (r.t.p.).
Cambridge International Examinations
Cambridge International General Certificate of Secondary Education
*8393780945*
CHEMISTRY 0620/51
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_51/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
BLANK PAGE
1 You are going to investigate the rate of reaction between dilute hydrochloric acid and aqueous
sodium thiosulfate. When these chemicals react they form a precipitate which makes the solution
go cloudy. The formation of this precipitate can be used to show how fast the reaction proceeds.
Instructions
You are going to do five experiments using the apparatus shown.
eye
printed insert
printed words
Experiment 1
● se the large measuring cylinder to pour 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate into the conical
U
flask. Place the conical flask on the printed insert.
● Fill the small measuring cylinder with 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid.
● Add the dilute hydrochloric acid to the solution in the conical flask. Start the timer immediately
and swirl the mixture.
● View the conical flask from above and measure the time taken for the printed words to disappear
from view. Record the time taken in the table on page 4.
● Immediately pour the contents of the conical flask into the quenching bath and rinse the conical
flask with distilled water.
Experiment 2
● se the large measuring cylinder to pour 40 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate into the conical
U
flask, followed by 10 cm3 of distilled water. Place the conical flask on the printed insert.
● Fill the small measuring cylinder with 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid.
● Add the dilute hydrochloric acid to the solution in the conical flask. Start the timer immediately
and swirl the mixture.
● View the conical flask from above and measure the time taken for the printed words to disappear
from view. Record the time taken in the table on page 4.
● Immediately pour the contents of the conical flask into the quenching bath and rinse the conical
flask with distilled water.
Experiment 3
● epeat Experiment 2 but use 35 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate, 15 cm3 of distilled water
R
and 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid.
Experiment 4
Experiment 5
[3]
(b) Plot your results from Experiments 1–5 on the grid. Draw a smooth line graph.
350
300
250
200
time taken for the
printed words to
disappear from view / s
150
100
50
0
0 10 20 30 40 50
volume of aqueous sodium thiosulfate / cm 3
[3]
(c) Describe the appearance of the mixture in the conical flask at the end of each experiment.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) (i)
From your graph, deduce the time taken for the printed words to disappear from view
if Experiment 2 were repeated using 20 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate and 30 cm3 of
distilled water.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. s [2]
(ii) The rate of reaction can be calculated using the equation shown.
1
rate of reaction =
time taken
Calculate the rate of reaction using your answer from (d)(i).
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(e) (i) In which experiment, 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5, was the rate of reaction greatest?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Explain, in terms of particles, why the rate of reaction was greatest in this experiment.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(f) Give the name of a more accurate piece of apparatus for measuring volumes than a measuring
cylinder.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(g) S
uggest the effect on the results of using a 100 cm3 conical flask instead of a 250 cm3
conical flask. Explain your answer.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(h) S
ketch on the grid the graph you would expect if all of the experiments were repeated at a
lower temperature. Clearly label your graph. [1]
[Total: 17]
tests on solution A
Divide solution A into four approximately equal portions in three test-tubes and one boiling tube.
pH = .............................. [1]
(b) A
dd a strip of magnesium ribbon to the second portion of solution A in a test‑tube. Shake the
mixture.
Record your observations.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
tests on solid B
(d) U
se a spatula to place approximately half of solid B into a hard glass test-tube. Heat solid B
gently then strongly. Leave the hard glass test-tube to stand for approximately 1 minute.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(e) Add the rest of solid B to the fourth portion of solution A in a test-tube. Test the gas produced.
Record your observations.
test ..............................................................................................................................................
result ...........................................................................................................................................
[2]
Keep the solution from the test in (e) for the test in (f).
dd an approximately equal volume of distilled water to the solution from the test in (e). Shake the
A
solution and divide it into three approximately equal portions in two test-tubes and one boiling tube.
(f) (i) A
dd a few drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide to the first portion of the solution in a
test‑tube.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(g) (i) Add a few drops of aqueous ammonia to the second portion of the solution in a test‑tube.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii)
Now add an excess of aqueous ammonia to the mixture.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(h) A
dd a small piece of aluminium foil and about 2 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide to the third
portion of the solution in a boiling tube. Gently warm the mixture. Test the gas produced with
indicator paper.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 17]
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced
gently and test for the presence of will turn acidified aqueous
sulfur dioxide potassium manganate(VII) from
purple to colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt., or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper(II) (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/52
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2018
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_52/4RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1
You are going to investigate the temperature changes when two different solids, solid C and solid D,
dissolve in water.
Instructions
You are going to do two experiments.
(a) Experiment 1
● epeat the procedure using the 4 g sample of solid C. Record your results and the
R
temperature change, including whether the temperature increased (+) or decreased (–), in
the appropriate row of the table.
● Repeat the procedure using the 6 g sample of solid C. Record your results and the
temperature change, including whether the temperature increased (+) or decreased (–), in
the appropriate row of the table.
[2]
(b)
Experiment 2
● Repeat Experiment 1 but using the 3 g, 4 g, 6 g and 8 g samples of solid D.
● ecord your results in the table.
R
● Calculate and record the temperature changes in each case, including whether the
temperature increased (+) or decreased (–).
[2]
(c) P lot your results for Experiments 1 and 2 on the grid. The (0,0) point has been plotted for you.
Draw two straight lines of best fit.
Clearly label your graphs.
15
10
5
temperature
change / °C
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
mass of solid added / g
–5
–10
–15
[4]
(d)
Use your graph to estimate the temperature change after 1 minute if 8 g of solid C were added
to 40 cm3 of distilled water.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. °C [2]
(e) What type of energy change occurs when solid D dissolves in water?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) S
uggest the temperature of the solution containing 8 g of solid D, if the solution were left for
2 hours.
Explain your answer.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(g) H
ow would the temperature changes measured after 1 minute differ if the experiments were
repeated using 80 cm3 instead of 40 cm3 of distilled water in each case?
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(h) Suggest one change you could make to the experiments to obtain more accurate results.
Explain how this change would make the results more accurate.
change ........................................................................................................................................
explanation .................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 19]
2
You are provided with two solid salts, solid E and solid F.
Do the following tests on solid E and solid F, recording all of your observations at each stage.
tests on solid E
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(b) P
lace about half of solid E in a hard glass test-tube. Heat the solid gently then strongly.
Record your observations.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
dd the rest of solid E to about 10 cm3 of distilled water in a boiling tube. Stopper the boiling tube
A
and shake it to dissolve solid E and form solution E.
Divide solution E into three approximately equal portions in three test-tubes.
(c) Add a few drops of dilute nitric acid and about 1 cm3 of aqueous silver nitrate to the first portion
of solution E.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(d) Add a few drops of dilute nitric acid and about 1 cm3 of aqueous barium nitrate to the second
portion of solution E.
Record your observations.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
tests on solid F
dd solid F to about 10 cm3 of distilled water in a boiling tube. Stopper the boiling tube and shake
A
it to dissolve solid F and form solution F.
Divide solution F into three approximately equal portions in three test-tubes.
pH = .............................. [1]
(h) (i) A
dd a few drops of aqueous sodium hydroxide to the second portion of solution F and
shake the mixture.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(j) What conclusion can you draw about the cation present in solid F?
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 15]
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced
gently and test for the presence of will turn acidified aqueous
sulfur dioxide potassium manganate(VII) from
purple to colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt., or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper(II) (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/53
Paper 5 Practical Test May/June 2018
1 hour 15 minutes
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
Additional Materials: As listed in the Confidential Instructions
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
Total
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_53/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 You are going to investigate how the temperature changes when aqueous sodium hydroxide reacts
with solutions of two different acids, acid R and acid S.
Instructions
You are going to do two experiments.
(a)
Experiment 1
highest temperature
volume of acid R added / cm3
of the solution / °C
0.0
5.0
10.0
15.0
20.0
25.0
30.0
35.0
40.0
[2]
(b) Plot your results for Experiment 1 on the grid and draw two intersecting straight line graphs.
50
45
40
highest temperature of the solution / °C
35
30
25
20
15
10
0.0 5.0 10.0 15.0 20.0 25.0 30.0 35.0 40.0
volume of acid R added / cm3
[2]
(c)
Experiment 2
● mpty the burette and rinse it with distilled water. Discard this liquid.
E
● Rinse the burette with some of acid S. Discard this acid.
● Repeat Experiment 1 but using acid S instead of acid R.
● Record your results in the table.
highest temperature
volume of acid S added / cm3
of the solution / °C
0.0
5.0
10.0
15.0
20.0
25.0
30.0
35.0
40.0
[2]
(d) Plot your results for Experiment 2 on the grid and draw two intersecting straight line graphs.
50
45
40
highest temperature of the solution / °C
35
30
25
20
15
10
0.0 5.0 10.0 15.0 20.0 25.0 30.0 35.0 40.0
volume of acid S added / cm3
[2]
(e) (i)
Use your graph to estimate the volume of acid S which must be added to neutralise
50 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
(ii) Suggest how the volume in (e)(i) would differ if the experiment were repeated using 25 cm3
instead of 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide.
Explain your answer.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(f) What type of energy change occurs when acid S reacts with aqueous sodium hydroxide?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(g) (i) In Experiment 2, why was the burette rinsed with distilled water?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(h) D
escribe one source of error in Experiment 2. Suggest an improvement to reduce this source
of error.
improvement ...............................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 17]
tests on solution T
Divide solution T into four approximately equal portions in three test-tubes and one boiling tube.
(a) (i) D
o a flame test on the first portion of solution T.
Record your observations.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
pH = .............................. [1]
(b) ● A dd a few drops of aqueous zinc sulfate to the second portion of solution T in a test‑tube.
Shake the test-tube to mix the solutions.
Record your observations.
..............................................................................................................................................
● A
dd an excess of aqueous zinc sulfate to the mixture.
Record your observations.
..............................................................................................................................................
[3]
(c) A dd a small spatula measure of ammonium chloride to the third portion of solution T in a
boiling tube. Warm the mixture carefully. Test the gas produced.
Record your observations.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
[3]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
tests on liquid U
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(g) A dd about 10 cm3 of aqueous iodine to about 1 cm3 of liquid U in a boiling tube. Add drops of
aqueous sodium hydroxide until the brown colour of the aqueous iodine is removed.
Record your observations.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(h) U
se a teat pipette to place a few drops of liquid U on to a watch glass. Use a lighted splint to
touch the surface of the liquid carefully.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 17]
3 Some trees have purple leaves. The purple colour is a mixture of coloured pigments.
Plan an experiment to extract and separate the coloured pigments present in the purple leaves.
You are provided with some purple leaves, sand, ethanol and common laboratory apparatus.
You may draw a diagram to help you answer the question.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
chloride (Cl –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add white ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
bromide (Br –) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add cream ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
iodide (I–) acidify with dilute nitric acid, then add yellow ppt.
[in solution] aqueous silver nitrate
sulfite (SO32–) add dilute hydrochloric acid, warm sulfur dioxide produced
gently and test for the presence of will turn acidified aqueous
sulfur dioxide potassium manganate(VII) from
purple to colourless
aluminium (Al 3+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., insoluble in excess
colourless solution
calcium (Ca2+) white ppt., insoluble in excess no ppt., or very slight white ppt.
chromium(III) (Cr3+) green ppt., soluble in excess grey-green ppt., insoluble in excess
copper(II) (Cu2+) light blue ppt., insoluble in excess light blue ppt., soluble in excess,
giving a dark blue solution
iron(II) (Fe2+) green ppt., insoluble in excess green ppt., insoluble in excess
iron(III) (Fe3+) red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess red-brown ppt., insoluble in excess
zinc (Zn2+) white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a white ppt., soluble in excess, giving a
colourless solution colourless solution
ammonia (NH3) turns damp red litmus paper blue lithium (Li+) red
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/61
Paper 6 Alternative to Practical May/June 2018
1 hour
Candidates answer on the Question Paper.
No Additional Materials are required.
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_61/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 The volume of dilute nitric acid that reacts with 25.0 cm3 of aqueous potassium hydroxide can be
found by titration using the apparatus shown.
...........................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
A student did the titration four times and recorded the following results.
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(iii) Use the other results to calculate the average volume of dilute nitric acid that reacted with
the aqueous potassium hydroxide.
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(d) The equation for the reaction taking place in the titration is shown.
The student concluded that the aqueous potassium hydroxide was more concentrated than the
dilute nitric acid.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 8]
2
A student investigated the rate of reaction between dilute hydrochloric acid and aqueous
sodium thiosulfate. When these chemicals react they form a precipitate which makes the solution
go cloudy. The formation of this precipitate can be used to show how fast the reaction proceeds.
eye
Experiment 1
● large measuring cylinder was used to pour 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate into a
A
250 cm3 conical flask. The conical flask was placed on a printed sheet of paper.
● 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid was added to the solution in the conical flask. A timer was
started immediately and the mixture was swirled.
● The time taken for the printed words to disappear from view was measured.
Experiment 2
● he large measuring cylinder was used to pour 40 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate into a
T
conical flask, followed by 10 cm3 of distilled water. The conical flask was placed on the printed
sheet of paper.
● 10 cm3 of dilute hydrochloric acid was added to the solution in the conical flask. The timer was
started immediately and the mixture was swirled.
● The time taken for the printed words to disappear from view was measured.
Experiment 3
● xperiment 2 was repeated but using 35 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate and 15 cm3 of
E
distilled water.
Experiment 4
● xperiment 2 was repeated but using 30 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate and 20 cm3 of
E
distilled water.
Experiment 5
● xperiment 2 was repeated but using 10 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate and 40 cm3 of
E
distilled water.
(a) Record the volumes of distilled water used in the table. Use the stop-clock diagrams to record
the results in the table.
1 50 45 15 5 15
10
minutes
30
0
0
2 40 45 15 5 15
10
30
0
0
3 35 45 15 5 15
10
30
0
0
4 30 45 15 5 15
10
30
0
0
5 10 45 15 5 15
10
30
[3]
(b) Plot the results from Experiments 1–5 on the grid. Draw a smooth line graph.
240
210
180
150
time taken for
the printed words
to disappear
from view / s 120
90
60
30
0
0 10 20 30 40 50
volume of aqueous sodium thiosulfate / cm3
[3]
(c) (i)
From your graph, deduce the time taken for the printed words to disappear from view
if Experiment 2 were repeated using 20 cm3 of aqueous sodium thiosulfate and 30 cm3 of
distilled water.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. s [2]
(ii) The rate of reaction can be calculated using the equation shown.
1
rate of reaction =
time taken
Calculate the rate of reaction using your answer from (c)(i).
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(d) (i) In which experiment, 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5, was the rate of reaction greatest?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(ii) Explain, in terms of particles, why the rate of reaction was greatest in this experiment.
..............................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(e) Give the name of a more accurate piece of apparatus for measuring volumes than a measuring
cylinder.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) Suggest the effect on the results of using a 100 cm3 conical flask instead of a 250 cm3 conical
flask. Explain your answer.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(g) Sketch on the grid the graph you would expect if all of the experiments were repeated at a
lower temperature. Clearly label your graph. [1]
[Total: 16]
tests on solution A
test 1
test 2
The gas produced was tested. gas ‘popped’ with a lighted splint
test 3
Dilute nitric acid and aqueous barium nitrate white precipitate formed
were added to the third portion of solution A.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
tests on solid B
(c) Dilute nitric acid was added to solid B. The gas produced was tested.
observations ...............................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
The zinc nitrate solution formed in the test in (c) was divided into two portions in two test‑tubes.
(d) (i) D
rops of aqueous sodium hydroxide were added to the first portion of the zinc nitrate
solution.
(ii)
An excess of aqueous sodium hydroxide was then added to the mixture.
(e) (i)
Drops of aqueous ammonia were added to the second portion of the zinc nitrate solution.
(ii) An excess of aqueous ammonia was then added to the mixture.
[Total: 10]
You are provided with potassium chloride and common laboratory apparatus.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/62
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_62/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 The rate of reaction between an excess of dilute nitric acid and powdered calcium carbonate was
investigated. The carbon dioxide produced was collected. The apparatus used is shown.
powdered
calcium carbonate
time
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(c) Draw on the axes the graph expected if the experiment were repeated using an equal mass
of lumps of calcium carbonate. All other conditions were kept the same. [2]
test ..............................................................................................................................................
result ...........................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 8]
2 A student investigated the temperature changes when two different solids, solid C and solid D,
dissolved in water.
Experiment 1
● sing a measuring cylinder, 40 cm3 of distilled water was poured into a polystyrene cup. The
U
initial temperature of the distilled water was measured.
● 3 g of solid C was added to the polystyrene cup and the mixture was stirred with a thermometer.
The temperature of the solution was measured after 1 minute.
(a) Use the thermometer diagrams to record the results in the table.
Calculate and record the temperature change in each case, including whether the temperature
increased (+) or decreased (–).
initial
temperature of
mass of thermometer temperature thermometer temperature
the solution
solid C / g diagram of the distilled diagram change / °C
after 1 min / °C
water / °C
30 20
3 25 15
20 10
30 20
4 25 15
20 10
30 20
6 25 15
20 10
[2]
Experiment 2
● Experiment 1 was repeated but using 3 g, 4 g, 6 g and 8 g of solid D .
(b) Use the thermometer diagrams to record the results in the table.
Calculate and record the temperature change in each case, including whether the temperature
increased (+) or decreased (–).
initial
temperature of
mass of thermometer temperature thermometer temperature
the solution
solid D / g diagram of the distilled diagram change / °C
after 1 min / °C
water / °C
30 30
3 25 25
20 20
30 30
4 25 25
20 20
30 30
6 25 25
20 20
30 40
8 25 35
20 30
[2]
(c) P
lot the results for Experiments 1 and 2 on the grid. The (0,0) point has been plotted for you.
Draw two straight lines of best fit.
Clearly label your graphs.
15
10
5
temperature
change / °C
0
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
mass of solid added / g
–5
–10
[4]
(d)
Use your graph to estimate the temperature change after 1 minute if 8 g of solid C were added
to 40 cm3 of distilled water.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
.............................. °C [2]
(e) What type of energy change occurs when solid D dissolves in water?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(f) Suggest the temperature of the solution containing 8 g of solid D, if the solution were left for
2 hours.
Explain your answer.
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(g) How would the temperature changes measured after 1 minute differ if the experiments were
repeated using 80 cm3 instead of 40 cm3 of distilled water in each case?
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
(h) Suggest one change you could make to the experiments to obtain more accurate results.
Explain how this change would make the results more accurate.
change ........................................................................................................................................
explanation .................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
[2]
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
[Total: 19]
3 Two substances, solid E and solution F, were analysed. Solid E was iron(II) sulfate. Tests were
done on solid E and solution F.
tests on solid E
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
Solid E was added to distilled water in a test-tube. The test-tube was shaken to dissolve solid E and
form solution E. Solution E was divided into four equal portions in four test-tubes.
(b) Dilute nitric acid and aqueous silver nitrate were added to the first portion of solution E.
(c) Dilute nitric acid and aqueous barium nitrate were added to the second portion of solution E.
(d) An excess of aqueous sodium hydroxide was added to the third portion of solution E.
(e) An excess of aqueous ammonia was added to the fourth portion of solution E.
tests on solution F
test 1
test 2
(f) What conclusion can you draw about the cation present in solution F?
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 7]
4
Aqueous solutions of barium hydroxide are alkaline.
Plan an investigation to find the concentration of an aqueous solution of barium hydroxide.
You are provided with an aqueous solution of barium hydroxide, dilute hydrochloric acid of known
concentration and common laboratory apparatus.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.
CHEMISTRY 0620/63
Write your Centre number, candidate number and name on all the work you hand in.
Write in dark blue or black pen.
You may use an HB pencil for any diagrams or graphs.
Do not use staples, paper clips, glue or correction fluid.
DO NOT WRITE IN ANY BARCODES.
At the end of the examination, fasten all your work securely together.
The number of marks is given in brackets [ ] at the end of each question or part question.
The syllabus is approved for use in England, Wales and Northern Ireland as a Cambridge International Level 1/Level 2 Certificate.
IB18 06_0620_63/3RP
© UCLES 2018 [Turn over
2
1 Zinc sulfate crystals are hydrated. They contain water of crystallisation. A student did an experiment
to find the mass of water in hydrated zinc sulfate crystals.
The hydrated zinc sulfate crystals were weighed and then heated with a Bunsen burner to remove
the water as shown.
.........................................
heat
A B
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(b) What position should the air hole of the Bunsen burner be in when heating the hydrated
zinc sulfate crystals in B?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(c) Describe how the student could find out if all of the water of crystallisation had been removed
from the hydrated zinc sulfate crystals.
.....................................................................................................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................... [2]
test ..............................................................................................................................................
result ...........................................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 7]
2 A student investigated how the temperature changed when aqueous sodium hydroxide reacted
with solutions of two different acids, acid R and acid S.
Experiment 1
● A measuring cylinder was used to pour 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide into a polystyrene
cup. The temperature of the solution was measured.
● A burette was filled up to the 0.0 cm3 mark with acid R.
● 5.0 cm3 of acid R was added to the aqueous sodium hydroxide in the polystyrene cup and the
solution stirred.
● The highest temperature of the solution was measured.
● A further 5.0 cm3 of acid R was added to the polystyrene cup and the solution was stirred.
● The highest temperature of the solution was measured.
● Further 5.0 cm3 portions of acid R were added to the polystyrene cup until a total volume of
40.0 cm3 of acid R had been added. The highest temperature of the solution was measured
after each addition.
(a) Use the thermometer diagrams to record the results in the table.
0.0 25
20
30
5.0 25
20
30
10.0 25
20
30
15.0 25
20
30
20.0 25
20
40
25.0 35
30
30
30.0 25
20
30
35.0 25
20
30
40.0 25
20
[2]
(b) Plot the results for Experiment 1 on the grid and draw two intersecting straight line graphs.
40
highest temperature of the solution / °C
35
30
25
20
15
0.0 5.0 10.0 15.0 20.0 25.0 30.0 35.0 40.0
volume of acid R added / cm3
[2]
Experiment 2
● The burette was rinsed with distilled water and then with acid S.
● Experiment 1 was repeated but using acid S instead of acid R.
(c) Use the thermometer diagrams to record the results in the table.
0.0 25
20
30
5.0 25
20
40
10.0 35
30
40
15.0 35
30
40
20.0 35
30
30
25.0 25
20
30
30.0 25
20
30
35.0 25
20
30
40.0 25
20
[2]
(d) Plot the results for Experiment 2 on the grid and draw two intersecting straight line graphs.
40
highest temperature of the solution / °C
35
30
25
20
15
0.0 5.0 10.0 15.0 20.0 25.0 30.0 35.0 40.0
volume of acid S added / cm3
[2]
(e) (i)
Use your graph to estimate the volume of acid S which must be added to neutralise
50 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide.
Show clearly on the grid how you worked out your answer.
(ii) Suggest how the volume in (e)(i) would differ if the experiment were repeated using 25 cm3
instead of 50 cm3 of aqueous sodium hydroxide.
Explain your answer.
..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................................................................................ [2]
(f) What type of energy change occurs when acid S reacts with aqueous sodium hydroxide?
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
(g) (i) In Experiment 2, why was the burette rinsed with distilled water?
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
........................................................................................................................................ [1]
(h) Describe one source of error in Experiment 2. Suggest an improvement to reduce this source
of error.
improvement ...............................................................................................................................
[2]
[Total: 17]
tests on solution T
Solution T was divided into four portions in three test-tubes and one boiling tube.
(a) (i) A flame test was done on the first portion of solution T.
pH = .............................. [1]
(b) ● A few drops of aqueous zinc sulfate were added to the second portion of solution T in a
test‑tube. The test-tube was shaken to mix the solutions.
observations ........................................................................................................................
observations ........................................................................................................................
[3]
(c) Ammonium chloride was added to the third portion of solution T in a boiling tube. The mixture
was heated and the gas produced was tested.
test ..............................................................................................................................................
observations ...............................................................................................................................
[2]
(d) An excess of aqueous chromium(III) chloride was added to the fourth portion of solution T in
a test‑tube.
tests on liquid U
The surface of the liquid was touched with a burned with a blue flame
lighted splint.
............................................................................................................................................... [1]
[Total: 10]
4 Some trees have purple leaves. The purple colour is a mixture of coloured pigments.
Plan an experiment to extract and separate the coloured pigments present in the purple leaves.
You are provided with some purple leaves, sand, ethanol and common laboratory apparatus.
You may draw a diagram to help you answer the question.
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
............................................................................................................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [6]
[Total: 6]
BLANK PAGE
Permission to reproduce items where third-party owned material protected by copyright is included has been sought and cleared where possible. Every reasonable
effort has been made by the publisher (UCLES) to trace copyright holders, but if any items requiring clearance have unwittingly been included, the publisher will
be pleased to make amends at the earliest possible opportunity.
To avoid the issue of disclosure of answer-related information to candidates, all copyright acknowledgements are reproduced online in the Cambridge International
Examinations Copyright Acknowledgements Booklet. This is produced for each series of examinations and is freely available to download at www.cie.org.uk after
the live examination series.
Cambridge International Examinations is part of the Cambridge Assessment Group. Cambridge Assessment is the brand name of University of Cambridge Local
Examinations Syndicate (UCLES), which is itself a department of the University of Cambridge.